* gdb.texinfo (Help): Fix formatting of examples.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
66 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
67 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
68 development.''
69 @end ifinfo
70
71 @titlepage
72 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
73 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
74 @sp 1
75 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
76 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
77 @page
78 @tex
79 {\parskip=0pt
80 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
81 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
82 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
83 }
84 @end tex
85
86 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
87 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
88 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
89 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
90 @sp 2
91 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
92 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
93 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
94 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
95
96 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
97 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
98 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
99 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
100 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
101 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
102
103 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
104 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
105 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
106 development.''
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
118 @value{GDBVN}.
119
120 Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
121
122 @menu
123 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
124 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
125
126 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
127 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
128 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
129 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
130 * Stack:: Examining the stack
131 * Source:: Examining source files
132 * Data:: Examining data
133 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
134 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
135 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
136
137 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
138
139 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
140 * Altering:: Altering execution
141 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
142 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
143 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
144 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
145 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
146 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
147 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
148 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
149 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
150 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
151 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
152
153 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
154
155 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
156 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
157 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
158 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
159 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
160 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
161 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
162 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
163 @value{GDBN}
164 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
165 how you can copy and share GDB
166 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
167 * Index:: Index
168 @end menu
169
170 @end ifnottex
171
172 @contents
173
174 @node Summary
175 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
176
177 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
178 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
179 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
180
181 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
182 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
183
184 @itemize @bullet
185 @item
186 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
187
188 @item
189 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
190
191 @item
192 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
193
194 @item
195 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
196 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
197 @end itemize
198
199 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
200 For more information, see @ref{Supported languages,,Supported languages}.
201 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
202
203 @cindex Modula-2
204 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
205 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
206
207 @cindex Pascal
208 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
209 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
210 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
211 syntax.
212
213 @cindex Fortran
214 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
215 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
216 underscore.
217
218 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
219 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
220
221 @menu
222 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
223 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
224 @end menu
225
226 @node Free Software
227 @unnumberedsec Free software
228
229 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
230 General Public License
231 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
232 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
233 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
234 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
235 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
236 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
237
238 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
239 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
240 from anyone else.
241
242 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
243
244 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
245 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
246 include with the free software. Many of our most important
247 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
248 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
249 when an important free software package does not come with a free
250 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
251 gaps today.
252
253 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
254 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
255 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
256 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
257 them from the free software world.
258
259 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
260 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
261 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
262 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
263 contract to make it non-free.
264
265 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
266 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
267 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
268 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
269 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
270 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
271 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
272
273 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
274 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
275 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
276 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
277
278 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
279 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
280 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
281 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
282 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
283 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
284 community.
285
286 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
287 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
288 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
289 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
290 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
291 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
292 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
293 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
294 of the manual.
295
296 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
297 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
298 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
299 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
300 manual to replace it.
301
302 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
303 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
304 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
305 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
306 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
307 the free software community.
308
309 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
310 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
311 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
312 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
313 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
314 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
315 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
316 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
317 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
318
319 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
320 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
321 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
322 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
323 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
324 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
325 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
326 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
327
328 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
329 published by other publishers, at
330 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
331
332 @node Contributors
333 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
334
335 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
336 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
337 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
338 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
339 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
340 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
341 blow-by-blow account.
342
343 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
344
345 @quotation
346 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
347 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
348 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
349 @end quotation
350
351 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
352 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
353 releases:
354 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
355 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
356 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
357 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
358 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
359 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
360 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
361 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
362 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
363
364 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
365 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
366
367 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
368 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
369 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
370 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
371 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
372
373 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
374 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
375 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
376
377 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
378 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
379
380 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
381
382 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
383 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
384 support.
385 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
386 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
387 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
388 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
389 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
390 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
391 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
392 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
393 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
394 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
395 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
396 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
397 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
398 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
399 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
400 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
401
402 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
403
404 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
405 libraries.
406
407 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
408 about several machine instruction sets.
409
410 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
411 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
412 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
413 and RDI targets, respectively.
414
415 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
416 command-line editing and command history.
417
418 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
419 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
420
421 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
422 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
423 symbols.
424
425 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
426 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
427
428 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
429
430 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
431 processors.
432
433 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
434
435 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
436
437 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
438
439 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
440 watchpoints.
441
442 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
443
444 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
445
446 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
447 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
448
449 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
450 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
451 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
452 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
453 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
454 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
455 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
456
457 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
458 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
459
460 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
461 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
462 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
463 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
464 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
465 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
466 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
467 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
468 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
469 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
470 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
471 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
472 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
473 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
474 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
475
476 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
477 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
478
479 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
480 Hat.
481
482 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
483 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
484 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
485 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
486 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
487 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
488
489 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
490 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
491 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
492 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
493 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
494 trad unwinders. The architecture specific changes, each involving a
495 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
496 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
497 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
498 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
499 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
500 Weigand.
501
502 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
503 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
504 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
505 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
506
507 @node Sample Session
508 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
509
510 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
511 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
512 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
513
514 @iftex
515 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
516 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
517 @end iftex
518
519 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
520 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
521
522 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
523 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
524 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
525 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
526 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
527 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
528 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
529 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
530 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
531
532 @smallexample
533 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
534 $ @b{./m4}
535 @b{define(foo,0000)}
536
537 @b{foo}
538 0000
539 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
540
541 @b{bar}
542 0000
543 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
544
545 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
546 @b{baz}
547 @b{Ctrl-d}
548 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
549 @end smallexample
550
551 @noindent
552 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
553
554 @smallexample
555 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
556 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
557 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
558 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
559 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
560 the conditions.
561 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
562 for details.
563
564 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
565 (@value{GDBP})
566 @end smallexample
567
568 @noindent
569 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
570 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
571 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
572 that examples fit in this manual.
573
574 @smallexample
575 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
576 @end smallexample
577
578 @noindent
579 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
580 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
581 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
582 @code{break} command.
583
584 @smallexample
585 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
586 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
587 @end smallexample
588
589 @noindent
590 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
591 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
592 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
593
594 @smallexample
595 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
596 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
597 @b{define(foo,0000)}
598
599 @b{foo}
600 0000
601 @end smallexample
602
603 @noindent
604 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
605 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
606 context where it stops.
607
608 @smallexample
609 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
610
611 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
612 at builtin.c:879
613 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
614 @end smallexample
615
616 @noindent
617 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
618 the next line of the current function.
619
620 @smallexample
621 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
622 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
623 : nil,
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
628 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
629 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
630 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
631
632 @smallexample
633 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
634 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
635 at input.c:530
636 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
637 @end smallexample
638
639 @noindent
640 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
641 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
642 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
643 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
644 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
645 stack frame for each active subroutine.
646
647 @smallexample
648 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
649 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
650 at input.c:530
651 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
652 at builtin.c:882
653 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
654 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
655 at macro.c:71
656 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
657 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
658 @end smallexample
659
660 @noindent
661 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
662 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
663 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
664
665 @smallexample
666 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
667 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
668 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
669 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
670 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
671 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
672 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
673 : xstrdup(rq);
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
675 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
676 @end smallexample
677
678 @noindent
679 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
680 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
681 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
682 (@code{print}) to see their values.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
686 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
687 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
688 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
689 @end smallexample
690
691 @noindent
692 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
693 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
694 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
695
696 @smallexample
697 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
698 533 xfree(rquote);
699 534
700 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
701 : xstrdup (lq);
702 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
703 : xstrdup (rq);
704 537
705 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
706 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
707 540 @}
708 541
709 542 void
710 @end smallexample
711
712 @noindent
713 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
714 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
715
716 @smallexample
717 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
718 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
719 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
720 540 @}
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
722 $3 = 9
723 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
724 $4 = 7
725 @end smallexample
726
727 @noindent
728 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
729 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
730 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
731 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
732 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
733 assignments.
734
735 @smallexample
736 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
737 $5 = 7
738 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
739 $6 = 9
740 @end smallexample
741
742 @noindent
743 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
744 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
745 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
746 example that caused trouble initially:
747
748 @smallexample
749 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
750 Continuing.
751
752 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
753
754 baz
755 0000
756 @end smallexample
757
758 @noindent
759 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
760 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
761 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
762
763 @smallexample
764 @b{Ctrl-d}
765 Program exited normally.
766 @end smallexample
767
768 @noindent
769 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
770 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
771 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
772
773 @smallexample
774 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
775 @end smallexample
776
777 @node Invocation
778 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
779
780 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
781 The essentials are:
782 @itemize @bullet
783 @item
784 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
785 @item
786 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
787 @end itemize
788
789 @menu
790 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
791 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
792 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
793 * Logging output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
794 @end menu
795
796 @node Invoking GDB
797 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
798
799 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
800 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
801
802 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
803 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
804
805 The command-line options described here are designed
806 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
807 options may effectively be unavailable.
808
809 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
810 specifying an executable program:
811
812 @smallexample
813 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
814 @end smallexample
815
816 @noindent
817 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
818 specified:
819
820 @smallexample
821 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
822 @end smallexample
823
824 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
825 to debug a running process:
826
827 @smallexample
828 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
829 @end smallexample
830
831 @noindent
832 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
833 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
834
835 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
836 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
837 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
838 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
839 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
840
841 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
842 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
843 option processing.
844 @smallexample
845 gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
846 @end smallexample
847 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
848 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
849
850 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
851 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
852
853 @smallexample
854 @value{GDBP} -silent
855 @end smallexample
856
857 @noindent
858 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
859 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
860
861 @noindent
862 Type
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} -help
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
870 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
871
872 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
873 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
874 @samp{-x} option is used.
875
876
877 @menu
878 * File Options:: Choosing files
879 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
880 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
881 @end menu
882
883 @node File Options
884 @subsection Choosing files
885
886 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
887 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
888 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
889 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
890 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
891 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
892 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
893 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
894 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
895 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
896 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
897 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
898 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
899
900 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
901 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
902 argument and ignore it.
903
904 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
905 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
906 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
907 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
908 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
909
910 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
911 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
912 @c it.
913
914 @table @code
915 @item -symbols @var{file}
916 @itemx -s @var{file}
917 @cindex @code{--symbols}
918 @cindex @code{-s}
919 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
920
921 @item -exec @var{file}
922 @itemx -e @var{file}
923 @cindex @code{--exec}
924 @cindex @code{-e}
925 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
926 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
927
928 @item -se @var{file}
929 @cindex @code{--se}
930 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
931 file.
932
933 @item -core @var{file}
934 @itemx -c @var{file}
935 @cindex @code{--core}
936 @cindex @code{-c}
937 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
938
939 @item -c @var{number}
940 @item -pid @var{number}
941 @itemx -p @var{number}
942 @cindex @code{--pid}
943 @cindex @code{-p}
944 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
945 If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
946 file named @var{number}.
947
948 @item -command @var{file}
949 @itemx -x @var{file}
950 @cindex @code{--command}
951 @cindex @code{-x}
952 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
953 Files,, Command files}.
954
955 @item -eval-command @var{command}
956 @itemx -ex @var{command}
957 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
958 @cindex @code{-ex}
959 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
960
961 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
962 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
963
964 @smallexample
965 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
966 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
967 @end smallexample
968
969 @item -directory @var{directory}
970 @itemx -d @var{directory}
971 @cindex @code{--directory}
972 @cindex @code{-d}
973 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
974
975 @item -r
976 @itemx -readnow
977 @cindex @code{--readnow}
978 @cindex @code{-r}
979 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
980 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
981 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
982
983 @end table
984
985 @node Mode Options
986 @subsection Choosing modes
987
988 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
989 batch mode or quiet mode.
990
991 @table @code
992 @item -nx
993 @itemx -n
994 @cindex @code{--nx}
995 @cindex @code{-n}
996 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
997 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
998 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
999 files}.
1000
1001 @item -quiet
1002 @itemx -silent
1003 @itemx -q
1004 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1005 @cindex @code{--silent}
1006 @cindex @code{-q}
1007 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1008 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1009
1010 @item -batch
1011 @cindex @code{--batch}
1012 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1013 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1014 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1015 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1016 in the command files.
1017
1018 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1019 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1020 make this more useful, the message
1021
1022 @smallexample
1023 Program exited normally.
1024 @end smallexample
1025
1026 @noindent
1027 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1028 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1029 mode.
1030
1031 @item -batch-silent
1032 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1033 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1034 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1035 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1036 for an interactive session.
1037
1038 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1039 messages, for example.
1040
1041 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1042 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1043
1044 @item -return-child-result
1045 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1046 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1047 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1048
1049 @itemize @bullet
1050 @item
1051 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1052 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1053 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1054 @item
1055 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1056 @item
1057 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1058 the exit code will be -1.
1059 @end itemize
1060
1061 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1062 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1063 interface.
1064
1065 @item -nowindows
1066 @itemx -nw
1067 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1068 @cindex @code{-nw}
1069 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1070 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1071 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1072
1073 @item -windows
1074 @itemx -w
1075 @cindex @code{--windows}
1076 @cindex @code{-w}
1077 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1078 used if possible.
1079
1080 @item -cd @var{directory}
1081 @cindex @code{--cd}
1082 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1083 instead of the current directory.
1084
1085 @item -fullname
1086 @itemx -f
1087 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1088 @cindex @code{-f}
1089 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1090 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1091 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1092 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1093 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1094 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1095 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1096 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1097 frame.
1098
1099 @item -epoch
1100 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1101 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1102 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1103 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1104 separate window.
1105
1106 @item -annotate @var{level}
1107 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1108 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1109 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1110 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1111 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1112 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1113 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1114 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1115 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1116
1117 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1118 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1119
1120 @item --args
1121 @cindex @code{--args}
1122 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1123 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1124 This option stops option processing.
1125
1126 @item -baud @var{bps}
1127 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1128 @cindex @code{--baud}
1129 @cindex @code{-b}
1130 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1131 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1132
1133 @item -l @var{timeout}
1134 @cindex @code{-l}
1135 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1136 for remote debugging.
1137
1138 @item -tty @var{device}
1139 @itemx -t @var{device}
1140 @cindex @code{--tty}
1141 @cindex @code{-t}
1142 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1143 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1144
1145 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1146 @item -tui
1147 @cindex @code{--tui}
1148 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1149 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1150 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1151 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1152 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1153 @samp{gdbtui}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1154 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1155
1156 @c @item -xdb
1157 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1158 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1159 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1160 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1161 @c systems.
1162
1163 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1164 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1165 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1166 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1167 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1168 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1169
1170 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1171 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1172 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1173 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1174 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1175 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1176
1177 @item -write
1178 @cindex @code{--write}
1179 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1180 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1181 (@pxref{Patching}).
1182
1183 @item -statistics
1184 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1185 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1186 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1187
1188 @item -version
1189 @cindex @code{--version}
1190 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1191 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1192
1193 @end table
1194
1195 @node Startup
1196 @subsection What @value{GDBN} does during startup
1197 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1198
1199 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1200
1201 @enumerate
1202 @item
1203 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1204 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1205
1206 @item
1207 @cindex init file
1208 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1209 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1210 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1211 that file.
1212
1213 @item
1214 Processes command line options and operands.
1215
1216 @item
1217 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1218 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1219 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1220 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1221 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1222 @value{GDBN}.
1223
1224 @item
1225 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1226 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1227
1228 @item
1229 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1230 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1231 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1232 @end enumerate
1233
1234 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1235 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1236 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1237 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1238 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1239 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
1240
1241 @cindex init file name
1242 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1243 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1244 On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
1245 different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
1246 form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
1247 different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
1248 environments with special init file names:
1249
1250 @itemize @bullet
1251 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1252 @item
1253 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1254 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1255 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1256 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1257 the file to the standard name.
1258
1259 @cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
1260 @item
1261 VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
1262
1263 @cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
1264 @item
1265 OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
1266
1267 @cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
1268 @item
1269 ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
1270
1271 @item
1272 CISCO 68k: @file{.cisco-gdbinit}
1273 @end itemize
1274
1275
1276 @node Quitting GDB
1277 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1278 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1279 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1280
1281 @table @code
1282 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1283 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1284 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1285 @itemx q
1286 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1287 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1288 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1289 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1290 error code.
1291 @end table
1292
1293 @cindex interrupt
1294 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1295 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1296 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1297 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1298 until a time when it is safe.
1299
1300 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1301 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1302 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
1303
1304 @node Shell Commands
1305 @section Shell commands
1306
1307 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1308 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1309 just use the @code{shell} command.
1310
1311 @table @code
1312 @kindex shell
1313 @cindex shell escape
1314 @item shell @var{command string}
1315 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1316 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1317 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1318 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1319 @end table
1320
1321 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1322 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1323 @value{GDBN}:
1324
1325 @table @code
1326 @kindex make
1327 @cindex calling make
1328 @item make @var{make-args}
1329 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1330 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1331 @end table
1332
1333 @node Logging output
1334 @section Logging output
1335 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1336 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1337
1338 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1339 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1340
1341 @table @code
1342 @kindex set logging
1343 @item set logging on
1344 Enable logging.
1345 @item set logging off
1346 Disable logging.
1347 @cindex logging file name
1348 @item set logging file @var{file}
1349 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1350 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1351 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1352 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1353 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1354 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1355 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1356 @kindex show logging
1357 @item show logging
1358 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1359 @end table
1360
1361 @node Commands
1362 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1363
1364 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1365 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1366 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1367 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1368 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1369
1370 @menu
1371 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1372 * Completion:: Command completion
1373 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1374 @end menu
1375
1376 @node Command Syntax
1377 @section Command syntax
1378
1379 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1380 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1381 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1382 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1383 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1384 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1385
1386 @cindex abbreviation
1387 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1388 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1389 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1390 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1391 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1392 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1393 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1394
1395 @cindex repeating commands
1396 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1397 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1398 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1399 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1400 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1401 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1402 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1403
1404 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1405 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1406 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1407
1408 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1409 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1410 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1411 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1412 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1413
1414 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1415 @cindex comment
1416 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1417 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1418 Files,,Command files}).
1419
1420 @cindex repeating command sequences
1421 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1422 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1423 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1424 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1425 for editing.
1426
1427 @node Completion
1428 @section Command completion
1429
1430 @cindex completion
1431 @cindex word completion
1432 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1433 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1434 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1435 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1436
1437 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1438 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1439 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1440 enter it). For example, if you type
1441
1442 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1443 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1444 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1445 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1446 @smallexample
1447 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1448 @end smallexample
1449
1450 @noindent
1451 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1452 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1453
1454 @smallexample
1455 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1456 @end smallexample
1457
1458 @noindent
1459 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1460 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1461 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1462 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1463 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1464 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1465
1466 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1467 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1468 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1469 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1470 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1471 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1472 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1473 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1474 example:
1475
1476 @smallexample
1477 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1478 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1479 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1480 make_abs_section make_function_type
1481 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1482 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1483 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1484 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1485 @end smallexample
1486
1487 @noindent
1488 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1489 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1490 command.
1491
1492 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1493 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1494 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1495 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1496 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1497
1498 @cindex quotes in commands
1499 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1500 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1501 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1502 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1503 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1504 @value{GDBN} commands.
1505
1506 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1507 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1508 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1509 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1510 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1511 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1512 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1513 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1514 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1515 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1516 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1517
1518 @smallexample
1519 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1520 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1521 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1522 @end smallexample
1523
1524 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1525 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1526 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1527 place:
1528
1529 @smallexample
1530 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1531 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1532 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1533 @end smallexample
1534
1535 @noindent
1536 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1537 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1538 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1539
1540 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
1541 expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1542 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1543 see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
1544
1545
1546 @node Help
1547 @section Getting help
1548 @cindex online documentation
1549 @kindex help
1550
1551 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1552 using the command @code{help}.
1553
1554 @table @code
1555 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1556 @item help
1557 @itemx h
1558 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1559 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1560
1561 @smallexample
1562 (@value{GDBP}) help
1563 List of classes of commands:
1564
1565 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1566 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1567 data -- Examining data
1568 files -- Specifying and examining files
1569 internals -- Maintenance commands
1570 obscure -- Obscure features
1571 running -- Running the program
1572 stack -- Examining the stack
1573 status -- Status inquiries
1574 support -- Support facilities
1575 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1576 stopping the program
1577 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1578
1579 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1580 commands in that class.
1581 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1582 documentation.
1583 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1584 (@value{GDBP})
1585 @end smallexample
1586 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1587
1588 @item help @var{class}
1589 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1590 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1591 help display for the class @code{status}:
1592
1593 @smallexample
1594 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1595 Status inquiries.
1596
1597 List of commands:
1598
1599 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1600 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1601 info -- Generic command for showing things
1602 about the program being debugged
1603 show -- Generic command for showing things
1604 about the debugger
1605
1606 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1607 documentation.
1608 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1609 (@value{GDBP})
1610 @end smallexample
1611
1612 @item help @var{command}
1613 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1614 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1615
1616 @kindex apropos
1617 @item apropos @var{args}
1618 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1619 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1620 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1621
1622 @smallexample
1623 apropos reload
1624 @end smallexample
1625
1626 @noindent
1627 results in:
1628
1629 @smallexample
1630 @c @group
1631 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1632 multiple times in one run
1633 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1634 multiple times in one run
1635 @c @end group
1636 @end smallexample
1637
1638 @kindex complete
1639 @item complete @var{args}
1640 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1641 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1642 command you want completed. For example:
1643
1644 @smallexample
1645 complete i
1646 @end smallexample
1647
1648 @noindent results in:
1649
1650 @smallexample
1651 @group
1652 if
1653 ignore
1654 info
1655 inspect
1656 @end group
1657 @end smallexample
1658
1659 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1660 @end table
1661
1662 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1663 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1664 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1665 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1666 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1667 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1668
1669 @c @group
1670 @table @code
1671 @kindex info
1672 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1673 @item info
1674 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1675 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1676 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1677 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1678 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1679 @w{@code{help info}}.
1680
1681 @kindex set
1682 @item set
1683 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1684 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1685 @code{set prompt $}.
1686
1687 @kindex show
1688 @item show
1689 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1690 @value{GDBN} itself.
1691 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1692 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1693 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1694 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1695
1696 @kindex info set
1697 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1698 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1699 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1700 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1701 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1702 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1703 @end table
1704 @c @end group
1705
1706 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1707 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1708
1709 @table @code
1710 @kindex show version
1711 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1712 @item show version
1713 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1714 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1715 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1716 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1717 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1718 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1719 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1720 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1721 @value{GDBN}.
1722
1723 @kindex show copying
1724 @kindex info copying
1725 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1726 @item show copying
1727 @itemx info copying
1728 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1729
1730 @kindex show warranty
1731 @kindex info warranty
1732 @item show warranty
1733 @itemx info warranty
1734 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1735 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1736
1737 @end table
1738
1739 @node Running
1740 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1741
1742 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1743 debugging information when you compile it.
1744
1745 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1746 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1747 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1748 kill a child process.
1749
1750 @menu
1751 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1752 * Starting:: Starting your program
1753 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1754 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1755
1756 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1757 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1758 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1759 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1760
1761 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1762 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1763 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1764 @end menu
1765
1766 @node Compilation
1767 @section Compiling for debugging
1768
1769 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1770 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1771 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1772 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1773 and addresses in the executable code.
1774
1775 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1776 the compiler.
1777
1778 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1779 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1780 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1781 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1782 executables containing debugging information.
1783
1784 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1785 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1786 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1787 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1788 in pushing your luck.
1789
1790 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1791 @cindex debugging optimized code
1792 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1793 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1794 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1795 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1796 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1797 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1798
1799 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1800 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1801 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1802 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1803 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1804
1805 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1806 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1807 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1808
1809 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1810 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1811 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1812 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1813 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1814 provides macro information if you specify the options
1815 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1816 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1817 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1818 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1819 @option{-g} alone.
1820
1821 @need 2000
1822 @node Starting
1823 @section Starting your program
1824 @cindex starting
1825 @cindex running
1826
1827 @table @code
1828 @kindex run
1829 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1830 @item run
1831 @itemx r
1832 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1833 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1834 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1835 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1836 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1837
1838 @end table
1839
1840 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1841 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1842 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1843 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1844
1845 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1846 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1847 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1848 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1849 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1850 divided into four categories:
1851
1852 @table @asis
1853 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1854 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1855 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1856 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1857 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1858 the arguments.
1859 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1860 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1861 @xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1862
1863 @item The @emph{environment.}
1864 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1865 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1866 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1867 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1868
1869 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1870 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1871 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1872 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1873
1874 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1875 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1876 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1877 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1878 set a different device for your program.
1879 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1880
1881 @cindex pipes
1882 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1883 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1884 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1885 wrong program.
1886 @end table
1887
1888 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1889 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1890 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1891 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1892 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1893
1894 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1895 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1896 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1897 your current breakpoints.
1898
1899 @table @code
1900 @kindex start
1901 @item start
1902 @cindex run to main procedure
1903 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1904 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1905 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1906 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1907 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1908 procedure, depending on the language used.
1909
1910 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1911 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1912 the @samp{run} command.
1913
1914 @cindex elaboration phase
1915 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1916 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1917 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1918 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1919 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1920 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1921 will remain to halt execution.
1922
1923 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1924 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1925 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1926 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1927 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1928
1929 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1930 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1931 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1932 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1933 elaboration code before running your program.
1934 @end table
1935
1936 @node Arguments
1937 @section Your program's arguments
1938
1939 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1940 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1941 @code{run} command.
1942 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1943 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1944 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1945 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1946 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1947
1948 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1949 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1950 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1951 the program, not by the shell.
1952
1953 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1954 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1955
1956 @table @code
1957 @kindex set args
1958 @item set args
1959 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1960 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1961 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1962 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1963 it again without arguments.
1964
1965 @kindex show args
1966 @item show args
1967 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1968 @end table
1969
1970 @node Environment
1971 @section Your program's environment
1972
1973 @cindex environment (of your program)
1974 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1975 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1976 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1977 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1978 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1979 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1980 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1981
1982 @table @code
1983 @kindex path
1984 @item path @var{directory}
1985 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1986 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1987 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1988 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1989 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1990 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1991 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1992
1993 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1994 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1995 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1996 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1997 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1998 @var{directory} to the search path.
1999 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2000 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2001
2002 @kindex show paths
2003 @item show paths
2004 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2005 environment variable).
2006
2007 @kindex show environment
2008 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2009 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2010 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2011 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2012 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2013
2014 @kindex set environment
2015 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2016 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2017 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2018 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2019 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2020 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2021 null value.
2022 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2023 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2024
2025 For example, this command:
2026
2027 @smallexample
2028 set env USER = foo
2029 @end smallexample
2030
2031 @noindent
2032 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2033 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2034 are not actually required.)
2035
2036 @kindex unset environment
2037 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2038 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2039 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2040 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2041 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2042 @end table
2043
2044 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2045 the shell indicated
2046 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2047 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2048 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2049 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2050 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2051 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2052 @file{.profile}.
2053
2054 @node Working Directory
2055 @section Your program's working directory
2056
2057 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2058 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2059 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2060 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2061 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2062 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2063
2064 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2065 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2066 specify files}.
2067
2068 @table @code
2069 @kindex cd
2070 @cindex change working directory
2071 @item cd @var{directory}
2072 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2073
2074 @kindex pwd
2075 @item pwd
2076 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2077 @end table
2078
2079 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2080 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2081 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2082 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2083 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2084 current working directory of the debuggee.
2085
2086 @node Input/Output
2087 @section Your program's input and output
2088
2089 @cindex redirection
2090 @cindex i/o
2091 @cindex terminal
2092 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2093 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2094 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2095 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2096 running your program.
2097
2098 @table @code
2099 @kindex info terminal
2100 @item info terminal
2101 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2102 program is using.
2103 @end table
2104
2105 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2106 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2107
2108 @smallexample
2109 run > outfile
2110 @end smallexample
2111
2112 @noindent
2113 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2114
2115 @kindex tty
2116 @cindex controlling terminal
2117 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2118 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2119 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2120 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2121 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2122
2123 @smallexample
2124 tty /dev/ttyb
2125 @end smallexample
2126
2127 @noindent
2128 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2129 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2130 that as their controlling terminal.
2131
2132 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2133 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2134 terminal.
2135
2136 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2137 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2138 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2139 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2140
2141 @cindex inferior tty
2142 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2143 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2144 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2145 program.
2146
2147 @table @code
2148 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2149 @kindex set inferior-tty
2150 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2151
2152 @item show inferior-tty
2153 @kindex show inferior-tty
2154 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2155 @end table
2156
2157 @node Attach
2158 @section Debugging an already-running process
2159 @kindex attach
2160 @cindex attach
2161
2162 @table @code
2163 @item attach @var{process-id}
2164 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2165 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2166 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2167 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2168 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2169
2170 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2171 executing the command.
2172 @end table
2173
2174 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2175 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2176 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2177 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2178
2179 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2180 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2181 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2182 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
2183 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2184 Specify Files}.
2185
2186 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2187 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2188 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2189 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2190 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2191 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2192 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2193
2194 @table @code
2195 @kindex detach
2196 @item detach
2197 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2198 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2199 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2200 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2201 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2202 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2203 executing the command.
2204 @end table
2205
2206 If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
2207 attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
2208 for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
2209 control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
2210 confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
2211 messages}).
2212
2213 @node Kill Process
2214 @section Killing the child process
2215
2216 @table @code
2217 @kindex kill
2218 @item kill
2219 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2220 @end table
2221
2222 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2223 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2224 is running.
2225
2226 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2227 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2228 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2229 outside the debugger.
2230
2231 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2232 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2233 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2234 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2235 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2236 breakpoint settings).
2237
2238 @node Threads
2239 @section Debugging programs with multiple threads
2240
2241 @cindex threads of execution
2242 @cindex multiple threads
2243 @cindex switching threads
2244 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2245 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2246 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2247 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2248 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2249 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2250 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2251
2252 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2253 programs:
2254
2255 @itemize @bullet
2256 @item automatic notification of new threads
2257 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2258 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2259 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2260 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2261 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2262 @end itemize
2263
2264 @quotation
2265 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2266 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2267 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2268 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2269 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2270 like this:
2271
2272 @smallexample
2273 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2274 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2275 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2276 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2277 @end smallexample
2278 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2279 @c doesn't support threads"?
2280 @end quotation
2281
2282 @cindex focus of debugging
2283 @cindex current thread
2284 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2285 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2286 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2287 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2288 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2289
2290 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2291 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2292 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2293 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2294 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2295 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2296 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2297 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2298 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2299 LynxOS, you might see
2300
2301 @smallexample
2302 [New process 35 thread 27]
2303 @end smallexample
2304
2305 @noindent
2306 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2307 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2308 further qualifier.
2309
2310 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2311 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2312 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2313 @c program?
2314 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2315 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2316 @c threads ab initio?
2317
2318 @cindex thread number
2319 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2320 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2321 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2322
2323 @table @code
2324 @kindex info threads
2325 @item info threads
2326 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2327 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2328
2329 @enumerate
2330 @item
2331 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2332
2333 @item
2334 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2335
2336 @item
2337 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2338 @end enumerate
2339
2340 @noindent
2341 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2342 indicates the current thread.
2343
2344 For example,
2345 @end table
2346 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2347
2348 @smallexample
2349 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2350 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2351 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2352 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2353 at threadtest.c:68
2354 @end smallexample
2355
2356 On HP-UX systems:
2357
2358 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2359 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2360 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2361 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2362 thread in your program.
2363
2364 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2365 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2366 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2367 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2368 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2369 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2370 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2371 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2372 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2373 HP-UX, you see
2374
2375 @smallexample
2376 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2377 @end smallexample
2378
2379 @noindent
2380 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2381
2382 @table @code
2383 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2384 @item info threads
2385 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2386 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2387
2388 @enumerate
2389 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2390
2391 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2392
2393 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2394 @end enumerate
2395
2396 @noindent
2397 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2398 indicates the current thread.
2399
2400 For example,
2401 @end table
2402 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2403
2404 @smallexample
2405 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2406 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2407 at quicksort.c:137
2408 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2409 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2410 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2411 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2412 @end smallexample
2413
2414 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2415 Solaris-specific command:
2416
2417 @table @code
2418 @item maint info sol-threads
2419 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2420 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2421 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2422 @end table
2423
2424 @table @code
2425 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2426 @item thread @var{threadno}
2427 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2428 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2429 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2430 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2431 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2432
2433 @smallexample
2434 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2435 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2436 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2437 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2438 @end smallexample
2439
2440 @noindent
2441 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2442 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2443 threads.
2444
2445 @kindex thread apply
2446 @cindex apply command to several threads
2447 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2448 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2449 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2450 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2451 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2452 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2453 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2454 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2455 @end table
2456
2457 @cindex automatic thread selection
2458 @cindex switching threads automatically
2459 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2460 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2461 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2462 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2463 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2464 thread.
2465
2466 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2467 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2468 programs with multiple threads.
2469
2470 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2471 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2472
2473 @node Processes
2474 @section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2475
2476 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2477 @cindex multiple processes
2478 @cindex processes, multiple
2479 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2480 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2481 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2482 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2483 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2484 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2485 will cause it to terminate.
2486
2487 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2488 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2489 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2490 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2491 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2492 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2493 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2494 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2495 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2496 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2497
2498 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2499 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2500 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2501 only?) and GNU/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2502
2503 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2504 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2505
2506 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2507 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2508
2509 @table @code
2510 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2511 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2512 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2513 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2514 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2515
2516 @table @code
2517 @item parent
2518 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2519 unimpeded. This is the default.
2520
2521 @item child
2522 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2523 unimpeded.
2524
2525 @end table
2526
2527 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2528 @item show follow-fork-mode
2529 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2530 @end table
2531
2532 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2533 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2534 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2535
2536 @table @code
2537 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2538 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2539 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2540 retain debugger control over them both.
2541
2542 @table @code
2543 @item on
2544 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2545 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2546 independently. This is the default.
2547
2548 @item off
2549 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2550 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2551 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2552 is held suspended.
2553
2554 @end table
2555
2556 @kindex show detach-on-follow
2557 @item show detach-on-follow
2558 Show whether detach-on-follow mode is on/off.
2559 @end table
2560
2561 If you choose to set @var{detach-on-follow} mode off, then
2562 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2563 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2564 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2565 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2566
2567 @table @code
2568 @kindex info forks
2569 @item info forks
2570 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2571 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2572 position (program counter) of the process.
2573
2574
2575 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2576 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2577 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2578 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2579 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2580
2581 @end table
2582
2583 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2584 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2585 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2586 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2587
2588 @table @code
2589 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2590 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2591 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2592 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2593 allowed to run independently.
2594
2595 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2596 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2597 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2598 and remove it from the fork list.
2599
2600 @end table
2601
2602 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2603 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2604 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2605 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2606 the child process's @code{main}.
2607
2608 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2609 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2610
2611 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2612 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2613 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2614 argument.
2615
2616 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2617 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2618 Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
2619
2620 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2621 @section Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
2622
2623 @cindex checkpoint
2624 @cindex restart
2625 @cindex bookmark
2626 @cindex snapshot of a process
2627 @cindex rewind program state
2628
2629 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2630 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2631 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2632 later.
2633
2634 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2635 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2636 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2637 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2638 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2639
2640 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2641 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2642 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2643 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2644 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2645 start again from there.
2646
2647 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2648 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2649
2650 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2651
2652 @table @code
2653 @kindex checkpoint
2654 @item checkpoint
2655 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2656 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2657 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2658
2659 @kindex info checkpoints
2660 @item info checkpoints
2661 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2662 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2663 listed:
2664
2665 @table @code
2666 @item Checkpoint ID
2667 @item Process ID
2668 @item Code Address
2669 @item Source line, or label
2670 @end table
2671
2672 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2673 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2674 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2675 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2676 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2677 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2678 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2679
2680 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2681 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2682 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2683 the debugger.
2684
2685 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2686 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2687 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2688
2689 @end table
2690
2691 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2692 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2693 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2694 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2695 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2696 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2697 previously read data can be read again.
2698
2699 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2700 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2701 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2702 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2703 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2704 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2705
2706 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2707 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2708 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2709 different execution path this time.
2710
2711 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2712 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2713 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2714 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2715 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2716 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2717 potentially pose a problem.
2718
2719 @subsection A non-obvious benefit of using checkpoints
2720
2721 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2722 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2723 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2724 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2725 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2726 next.
2727
2728 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2729 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2730 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2731 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2732 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2733
2734 @node Stopping
2735 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2736
2737 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2738 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2739 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2740
2741 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2742 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2743 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2744 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2745 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2746 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2747 explicitly request this information at any time.
2748
2749 @table @code
2750 @kindex info program
2751 @item info program
2752 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2753 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2754 @end table
2755
2756 @menu
2757 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2758 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2759 * Signals:: Signals
2760 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2761 @end menu
2762
2763 @node Breakpoints
2764 @section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2765
2766 @cindex breakpoints
2767 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2768 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2769 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2770 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2771 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2772 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2773 program.
2774
2775 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2776 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2777 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2778 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2779 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2780 call).
2781
2782 @cindex watchpoints
2783 @cindex data breakpoints
2784 @cindex memory tracing
2785 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2786 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2787 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2788 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2789 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2790 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2791 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2792 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting watchpoints}), but aside
2793 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2794 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2795 same commands.
2796
2797 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2798 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2799 Automatic display}.
2800
2801 @cindex catchpoints
2802 @cindex breakpoint on events
2803 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2804 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2805 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2806 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2807 catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2808 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2809 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2810
2811 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2812 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2813 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2814 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2815 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2816 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2817 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2818 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2819 enable it again.
2820
2821 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2822 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2823 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2824 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2825 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2826 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2827 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
2828
2829 @menu
2830 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2831 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2832 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2833 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2834 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2835 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2836 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2837 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2838 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2839 * Breakpoint related warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2840 @end menu
2841
2842 @node Set Breaks
2843 @subsection Setting breakpoints
2844
2845 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2846 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2847 @c
2848 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2849
2850 @kindex break
2851 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2852 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2853 @cindex latest breakpoint
2854 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2855 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2856 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2857 Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2858 convenience variables.
2859
2860 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2861
2862 @table @code
2863 @item break @var{function}
2864 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2865 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2866 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2867 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2868
2869 @item break +@var{offset}
2870 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2871 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2872 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2873 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2874
2875 @item break @var{linenum}
2876 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2877 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2878 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2879 code on that line.
2880
2881 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2882 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2883
2884 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2885 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2886 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2887 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2888 functions.
2889
2890 @item break *@var{address}
2891 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2892 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2893 information or source files.
2894
2895 @item break
2896 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2897 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2898 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2899 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2900 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2901 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2902 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2903 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2904 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2905 inside loops.
2906
2907 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2908 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2909 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2910 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2911 existed when your program stopped.
2912
2913 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2914 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2915 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2916 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2917 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2918 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2919 ,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2920
2921 @kindex tbreak
2922 @item tbreak @var{args}
2923 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2924 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2925 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2926 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2927
2928 @kindex hbreak
2929 @cindex hardware breakpoints
2930 @item hbreak @var{args}
2931 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2932 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2933 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2934 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2935 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2936 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2937 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2938 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2939 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2940 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2941 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2942 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2943 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2944 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2945 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2946 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2947 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2948
2949
2950 @kindex thbreak
2951 @item thbreak @var{args}
2952 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2953 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2954 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2955 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2956 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2957 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2958 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2959 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2960
2961 @kindex rbreak
2962 @cindex regular expression
2963 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2964 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2965 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2966 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2967 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2968 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2969 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2970 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2971 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2972
2973 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2974 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2975 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2976 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2977 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2978 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2979
2980 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
2981 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2982 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2983 classes.
2984
2985 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
2986 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
2987 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
2988
2989 @smallexample
2990 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
2991 @end smallexample
2992
2993 @kindex info breakpoints
2994 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2995 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2996 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2997 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2998 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2999 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3000 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
3001 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3002
3003 @table @emph
3004 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3005 @item Type
3006 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3007 @item Disposition
3008 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3009 @item Enabled or Disabled
3010 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3011 that are not enabled.
3012 @item Address
3013 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. If the
3014 breakpoint is pending (see below for details) on a future load of a shared library, the address
3015 will be listed as @samp{<PENDING>}.
3016 @item What
3017 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3018 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3019 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3020 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3021 @end table
3022
3023 @noindent
3024 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3025 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3026 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3027 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3028 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3029 valid location.
3030
3031 @noindent
3032 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3033 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3034 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3035 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3036 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
3037
3038 @noindent
3039 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3040 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3041 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3042 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3043 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3044 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3045 @end table
3046
3047 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3048 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3049 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3050 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3051
3052 @cindex pending breakpoints
3053 If a specified breakpoint location cannot be found, it may be due to the fact
3054 that the location is in a shared library that is yet to be loaded. In such
3055 a case, you may want @value{GDBN} to create a special breakpoint (known as
3056 a @dfn{pending breakpoint}) that
3057 attempts to resolve itself in the future when an appropriate shared library
3058 gets loaded.
3059
3060 Pending breakpoints are useful to set at the start of your
3061 @value{GDBN} session for locations that you know will be dynamically loaded
3062 later by the program being debugged. When shared libraries are loaded,
3063 a check is made to see if the load resolves any pending breakpoint locations.
3064 If a pending breakpoint location gets resolved,
3065 a regular breakpoint is created and the original pending breakpoint is removed.
3066
3067 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling pending
3068 breakpoint support:
3069
3070 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3071 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3072 @table @code
3073 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3074 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3075 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3076
3077 @item set breakpoint pending on
3078 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3079 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3080
3081 @item set breakpoint pending off
3082 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3083 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3084 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3085
3086 @item show breakpoint pending
3087 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3088 @end table
3089
3090 @cindex operations allowed on pending breakpoints
3091 Normal breakpoint operations apply to pending breakpoints as well. You may
3092 specify a condition for a pending breakpoint and/or commands to run when the
3093 breakpoint is reached. You can also enable or disable
3094 the pending breakpoint. When you specify a condition for a pending breakpoint,
3095 the parsing of the condition will be deferred until the point where the
3096 pending breakpoint location is resolved. Disabling a pending breakpoint
3097 tells @value{GDBN} to not attempt to resolve the breakpoint on any subsequent
3098 shared library load. When a pending breakpoint is re-enabled,
3099 @value{GDBN} checks to see if the location is already resolved.
3100 This is done because any number of shared library loads could have
3101 occurred since the time the breakpoint was disabled and one or more
3102 of these loads could resolve the location.
3103
3104 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3105 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3106 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3107 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3108 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3109 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3110 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3111 breakpoints.
3112
3113 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3114
3115 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3116 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3117 @table @code
3118 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3119 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3120 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3121 breakpoint must be used.
3122
3123 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3124 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3125 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3126 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3127 @end table
3128
3129
3130 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3131 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3132 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3133 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3134 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3135 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3136 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3137 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3138
3139
3140 @node Set Watchpoints
3141 @subsection Setting watchpoints
3142
3143 @cindex setting watchpoints
3144 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3145 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3146 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3147 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3148 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3149
3150 @itemize @bullet
3151 @item
3152 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3153
3154 @item
3155 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3156 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3157 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3158
3159 @item
3160 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3161 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3162 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3163 @end itemize
3164
3165 @cindex software watchpoints
3166 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3167 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3168 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3169 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3170 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3171 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3172 culprit.)
3173
3174 On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3175 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3176 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3177
3178 @table @code
3179 @kindex watch
3180 @item watch @var{expr}
3181 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3182 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3183 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3184 to watch the value of a single variable:
3185
3186 @smallexample
3187 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3188 @end smallexample
3189
3190 @kindex rwatch
3191 @item rwatch @var{expr}
3192 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3193 by the program.
3194
3195 @kindex awatch
3196 @item awatch @var{expr}
3197 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3198 or written into by the program.
3199
3200 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3201 @item info watchpoints
3202 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3203 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3204 @end table
3205
3206 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3207 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3208 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3209 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3210 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3211 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3212
3213 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3214 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3215 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3216 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3217 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3218 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3219 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3220 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3221
3222 @table @code
3223 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3224 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3225 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3226
3227 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3228 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3229 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3230 @end table
3231
3232 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3233 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3234 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3235
3236 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3237
3238 @smallexample
3239 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3240 @end smallexample
3241
3242 @noindent
3243 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3244
3245 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3246 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3247 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3248 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3249 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3250 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3251 will print a message like this:
3252
3253 @smallexample
3254 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3255 @end smallexample
3256
3257 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3258 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3259 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3260 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3261 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3262 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3263 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3264 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3265
3266 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3267 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3268 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3269 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3270 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3271 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3272
3273 @smallexample
3274 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3275 @end smallexample
3276
3277 @noindent
3278 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3279
3280 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3281 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3282 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3283 expression with separately allocated resources.
3284
3285 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
3286 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
3287 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
3288 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
3289 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
3290 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
3291 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
3292 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
3293 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
3294 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
3295
3296 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3297 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3298 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3299
3300 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3301 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3302 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3303 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3304 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3305 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3306 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3307 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3308 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3309
3310 @quotation
3311 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3312 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3313 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
3314 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
3315 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
3316 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
3317 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
3318 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
3319 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
3320 the expression.
3321
3322 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
3323 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
3324 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3325 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3326 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3327 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3328 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3329 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3330 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3331 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3332 @end quotation
3333
3334 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3335
3336 @node Set Catchpoints
3337 @subsection Setting catchpoints
3338 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3339 @cindex exception handlers
3340 @cindex event handling
3341
3342 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3343 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3344 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3345
3346 @table @code
3347 @kindex catch
3348 @item catch @var{event}
3349 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3350 @table @code
3351 @item throw
3352 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3353 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3354
3355 @item catch
3356 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3357
3358 @item exception
3359 @cindex Ada exception catching
3360 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3361 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3362 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3363 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3364 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3365
3366 @item exception unhandled
3367 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3368
3369 @item assert
3370 A failed Ada assertion.
3371
3372 @item exec
3373 @cindex break on fork/exec
3374 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3375
3376 @item fork
3377 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3378
3379 @item vfork
3380 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3381
3382 @item load
3383 @itemx load @var{libname}
3384 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3385 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3386 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3387
3388 @item unload
3389 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3390 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3391 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3392 @end table
3393
3394 @item tcatch @var{event}
3395 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3396 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3397
3398 @end table
3399
3400 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3401
3402 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3403 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3404
3405 @itemize @bullet
3406 @item
3407 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3408 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3409 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3410 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3411 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3412 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3413 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3414 disabled within interactive calls.
3415
3416 @item
3417 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3418
3419 @item
3420 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3421 @end itemize
3422
3423 @cindex raise exceptions
3424 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3425 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3426 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3427 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3428 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3429 out where the exception was raised.
3430
3431 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3432 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3433 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3434 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3435
3436 @smallexample
3437 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3438 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3439 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3440 @end smallexample
3441
3442 @noindent
3443 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3444 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3445 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
3446
3447 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
3448 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3449 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3450 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3451 raised.
3452
3453
3454 @node Delete Breaks
3455 @subsection Deleting breakpoints
3456
3457 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3458 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3459 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3460 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3461 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3462 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3463
3464 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3465 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3466 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3467 their breakpoint numbers.
3468
3469 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3470 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3471 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3472
3473 @table @code
3474 @kindex clear
3475 @item clear
3476 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3477 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
3478 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3479 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3480
3481 @item clear @var{function}
3482 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3483 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3484
3485 @item clear @var{linenum}
3486 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3487 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3488 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3489
3490 @cindex delete breakpoints
3491 @kindex delete
3492 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3493 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3494 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3495 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3496 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3497 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3498 @end table
3499
3500 @node Disabling
3501 @subsection Disabling breakpoints
3502
3503 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3504 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3505 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3506 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3507 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3508
3509 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3510 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3511 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3512 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3513 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3514
3515 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3516 states of enablement:
3517
3518 @itemize @bullet
3519 @item
3520 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3521 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3522 @item
3523 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3524 @item
3525 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3526 disabled.
3527 @item
3528 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3529 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3530 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3531 @end itemize
3532
3533 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3534 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3535
3536 @table @code
3537 @kindex disable
3538 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3539 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3540 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3541 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3542 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3543 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3544 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3545
3546 @kindex enable
3547 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3548 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3549 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3550
3551 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3552 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3553 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3554
3555 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3556 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3557 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3558 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3559 @end table
3560
3561 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3562 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3563 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3564 ,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3565 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3566 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3567 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3568 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3569 stepping}.)
3570
3571 @node Conditions
3572 @subsection Break conditions
3573 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3574 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3575
3576 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3577 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3578 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3579 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3580 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3581 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3582 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3583 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3584
3585 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3586 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3587 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3588 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3589 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3590
3591 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3592 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3593 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3594 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3595 one.
3596
3597 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3598 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3599 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3600 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3601 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3602 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3603 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3604 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3605 conditions for the
3606 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3607 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3608
3609 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3610 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3611 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3612 with the @code{condition} command.
3613
3614 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3615 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3616 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3617 catchpoint.
3618
3619 @table @code
3620 @kindex condition
3621 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3622 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3623 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3624 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3625 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3626 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3627 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3628 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3629 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3630 prints an error message:
3631
3632 @smallexample
3633 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3634 @end smallexample
3635
3636 @noindent
3637 @value{GDBN} does
3638 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3639 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3640 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3641
3642 @item condition @var{bnum}
3643 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3644 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3645 @end table
3646
3647 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3648 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3649 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3650 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3651 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3652 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3653 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3654 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3655 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3656 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3657 your program reaches it.
3658
3659 @table @code
3660 @kindex ignore
3661 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3662 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3663 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3664 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3665 takes no action.
3666
3667 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3668 a count of zero.
3669
3670 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3671 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3672 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3673 Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3674
3675 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3676 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3677 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3678
3679 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3680 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3681 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3682 variables}.
3683 @end table
3684
3685 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3686
3687
3688 @node Break Commands
3689 @subsection Breakpoint command lists
3690
3691 @cindex breakpoint commands
3692 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3693 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3694 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3695 enable other breakpoints.
3696
3697 @table @code
3698 @kindex commands
3699 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3700 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3701 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3702 @itemx end
3703 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3704 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3705 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3706
3707 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3708 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3709
3710 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3711 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3712 recently encountered).
3713 @end table
3714
3715 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3716 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3717
3718 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3719 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3720 that resumes execution.
3721
3722 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3723 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3724 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3725 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3726 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3727
3728 @kindex silent
3729 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3730 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3731 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3732 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3733 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3734 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3735
3736 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3737 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3738 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3739
3740 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3741 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3742
3743 @smallexample
3744 break foo if x>0
3745 commands
3746 silent
3747 printf "x is %d\n",x
3748 cont
3749 end
3750 @end smallexample
3751
3752 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3753 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3754 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3755 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3756 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3757 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3758 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3759
3760 @smallexample
3761 break 403
3762 commands
3763 silent
3764 set x = y + 4
3765 cont
3766 end
3767 @end smallexample
3768
3769 @node Breakpoint Menus
3770 @subsection Breakpoint menus
3771 @cindex overloading
3772 @cindex symbol overloading
3773
3774 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3775 single function name
3776 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3777 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3778 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3779 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3780 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3781 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3782 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3783 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3784 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3785 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3786 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3787 breakpoints.
3788
3789 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3790 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3791 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3792
3793 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3794 @smallexample
3795 @group
3796 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3797 [0] cancel
3798 [1] all
3799 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3800 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3801 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3802 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3803 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3804 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3805 > 2 4 6
3806 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3807 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3808 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3809 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3810 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3811 breakpoints.
3812 (@value{GDBP})
3813 @end group
3814 @end smallexample
3815
3816 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3817 @node Error in Breakpoints
3818 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3819 @c
3820 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3821 @c
3822 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3823 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3824 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3825 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3826
3827 @smallexample
3828 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3829 The same program may be running in another process.
3830 @end smallexample
3831
3832 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3833
3834 @enumerate
3835 @item
3836 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3837
3838 @item
3839 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3840 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3841 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3842 Then start your program again.
3843
3844 @item
3845 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3846 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3847 to nonsharable executables.
3848 @end enumerate
3849 @c @end ifclear
3850
3851 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3852 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3853
3854 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3855 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3856 @smallexample
3857 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3858 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3859 @end smallexample
3860
3861 @noindent
3862 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3863 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3864 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3865
3866 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3867 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3868
3869 @node Breakpoint related warnings
3870 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3871 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3872
3873 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3874 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3875 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3876 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3877
3878 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3879 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3880 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3881 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3882 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3883 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3884 first in the bundle.
3885
3886 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3887 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3888 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3889 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3890 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3891 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3892 is hit.
3893
3894 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3895 that's been subject to address adjustment:
3896
3897 @smallexample
3898 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3899 @end smallexample
3900
3901 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3902 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3903 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3904 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3905 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3906 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3907 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3908 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3909
3910 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3911 adjusted breakpoints:
3912
3913 @smallexample
3914 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3915 to 0x00010410.
3916 @end smallexample
3917
3918 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3919 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3920 frequently than expected.
3921
3922 @node Continuing and Stepping
3923 @section Continuing and stepping
3924
3925 @cindex stepping
3926 @cindex continuing
3927 @cindex resuming execution
3928 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3929 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3930 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3931 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3932 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3933 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3934 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3935 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3936
3937 @table @code
3938 @kindex continue
3939 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3940 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3941 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3942 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3943 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3944 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3945 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3946 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3947 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3948 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3949
3950 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3951 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3952 @code{continue} is ignored.
3953
3954 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3955 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3956 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3957 @code{continue}.
3958 @end table
3959
3960 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3961 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3962 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3963 different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3964
3965 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3966 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3967 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3968 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3969 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3970 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3971
3972 @table @code
3973 @kindex step
3974 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3975 @item step
3976 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3977 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3978 abbreviated @code{s}.
3979
3980 @quotation
3981 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3982 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3983 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3984 @c distinction here.
3985 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3986 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3987 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3988 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3989 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3990 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3991 below.
3992 @end quotation
3993
3994 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3995 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3996 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3997 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3998 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3999 called within the line.
4000
4001 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4002 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4003 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4004 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4005 was any debugging information about the routine.
4006
4007 @item step @var{count}
4008 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4009 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4010 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4011
4012 @kindex next
4013 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4014 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4015 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4016 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4017 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4018 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4019 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4020 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4021
4022 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4023
4024
4025 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4026 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4027 @c
4028 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4029 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4030 @c function are executed without stopping.
4031
4032 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4033 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4034 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4035
4036 @kindex set step-mode
4037 @item set step-mode
4038 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4039 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4040 @itemx set step-mode on
4041 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4042 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4043 information rather than stepping over it.
4044
4045 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4046 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4047 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4048
4049 @item set step-mode off
4050 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4051 debug information. This is the default.
4052
4053 @item show step-mode
4054 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4055 source line debug information.
4056
4057 @kindex finish
4058 @item finish
4059 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4060 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
4061
4062 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4063 ,Returning from a function}).
4064
4065 @kindex until
4066 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4067 @cindex run until specified location
4068 @item until
4069 @itemx u
4070 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4071 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4072 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4073 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4074 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4075 than the address of the jump.
4076
4077 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4078 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4079 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4080 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4081 through the next iteration.
4082
4083 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4084 stack frame.
4085
4086 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4087 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4088 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4089 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4090 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4091
4092 @smallexample
4093 (@value{GDBP}) f
4094 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4095 206 expand_input();
4096 (@value{GDBP}) until
4097 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4098 @end smallexample
4099
4100 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4101 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4102 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4103 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4104 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4105 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4106 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4107
4108 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4109 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4110 argument.
4111
4112 @item until @var{location}
4113 @itemx u @var{location}
4114 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4115 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4116 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4117 ,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
4118 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4119 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4120 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4121 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4122 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4123 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e. after the inner
4124 invocations have returned.
4125
4126 @smallexample
4127 94 int factorial (int value)
4128 95 @{
4129 96 if (value > 1) @{
4130 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4131 98 @}
4132 99 return (value);
4133 100 @}
4134 @end smallexample
4135
4136
4137 @kindex advance @var{location}
4138 @itemx advance @var{location}
4139 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4140 required, which should be of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
4141 command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4142 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4143 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4144 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4145
4146
4147 @kindex stepi
4148 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4149 @item stepi
4150 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4151 @itemx si
4152 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4153
4154 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4155 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4156 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4157 Display,, Automatic display}.
4158
4159 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4160
4161 @need 750
4162 @kindex nexti
4163 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4164 @item nexti
4165 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4166 @itemx ni
4167 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4168 proceed until the function returns.
4169
4170 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4171 @end table
4172
4173 @node Signals
4174 @section Signals
4175 @cindex signals
4176
4177 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4178 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4179 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4180 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4181 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4182 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4183 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4184 requested an alarm).
4185
4186 @cindex fatal signals
4187 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4188 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4189 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4190 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4191 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4192 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4193
4194 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4195 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4196 signal.
4197
4198 @cindex handling signals
4199 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4200 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4201 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4202 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4203 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4204
4205 @table @code
4206 @kindex info signals
4207 @kindex info handle
4208 @item info signals
4209 @itemx info handle
4210 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4211 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4212 the defined types of signals.
4213
4214 @item info signals @var{sig}
4215 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4216
4217 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4218
4219 @kindex handle
4220 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4221 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4222 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4223 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4224 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4225 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4226 say what change to make.
4227 @end table
4228
4229 @c @group
4230 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4231 Their full names are:
4232
4233 @table @code
4234 @item nostop
4235 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4236 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4237
4238 @item stop
4239 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4240 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4241
4242 @item print
4243 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4244
4245 @item noprint
4246 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4247 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4248
4249 @item pass
4250 @itemx noignore
4251 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4252 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4253 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4254
4255 @item nopass
4256 @itemx ignore
4257 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4258 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4259 @end table
4260 @c @end group
4261
4262 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4263 program until you
4264 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4265 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4266 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4267 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4268 program sees that signal when you continue.
4269
4270 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4271 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4272 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4273 erroneous signals.
4274
4275 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4276 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4277 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4278 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4279 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4280 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4281 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4282 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4283 program a signal}.
4284
4285 @node Thread Stops
4286 @section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
4287
4288 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4289 programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
4290 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4291
4292 @table @code
4293 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4294 @cindex thread breakpoints
4295 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4296 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4297 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4298 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4299 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4300
4301 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4302 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4303 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4304 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4305 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4306
4307 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4308 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4309 program.
4310
4311 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4312 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4313 breakpoint condition, like this:
4314
4315 @smallexample
4316 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4317 @end smallexample
4318
4319 @end table
4320
4321 @cindex stopped threads
4322 @cindex threads, stopped
4323 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4324 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4325 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4326 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4327 underfoot.
4328
4329 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4330 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4331 @cindex premature return from system calls
4332 There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4333 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4334 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4335 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4336 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4337 stop execution.
4338
4339 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4340 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4341 style anyways.
4342
4343 For example, do not write code like this:
4344
4345 @smallexample
4346 sleep (10);
4347 @end smallexample
4348
4349 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4350 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4351
4352 Instead, write this:
4353
4354 @smallexample
4355 int unslept = 10;
4356 while (unslept > 0)
4357 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4358 @end smallexample
4359
4360 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4361 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4362 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4363 @value{GDBN}.
4364
4365 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4366 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4367 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4368 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4369
4370 @cindex continuing threads
4371 @cindex threads, continuing
4372 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4373 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4374 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4375
4376 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4377 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4378 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4379 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4380 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4381 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4382 stops.
4383
4384 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4385 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4386 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4387 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4388
4389 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4390 thread to run.
4391
4392 @table @code
4393 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4394 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4395 @cindex lock scheduler
4396 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4397 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4398 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4399 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4400 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4401 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4402 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4403 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4404 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4405 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4406 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4407
4408 @item show scheduler-locking
4409 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4410 @end table
4411
4412
4413 @node Stack
4414 @chapter Examining the Stack
4415
4416 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4417 stopped and how it got there.
4418
4419 @cindex call stack
4420 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4421 is generated.
4422 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4423 the arguments of the call,
4424 and the local variables of the function being called.
4425 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4426 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4427 stack}.
4428
4429 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4430 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4431
4432 @cindex selected frame
4433 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4434 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4435 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4436 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4437 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4438 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4439
4440 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4441 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4442 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
4443
4444 @menu
4445 * Frames:: Stack frames
4446 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4447 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4448 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4449
4450 @end menu
4451
4452 @node Frames
4453 @section Stack frames
4454
4455 @cindex frame, definition
4456 @cindex stack frame
4457 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4458 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4459 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4460 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4461 which the function is executing.
4462
4463 @cindex initial frame
4464 @cindex outermost frame
4465 @cindex innermost frame
4466 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4467 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4468 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4469 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4470 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4471 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4472 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4473 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4474
4475 @cindex frame pointer
4476 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4477 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4478 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4479 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4480 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4481 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4482
4483 @cindex frame number
4484 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4485 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4486 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4487 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4488 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4489
4490 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4491 @c underflow problems.
4492 @cindex frameless execution
4493 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4494 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
4495 @smallexample
4496 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4497 @end smallexample
4498 generates functions without a frame.)
4499 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4500 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4501 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4502 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4503 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4504 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4505 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4506
4507 @table @code
4508 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4509 @cindex current stack frame
4510 @item frame @var{args}
4511 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4512 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4513 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4514 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4515
4516 @kindex select-frame
4517 @cindex selecting frame silently
4518 @item select-frame
4519 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4520 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4521 @code{frame}.
4522 @end table
4523
4524 @node Backtrace
4525 @section Backtraces
4526
4527 @cindex traceback
4528 @cindex call stack traces
4529 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4530 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4531 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4532 stack.
4533
4534 @table @code
4535 @kindex backtrace
4536 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4537 @item backtrace
4538 @itemx bt
4539 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4540 frames in the stack.
4541
4542 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4543 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
4544
4545 @item backtrace @var{n}
4546 @itemx bt @var{n}
4547 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4548
4549 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4550 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4551 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4552
4553 @item backtrace full
4554 @itemx bt full
4555 @itemx bt full @var{n}
4556 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
4557 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
4558 number of frames to print, as described above.
4559 @end table
4560
4561 @kindex where
4562 @kindex info stack
4563 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4564 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4565
4566 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4567 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4568 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4569 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4570 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4571 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4572 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4573 multi-threaded program.
4574
4575 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4576 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4577 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4578 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4579 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4580 line number.
4581
4582 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4583 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4584
4585 @smallexample
4586 @group
4587 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4588 at builtin.c:993
4589 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4590 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4591 at macro.c:71
4592 (More stack frames follow...)
4593 @end group
4594 @end smallexample
4595
4596 @noindent
4597 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4598 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4599 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4600
4601 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4602 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4603 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4604 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4605 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4606 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4607 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4608 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4609 such a backtrace might look like:
4610
4611 @smallexample
4612 @group
4613 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4614 at builtin.c:993
4615 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4616 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4617 at macro.c:71
4618 (More stack frames follow...)
4619 @end group
4620 @end smallexample
4621
4622 @noindent
4623 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4624 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4625
4626 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4627 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4628 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4629
4630 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4631 @cindex program entry point
4632 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
4633 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4634 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4635 @code{main}@footnote{
4636 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4637 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4638 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4639 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4640 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4641 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4642
4643 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4644 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4645
4646 @table @code
4647 @item set backtrace past-main
4648 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
4649 @kindex set backtrace
4650 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4651
4652 @item set backtrace past-main off
4653 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4654 default.
4655
4656 @item show backtrace past-main
4657 @kindex show backtrace
4658 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4659
4660 @item set backtrace past-entry
4661 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4662 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4663 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4664 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4665
4666 @item set backtrace past-entry off
4667 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
4668 application. This is the default.
4669
4670 @item show backtrace past-entry
4671 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4672
4673 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4674 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4675 @cindex backtrace limit
4676 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4677 unlimited.
4678
4679 @item show backtrace limit
4680 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4681 @end table
4682
4683 @node Selection
4684 @section Selecting a frame
4685
4686 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4687 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4688 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4689 of the stack frame just selected.
4690
4691 @table @code
4692 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4693 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4694 @item frame @var{n}
4695 @itemx f @var{n}
4696 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4697 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4698 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4699 @code{main}.
4700
4701 @item frame @var{addr}
4702 @itemx f @var{addr}
4703 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4704 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4705 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4706 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4707 switches between them.
4708
4709 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4710 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4711
4712 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4713 pointer and a program counter.
4714
4715 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4716 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4717
4718 @kindex up
4719 @item up @var{n}
4720 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4721 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4722 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4723
4724 @kindex down
4725 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4726 @item down @var{n}
4727 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4728 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4729 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4730 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4731 @end table
4732
4733 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4734 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4735 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4736 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4737
4738 @need 1000
4739 For example:
4740
4741 @smallexample
4742 @group
4743 (@value{GDBP}) up
4744 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4745 at env.c:10
4746 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4747 @end group
4748 @end smallexample
4749
4750 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4751 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4752 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4753 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4754 @xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
4755 for details.
4756
4757 @table @code
4758 @kindex down-silently
4759 @kindex up-silently
4760 @item up-silently @var{n}
4761 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4762 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4763 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4764 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4765 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4766 distracting.
4767 @end table
4768
4769 @node Frame Info
4770 @section Information about a frame
4771
4772 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4773 stack frame.
4774
4775 @table @code
4776 @item frame
4777 @itemx f
4778 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4779 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4780 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4781 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4782 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4783
4784 @kindex info frame
4785 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4786 @item info frame
4787 @itemx info f
4788 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4789 including:
4790
4791 @itemize @bullet
4792 @item
4793 the address of the frame
4794 @item
4795 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4796 @item
4797 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4798 @item
4799 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4800 @item
4801 the address of the frame's arguments
4802 @item
4803 the address of the frame's local variables
4804 @item
4805 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4806 @item
4807 which registers were saved in the frame
4808 @end itemize
4809
4810 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4811 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4812 the usual conventions.
4813
4814 @item info frame @var{addr}
4815 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4816 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4817 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4818 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4819 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4820 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4821
4822 @kindex info args
4823 @item info args
4824 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4825
4826 @item info locals
4827 @kindex info locals
4828 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4829 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4830 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4831
4832 @kindex info catch
4833 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4834 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4835 @item info catch
4836 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4837 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4838 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4839 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4840 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
4841
4842 @end table
4843
4844
4845 @node Source
4846 @chapter Examining Source Files
4847
4848 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4849 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4850 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4851 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4852 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4853 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4854 source files by explicit command.
4855
4856 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4857 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4858 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4859
4860 @menu
4861 * List:: Printing source lines
4862 * Edit:: Editing source files
4863 * Search:: Searching source files
4864 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4865 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4866 @end menu
4867
4868 @node List
4869 @section Printing source lines
4870
4871 @kindex list
4872 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4873 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4874 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4875 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4876
4877 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4878
4879 @table @code
4880 @item list @var{linenum}
4881 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4882 current source file.
4883
4884 @item list @var{function}
4885 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4886 @var{function}.
4887
4888 @item list
4889 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4890 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4891 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4892 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4893 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4894
4895 @item list -
4896 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4897 @end table
4898
4899 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4900 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4901 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4902
4903 @table @code
4904 @kindex set listsize
4905 @item set listsize @var{count}
4906 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4907 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4908
4909 @kindex show listsize
4910 @item show listsize
4911 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4912 @end table
4913
4914 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4915 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4916 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4917 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4918 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4919
4920 @cindex linespec
4921 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4922 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4923 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4924 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4925
4926 @table @code
4927 @item list @var{linespec}
4928 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4929
4930 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4931 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4932 linespecs.
4933
4934 @item list ,@var{last}
4935 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4936
4937 @item list @var{first},
4938 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4939
4940 @item list +
4941 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4942
4943 @item list -
4944 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4945
4946 @item list
4947 As described in the preceding table.
4948 @end table
4949
4950 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4951 kinds of linespec.
4952
4953 @table @code
4954 @item @var{number}
4955 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4956 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4957 the same source file as the first linespec.
4958
4959 @item +@var{offset}
4960 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4961 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4962 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4963 first linespec.
4964
4965 @item -@var{offset}
4966 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4967
4968 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4969 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4970
4971 @item @var{function}
4972 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4973 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4974
4975 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4976 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4977 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4978 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4979 identically named functions in different source files.
4980
4981 @item *@var{address}
4982 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4983 @var{address} may be any expression.
4984 @end table
4985
4986 @node Edit
4987 @section Editing source files
4988 @cindex editing source files
4989
4990 @kindex edit
4991 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4992 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4993 The editing program of your choice
4994 is invoked with the current line set to
4995 the active line in the program.
4996 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4997 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4998
4999 Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
5000
5001 @table @code
5002 @item edit
5003 Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
5004
5005 @item edit @var{number}
5006 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
5007
5008 @item edit @var{function}
5009 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
5010
5011 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
5012 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
5013
5014 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
5015 Specifies the line that begins the body of the
5016 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
5017 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
5018 identically named functions in different source files.
5019
5020 @item edit *@var{address}
5021 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
5022 @var{address} may be any expression.
5023 @end table
5024
5025 @subsection Choosing your editor
5026 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5027 @footnote{
5028 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5029 following command-line syntax:
5030 @smallexample
5031 ex +@var{number} file
5032 @end smallexample
5033 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5034 the file where to start editing.}.
5035 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5036 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5037 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5038 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5039 @smallexample
5040 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5041 export EDITOR
5042 gdb @dots{}
5043 @end smallexample
5044 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5045 @smallexample
5046 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5047 gdb @dots{}
5048 @end smallexample
5049
5050 @node Search
5051 @section Searching source files
5052 @cindex searching source files
5053
5054 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5055 regular expression.
5056
5057 @table @code
5058 @kindex search
5059 @kindex forward-search
5060 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5061 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5062 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5063 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5064 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5065 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5066 @code{fo}.
5067
5068 @kindex reverse-search
5069 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5070 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5071 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5072 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5073 this command as @code{rev}.
5074 @end table
5075
5076 @node Source Path
5077 @section Specifying source directories
5078
5079 @cindex source path
5080 @cindex directories for source files
5081 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5082 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5083 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5084 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5085 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5086 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5087 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5088
5089 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5090 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5091 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5092 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5093 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5094 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5095 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5096 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5097 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5098 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5099 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5100
5101 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5102 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5103 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5104 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5105 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5106 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5107
5108 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5109 source files.
5110
5111 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5112 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5113 each line is in the file.
5114
5115 @kindex directory
5116 @kindex dir
5117 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5118 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5119 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5120
5121 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5122 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5123
5124 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5125 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5126 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5127 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5128 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5129 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5130 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5131 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5132 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5133 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5134 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5135 name to look up the sources.
5136
5137 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5138 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5139 GDB to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5140 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5141 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5142 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5143 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5144 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5145
5146 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5147 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5148 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5149 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5150 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5151 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5152 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5153
5154 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5155 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5156 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5157 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5158 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5159 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5160 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5161 command.
5162
5163 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5164 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5165 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5166 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5167 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5168 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5169 method available to point GDB at the new location.
5170
5171 @table @code
5172 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5173 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5174 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5175 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5176 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5177 part of absolute file names) or
5178 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5179 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5180
5181 @kindex cdir
5182 @kindex cwd
5183 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5184 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
5185 @cindex compilation directory
5186 @cindex current directory
5187 @cindex working directory
5188 @cindex directory, current
5189 @cindex directory, compilation
5190 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5191 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5192 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5193 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5194 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5195 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5196
5197 @item directory
5198 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5199
5200 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5201 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5202
5203 @item show directories
5204 @kindex show directories
5205 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5206
5207 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5208 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5209 @kindex set substitute-path
5210 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5211 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5212 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5213
5214 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5215 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5216
5217 @smallexample
5218 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5219 @end smallexample
5220
5221 @noindent
5222 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5223 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5224 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5225
5226 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5227 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5228 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5229 the substitution.
5230
5231 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5232
5233 @smallexample
5234 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5235 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5236 @end smallexample
5237
5238 @noindent
5239 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5240 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5241 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5242 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5243
5244
5245 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5246 @kindex unset substitute-path
5247 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5248 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5249 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5250
5251 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5252
5253 @item show substitute-path [path]
5254 @kindex show substitute-path
5255 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5256 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5257
5258 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5259 rules.
5260
5261 @end table
5262
5263 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5264 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5265 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5266
5267 @enumerate
5268 @item
5269 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5270
5271 @item
5272 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5273 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5274 directories in one command.
5275 @end enumerate
5276
5277 @node Machine Code
5278 @section Source and machine code
5279 @cindex source line and its code address
5280
5281 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5282 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5283 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5284 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5285 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5286 well as hex.
5287
5288 @table @code
5289 @kindex info line
5290 @item info line @var{linespec}
5291 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5292 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5293 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
5294 source lines}).
5295 @end table
5296
5297 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5298 the object code for the first line of function
5299 @code{m4_changequote}:
5300
5301 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5302 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5303 @smallexample
5304 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5305 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5306 @end smallexample
5307
5308 @noindent
5309 @cindex code address and its source line
5310 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5311 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5312 @smallexample
5313 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5314 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5315 @end smallexample
5316
5317 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5318 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5319 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5320 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5321 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5322 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5323 ,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5324 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5325 variables}).
5326
5327 @table @code
5328 @kindex disassemble
5329 @cindex assembly instructions
5330 @cindex instructions, assembly
5331 @cindex machine instructions
5332 @cindex listing machine instructions
5333 @item disassemble
5334 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5335 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5336 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5337 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5338 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5339 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5340 @end table
5341
5342 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5343 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5344
5345 @smallexample
5346 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5347 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5348 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5349 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5350 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5351 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5352 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5353 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5354 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5355 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5356 End of assembler dump.
5357 @end smallexample
5358
5359 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5360 mnemonics or other syntax.
5361
5362 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5363 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5364 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5365 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5366 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5367
5368 @table @code
5369 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5370 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5371 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5372 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5373 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5374 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5375
5376 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5377 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5378 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5379 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5380
5381 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5382 @item show disassembly-flavor
5383 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5384 @end table
5385
5386
5387 @node Data
5388 @chapter Examining Data
5389
5390 @cindex printing data
5391 @cindex examining data
5392 @kindex print
5393 @kindex inspect
5394 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5395 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5396 @c different window or something like that.
5397 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5398 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5399 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5400 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5401 Different Languages}).
5402
5403 @table @code
5404 @item print @var{expr}
5405 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5406 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5407 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5408 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5409 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5410 formats}.
5411
5412 @item print
5413 @itemx print /@var{f}
5414 @cindex reprint the last value
5415 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5416 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
5417 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5418 @end table
5419
5420 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5421 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5422 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5423
5424 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5425 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5426 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5427 Table}.
5428
5429 @menu
5430 * Expressions:: Expressions
5431 * Variables:: Program variables
5432 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5433 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5434 * Memory:: Examining memory
5435 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5436 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5437 * Value History:: Value history
5438 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5439 * Registers:: Registers
5440 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5441 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5442 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5443 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5444 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5445 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5446 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5447 character set than GDB does
5448 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5449 @end menu
5450
5451 @node Expressions
5452 @section Expressions
5453
5454 @cindex expressions
5455 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5456 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5457 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5458 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5459 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5460 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5461 @ref{Compilation}.
5462
5463 @cindex arrays in expressions
5464 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5465 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5466 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
5467 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5468
5469 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5470 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5471 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5472 languages.
5473
5474 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5475 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5476
5477 @cindex casts, in expressions
5478 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5479 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5480 at that address in memory.
5481 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5482
5483 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5484 to programming languages:
5485
5486 @table @code
5487 @item @@
5488 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5489 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
5490
5491 @item ::
5492 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5493 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
5494
5495 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
5496 @cindex type casting memory
5497 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5498 @cindex casts, to view memory
5499 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5500 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5501 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5502 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5503 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5504 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5505 @end table
5506
5507 @node Variables
5508 @section Program variables
5509
5510 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5511 in your program.
5512
5513 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5514 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
5515
5516 @itemize @bullet
5517 @item
5518 global (or file-static)
5519 @end itemize
5520
5521 @noindent or
5522
5523 @itemize @bullet
5524 @item
5525 visible according to the scope rules of the
5526 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5527 @end itemize
5528
5529 @noindent This means that in the function
5530
5531 @smallexample
5532 foo (a)
5533 int a;
5534 @{
5535 bar (a);
5536 @{
5537 int b = test ();
5538 bar (b);
5539 @}
5540 @}
5541 @end smallexample
5542
5543 @noindent
5544 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5545 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5546 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5547 the block where @code{b} is declared.
5548
5549 @cindex variable name conflict
5550 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5551 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5552 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5553 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5554 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5555 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5556 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5557
5558 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5559 @ifnotinfo
5560 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5561 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5562 @end ifnotinfo
5563 @smallexample
5564 @var{file}::@var{variable}
5565 @var{function}::@var{variable}
5566 @end smallexample
5567
5568 @noindent
5569 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5570 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5571 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5572 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5573
5574 @smallexample
5575 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5576 @end smallexample
5577
5578 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5579 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5580 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5581 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5582 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5583 @c conflict?? --mew
5584
5585 @cindex wrong values
5586 @cindex variable values, wrong
5587 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5588 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5589 @quotation
5590 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5591 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5592 scope, and just before exit.
5593 @end quotation
5594 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5595 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5596 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5597 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5598 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5599 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5600 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5601 variable definitions may be gone.
5602
5603 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5604 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5605 when compiling.
5606
5607 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5608 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5609 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5610 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5611 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5612 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5613 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5614
5615 @smallexample
5616 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5617 @end smallexample
5618
5619 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5620 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5621 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5622 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5623 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5624 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5625 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5626 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
5627 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
5628 @xref{C, , Debugging C++}, for more information about debug info formats
5629 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5630
5631 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5632 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5633 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5634 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5635
5636 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
5637 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
5638 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
5639 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
5640 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
5641 For program code
5642
5643 @smallexample
5644 char var0[] = "A";
5645 signed char var1[] = "A";
5646 @end smallexample
5647
5648 You get during debugging
5649 @smallexample
5650 (gdb) print var0
5651 $1 = "A"
5652 (gdb) print var1
5653 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
5654 @end smallexample
5655
5656 @node Arrays
5657 @section Artificial arrays
5658
5659 @cindex artificial array
5660 @cindex arrays
5661 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5662 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5663 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5664 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5665 program.
5666
5667 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5668 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5669 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5670 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5671 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5672 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5673 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5674 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5675 example. If a program says
5676
5677 @smallexample
5678 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5679 @end smallexample
5680
5681 @noindent
5682 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5683
5684 @smallexample
5685 p *array@@len
5686 @end smallexample
5687
5688 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5689 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5690 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5691 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5692 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
5693
5694 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5695 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5696 The value need not be in memory:
5697 @smallexample
5698 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5699 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5700 @end smallexample
5701
5702 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5703 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5704 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5705 @smallexample
5706 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5707 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5708 @end smallexample
5709
5710 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5711 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5712 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5713 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5714 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5715 variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5716 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5717 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5718 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5719 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5720
5721 @smallexample
5722 set $i = 0
5723 p dtab[$i++]->fv
5724 @key{RET}
5725 @key{RET}
5726 @dots{}
5727 @end smallexample
5728
5729 @node Output Formats
5730 @section Output formats
5731
5732 @cindex formatted output
5733 @cindex output formats
5734 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5735 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5736 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5737 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5738 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5739
5740 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5741 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5742 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5743 letters supported are:
5744
5745 @table @code
5746 @item x
5747 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5748 hexadecimal.
5749
5750 @item d
5751 Print as integer in signed decimal.
5752
5753 @item u
5754 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5755
5756 @item o
5757 Print as integer in octal.
5758
5759 @item t
5760 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5761 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5762 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5763 see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
5764
5765 @item a
5766 @cindex unknown address, locating
5767 @cindex locate address
5768 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
5769 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
5770 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
5771
5772 @smallexample
5773 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
5774 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
5775 @end smallexample
5776
5777 @noindent
5778 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
5779 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
5780
5781 @item c
5782 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
5783 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
5784 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
5785 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
5786
5787 @item f
5788 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
5789 using typical floating point syntax.
5790 @end table
5791
5792 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
5793
5794 @smallexample
5795 p/x $pc
5796 @end smallexample
5797
5798 @noindent
5799 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
5800 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
5801
5802 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
5803 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
5804 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
5805
5806 @node Memory
5807 @section Examining memory
5808
5809 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
5810 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
5811
5812 @cindex examining memory
5813 @table @code
5814 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
5815 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
5816 @itemx x @var{addr}
5817 @itemx x
5818 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
5819 @end table
5820
5821 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
5822 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
5823 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
5824 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
5825 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
5826
5827 @table @r
5828 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
5829 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
5830 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
5831 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
5832 @c 4.1.2.
5833
5834 @item @var{f}, the display format
5835 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
5836 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
5837 @samp{f}), and in addition @samp{s} (for null-terminated strings) and
5838 @samp{i} (for machine instructions). The default is @samp{x}
5839 (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes each time you use either
5840 @code{x} or @code{print}.
5841
5842 @item @var{u}, the unit size
5843 The unit size is any of
5844
5845 @table @code
5846 @item b
5847 Bytes.
5848 @item h
5849 Halfwords (two bytes).
5850 @item w
5851 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
5852 @item g
5853 Giant words (eight bytes).
5854 @end table
5855
5856 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
5857 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
5858 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
5859
5860 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
5861 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
5862 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
5863 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
5864 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
5865 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
5866 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
5867 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
5868 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
5869 a value from memory).
5870 @end table
5871
5872 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
5873 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
5874 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
5875 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
5876 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
5877
5878 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
5879 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
5880 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
5881 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
5882 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
5883
5884 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
5885 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
5886 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
5887 including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
5888 alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
5889 Code,,Source and machine code}.
5890
5891 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
5892 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
5893 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
5894 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
5895 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
5896 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
5897 for successive uses of @code{x}.
5898
5899 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
5900 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
5901 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
5902 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
5903 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
5904 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
5905 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
5906 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
5907 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
5908
5909 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
5910 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
5911 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
5912
5913 @cindex remote memory comparison
5914 @cindex verify remote memory image
5915 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
5916 (@pxref{Remote}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
5917 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
5918 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
5919 situations.
5920
5921 @table @code
5922 @kindex compare-sections
5923 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
5924 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
5925 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
5926 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
5927 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
5928 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
5929 remote request.
5930 @end table
5931
5932 @node Auto Display
5933 @section Automatic display
5934 @cindex automatic display
5935 @cindex display of expressions
5936
5937 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
5938 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
5939 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
5940 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
5941 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
5942 The automatic display looks like this:
5943
5944 @smallexample
5945 2: foo = 38
5946 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
5947 @end smallexample
5948
5949 @noindent
5950 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
5951 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
5952 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
5953 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
5954 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
5955 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
5956 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
5957
5958 @table @code
5959 @kindex display
5960 @item display @var{expr}
5961 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
5962 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5963
5964 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
5965
5966 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
5967 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
5968 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
5969 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
5970 @xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
5971
5972 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
5973 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
5974 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
5975 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
5976 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5977 @end table
5978
5979 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
5980 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
5981 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5982
5983 @table @code
5984 @kindex delete display
5985 @kindex undisplay
5986 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5987 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5988 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5989
5990 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5991 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5992
5993 @kindex disable display
5994 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5995 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5996 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5997 enabled again later.
5998
5999 @kindex enable display
6000 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6001 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
6002 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
6003
6004 @item display
6005 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
6006 done when your program stops.
6007
6008 @kindex info display
6009 @item info display
6010 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
6011 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
6012 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
6013 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
6014 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
6015 @end table
6016
6017 @cindex display disabled out of scope
6018 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
6019 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
6020 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
6021 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
6022 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6023 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6024 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6025 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6026 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6027 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6028
6029 @node Print Settings
6030 @section Print settings
6031
6032 @cindex format options
6033 @cindex print settings
6034 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6035 and symbols are printed.
6036
6037 @noindent
6038 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6039
6040 @table @code
6041 @kindex set print
6042 @item set print address
6043 @itemx set print address on
6044 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6045 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6046 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6047 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6048 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6049 @code{set print address on}:
6050
6051 @smallexample
6052 @group
6053 (@value{GDBP}) f
6054 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6055 at input.c:530
6056 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6057 @end group
6058 @end smallexample
6059
6060 @item set print address off
6061 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6062 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6063
6064 @smallexample
6065 @group
6066 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6067 (@value{GDBP}) f
6068 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6069 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6070 @end group
6071 @end smallexample
6072
6073 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6074 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6075 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6076 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6077
6078 @kindex show print
6079 @item show print address
6080 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6081 @end table
6082
6083 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6084 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6085 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6086 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6087 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6088 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6089 it prints a symbolic address:
6090
6091 @table @code
6092 @item set print symbol-filename on
6093 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
6094 @cindex symbol, source file and line
6095 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6096 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6097
6098 @item set print symbol-filename off
6099 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6100 default.
6101
6102 @item show print symbol-filename
6103 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6104 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6105 @end table
6106
6107 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6108 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6109 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6110
6111 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6112 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6113
6114 @table @code
6115 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6116 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6117 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6118 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6119 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6120 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6121
6122 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6123 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6124 symbolic address.
6125 @end table
6126
6127 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6128 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6129 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6130 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6131 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6132 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6133 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6134 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6135
6136 @smallexample
6137 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6138 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6139 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6140 @end smallexample
6141
6142 @quotation
6143 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6144 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6145 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6146 @end quotation
6147
6148 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6149
6150 @table @code
6151 @item set print array
6152 @itemx set print array on
6153 @cindex pretty print arrays
6154 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6155 but uses more space. The default is off.
6156
6157 @item set print array off
6158 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6159
6160 @item show print array
6161 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6162 arrays.
6163
6164 @cindex print array indexes
6165 @item set print array-indexes
6166 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6167 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6168 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6169 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6170
6171 @item set print array-indexes off
6172 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6173
6174 @item show print array-indexes
6175 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6176 arrays.
6177
6178 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6179 @cindex number of array elements to print
6180 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6181 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6182 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6183 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6184 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6185 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6186 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6187
6188 @item show print elements
6189 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6190 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6191
6192 @item set print repeats
6193 @cindex repeated array elements
6194 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6195 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6196 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6197 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6198 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6199 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6200 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6201
6202 @item show print repeats
6203 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6204 elements.
6205
6206 @item set print null-stop
6207 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6208 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6209 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6210 contain only short strings.
6211 The default is off.
6212
6213 @item show print null-stop
6214 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6215 @sc{null} character.
6216
6217 @item set print pretty on
6218 @cindex print structures in indented form
6219 @cindex indentation in structure display
6220 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6221 per line, like this:
6222
6223 @smallexample
6224 @group
6225 $1 = @{
6226 next = 0x0,
6227 flags = @{
6228 sweet = 1,
6229 sour = 1
6230 @},
6231 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6232 @}
6233 @end group
6234 @end smallexample
6235
6236 @item set print pretty off
6237 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6238
6239 @smallexample
6240 @group
6241 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6242 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6243 @end group
6244 @end smallexample
6245
6246 @noindent
6247 This is the default format.
6248
6249 @item show print pretty
6250 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6251
6252 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6253 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6254 @cindex octal escapes in strings
6255 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6256 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6257 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6258 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6259 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6260
6261 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
6262 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6263 international character sets, and is the default.
6264
6265 @item show print sevenbit-strings
6266 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6267
6268 @item set print union on
6269 @cindex unions in structures, printing
6270 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6271 and other unions. This is the default setting.
6272
6273 @item set print union off
6274 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6275 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6276 instead.
6277
6278 @item show print union
6279 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6280 structures and other unions.
6281
6282 For example, given the declarations
6283
6284 @smallexample
6285 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6286 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6287 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6288 Bug_forms;
6289
6290 struct thing @{
6291 Species it;
6292 union @{
6293 Tree_forms tree;
6294 Bug_forms bug;
6295 @} form;
6296 @};
6297
6298 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6299 @end smallexample
6300
6301 @noindent
6302 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6303
6304 @smallexample
6305 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6306 @end smallexample
6307
6308 @noindent
6309 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6310
6311 @smallexample
6312 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6313 @end smallexample
6314
6315 @noindent
6316 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6317 and in Pascal.
6318 @end table
6319
6320 @need 1000
6321 @noindent
6322 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6323
6324 @table @code
6325 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6326 @item set print demangle
6327 @itemx set print demangle on
6328 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6329 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6330 linkage. The default is on.
6331
6332 @item show print demangle
6333 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6334
6335 @item set print asm-demangle
6336 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
6337 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6338 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6339 The default is off.
6340
6341 @item show print asm-demangle
6342 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6343 or demangled form.
6344
6345 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6346 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6347 @kindex set demangle-style
6348 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
6349 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6350 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6351
6352 @table @code
6353 @item auto
6354 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6355
6356 @item gnu
6357 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6358 This is the default.
6359
6360 @item hp
6361 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6362
6363 @item lucid
6364 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6365
6366 @item arm
6367 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6368 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6369 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6370 require further enhancement to permit that.
6371
6372 @end table
6373 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6374
6375 @item show demangle-style
6376 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6377
6378 @item set print object
6379 @itemx set print object on
6380 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
6381 @cindex display derived types
6382 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6383 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6384 the virtual function table.
6385
6386 @item set print object off
6387 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6388 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6389
6390 @item show print object
6391 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6392
6393 @item set print static-members
6394 @itemx set print static-members on
6395 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
6396 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
6397
6398 @item set print static-members off
6399 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
6400
6401 @item show print static-members
6402 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
6403
6404 @item set print pascal_static-members
6405 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
6406 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
6407 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
6408 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
6409
6410 @item set print pascal_static-members off
6411 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
6412
6413 @item show print pascal_static-members
6414 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
6415
6416 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
6417 @item set print vtbl
6418 @itemx set print vtbl on
6419 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
6420 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6421 @cindex VTBL display
6422 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6423 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6424 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6425
6426 @item set print vtbl off
6427 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6428
6429 @item show print vtbl
6430 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6431 @end table
6432
6433 @node Value History
6434 @section Value history
6435
6436 @cindex value history
6437 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6438 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6439 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6440 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6441 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6442 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6443 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6444 symbol table.
6445
6446 @cindex @code{$}
6447 @cindex @code{$$}
6448 @cindex history number
6449 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6450 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6451 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6452 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6453 history number.
6454
6455 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6456 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6457 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6458 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6459 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6460 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6461 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6462
6463 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6464 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6465
6466 @smallexample
6467 p *$
6468 @end smallexample
6469
6470 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6471 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6472
6473 @smallexample
6474 p *$.next
6475 @end smallexample
6476
6477 @noindent
6478 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6479 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6480
6481 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6482 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6483
6484 @smallexample
6485 print x
6486 set x=5
6487 @end smallexample
6488
6489 @noindent
6490 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6491 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6492
6493 @table @code
6494 @kindex show values
6495 @item show values
6496 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6497 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6498 values} does not change the history.
6499
6500 @item show values @var{n}
6501 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6502
6503 @item show values +
6504 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6505 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6506 @end table
6507
6508 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6509 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6510
6511 @node Convenience Vars
6512 @section Convenience variables
6513
6514 @cindex convenience variables
6515 @cindex user-defined variables
6516 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6517 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6518 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6519 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6520 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6521
6522 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6523 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6524 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6525 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6526 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
6527
6528 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6529 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6530 For example:
6531
6532 @smallexample
6533 set $foo = *object_ptr
6534 @end smallexample
6535
6536 @noindent
6537 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6538 @code{object_ptr}.
6539
6540 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6541 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6542 value with another assignment at any time.
6543
6544 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6545 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6546 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6547 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6548
6549 @table @code
6550 @kindex show convenience
6551 @cindex show all user variables
6552 @item show convenience
6553 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6554 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6555
6556 @kindex init-if-undefined
6557 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
6558 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
6559 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
6560 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
6561 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
6562 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
6563 override default values used in a command script.
6564
6565 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
6566 any side-effects do not occur.
6567 @end table
6568
6569 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6570 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6571 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6572
6573 @smallexample
6574 set $i = 0
6575 print bar[$i++]->contents
6576 @end smallexample
6577
6578 @noindent
6579 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6580
6581 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6582 values likely to be useful.
6583
6584 @table @code
6585 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6586 @item $_
6587 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6588 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
6589 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6590 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6591 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6592 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6593 to the type of @code{$__}.
6594
6595 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6596 @item $__
6597 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6598 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6599 to match the format in which the data was printed.
6600
6601 @item $_exitcode
6602 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6603 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6604 the program being debugged terminates.
6605 @end table
6606
6607 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6608 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6609 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6610
6611 @node Registers
6612 @section Registers
6613
6614 @cindex registers
6615 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6616 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6617 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6618 your machine.
6619
6620 @table @code
6621 @kindex info registers
6622 @item info registers
6623 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6624 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6625
6626 @kindex info all-registers
6627 @cindex floating point registers
6628 @item info all-registers
6629 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6630 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6631
6632 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6633 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6634 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6635 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6636 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6637 @end table
6638
6639 @cindex stack pointer register
6640 @cindex program counter register
6641 @cindex process status register
6642 @cindex frame pointer register
6643 @cindex standard registers
6644 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6645 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6646 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6647 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6648 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6649 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6650 register that contains the processor status. For example,
6651 you could print the program counter in hex with
6652
6653 @smallexample
6654 p/x $pc
6655 @end smallexample
6656
6657 @noindent
6658 or print the instruction to be executed next with
6659
6660 @smallexample
6661 x/i $pc
6662 @end smallexample
6663
6664 @noindent
6665 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6666 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6667 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6668 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6669 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6670 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6671 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
6672
6673 @smallexample
6674 set $sp += 4
6675 @end smallexample
6676
6677 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6678 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6679 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6680 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6681 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6682 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6683 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6684
6685 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6686 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6687 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6688 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6689 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6690 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6691 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6692
6693 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6694 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6695 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6696 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6697 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6698 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6699 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6700 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6701 prints the data in both formats.
6702
6703 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
6704 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
6705 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
6706 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
6707 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
6708 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
6709 registers in @code{struct} notation:
6710
6711 @smallexample
6712 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
6713 $1 = @{
6714 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
6715 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
6716 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
6717 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
6718 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
6719 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
6720 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
6721 @}
6722 @end smallexample
6723
6724 @noindent
6725 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
6726 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
6727 value to a @code{struct} member:
6728
6729 @smallexample
6730 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
6731 @end smallexample
6732
6733 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
6734 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
6735 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
6736 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
6737 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
6738 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
6739
6740 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
6741 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
6742 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
6743 frame makes no difference.
6744
6745 @node Floating Point Hardware
6746 @section Floating point hardware
6747 @cindex floating point
6748
6749 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
6750 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
6751
6752 @table @code
6753 @kindex info float
6754 @item info float
6755 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
6756 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
6757 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
6758 the ARM and x86 machines.
6759 @end table
6760
6761 @node Vector Unit
6762 @section Vector Unit
6763 @cindex vector unit
6764
6765 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
6766 more information about the status of the vector unit.
6767
6768 @table @code
6769 @kindex info vector
6770 @item info vector
6771 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
6772 layout vary depending on the hardware.
6773 @end table
6774
6775 @node OS Information
6776 @section Operating system auxiliary information
6777 @cindex OS information
6778
6779 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
6780 you debug your program.
6781
6782 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
6783 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
6784 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
6785 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
6786 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
6787 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
6788 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
6789 structure.
6790
6791 @table @code
6792 @item info udot
6793 @kindex info udot
6794 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
6795 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
6796 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
6797 the @code{examine} command.
6798 @end table
6799
6800 @cindex auxiliary vector
6801 @cindex vector, auxiliary
6802 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
6803 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
6804 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
6805 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
6806 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
6807 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
6808 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
6809 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
6810 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
6811 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
6812 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
6813
6814 @table @code
6815 @kindex info auxv
6816 @item info auxv
6817 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
6818 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
6819 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
6820 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
6821 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
6822 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
6823 an unrecognized tag.
6824 @end table
6825
6826
6827 @node Memory Region Attributes
6828 @section Memory region attributes
6829 @cindex memory region attributes
6830
6831 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
6832 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
6833 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
6834 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
6835 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
6836 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
6837 user can override the fetched regions.
6838
6839 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
6840 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
6841 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
6842 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
6843 all memory.
6844
6845 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
6846 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
6847
6848 @table @code
6849 @kindex mem
6850 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
6851 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
6852 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
6853 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
6854 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
6855 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
6856
6857 @item mem auto
6858 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
6859 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
6860
6861 @kindex delete mem
6862 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6863 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
6864 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
6865
6866 @kindex disable mem
6867 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6868 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6869 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
6870 It may be enabled again later.
6871
6872 @kindex enable mem
6873 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6874 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6875
6876 @kindex info mem
6877 @item info mem
6878 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
6879 for each region:
6880
6881 @table @emph
6882 @item Memory Region Number
6883 @item Enabled or Disabled.
6884 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
6885 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
6886
6887 @item Lo Address
6888 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
6889
6890 @item Hi Address
6891 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
6892
6893 @item Attributes
6894 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
6895 @end table
6896 @end table
6897
6898
6899 @subsection Attributes
6900
6901 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
6902 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
6903 write accesses to a memory region.
6904
6905 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
6906 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
6907 etc.@: from accessing memory.
6908
6909 @table @code
6910 @item ro
6911 Memory is read only.
6912 @item wo
6913 Memory is write only.
6914 @item rw
6915 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
6916 @end table
6917
6918 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
6919 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
6920 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
6921 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
6922 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
6923
6924 @table @code
6925 @item 8
6926 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
6927 @item 16
6928 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
6929 @item 32
6930 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
6931 @item 64
6932 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
6933 @end table
6934
6935 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
6936 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6937 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
6938 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
6939 @c
6940 @c @table @code
6941 @c @item hwbreak
6942 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
6943 @c @item swbreak (default)
6944 @c @end table
6945
6946 @subsubsection Data Cache
6947 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
6948 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
6949 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
6950 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
6951 registers.
6952
6953 @table @code
6954 @item cache
6955 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6956 @item nocache
6957 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
6958 @end table
6959
6960 @subsection Memory Access Checking
6961 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
6962 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
6963 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
6964 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
6965
6966 @table @code
6967 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
6968 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
6969 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
6970 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
6971 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
6972 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
6973 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
6974 The default value is @code{off}.
6975 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
6976 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
6977 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
6978 @end table
6979
6980
6981 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
6982 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6983 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
6984 @c
6985 @c @table @code
6986 @c @item verify
6987 @c @item noverify (default)
6988 @c @end table
6989
6990 @node Dump/Restore Files
6991 @section Copy between memory and a file
6992 @cindex dump/restore files
6993 @cindex append data to a file
6994 @cindex dump data to a file
6995 @cindex restore data from a file
6996
6997 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
6998 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
6999 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
7000 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
7001 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
7002 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
7003 files.
7004
7005 @table @code
7006
7007 @kindex dump
7008 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7009 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7010 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7011 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
7012
7013 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
7014 @table @code
7015 @item binary
7016 Raw binary form.
7017 @item ihex
7018 Intel hex format.
7019 @item srec
7020 Motorola S-record format.
7021 @item tekhex
7022 Tektronix Hex format.
7023 @end table
7024
7025 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7026 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7027 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7028 form.
7029
7030 @kindex append
7031 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7032 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7033 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7034 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7035 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7036
7037 @kindex restore
7038 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7039 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7040 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7041 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7042 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7043
7044 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7045 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7046 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7047 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7048 from that location.
7049
7050 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7051 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7052 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7053 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7054
7055 @end table
7056
7057 @node Core File Generation
7058 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7059 @cindex dump core from inferior
7060
7061 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7062 image of a running process and its process status (register values
7063 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7064 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7065 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7066 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7067 the post-mortem debugging mode.
7068
7069 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7070 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7071 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7072
7073 @table @code
7074 @kindex gcore
7075 @kindex generate-core-file
7076 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7077 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7078 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7079 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7080 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7081 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7082
7083 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7084 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7085 @end table
7086
7087 @node Character Sets
7088 @section Character Sets
7089 @cindex character sets
7090 @cindex charset
7091 @cindex translating between character sets
7092 @cindex host character set
7093 @cindex target character set
7094
7095 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7096 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7097 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7098 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7099 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7100 @dfn{target character set}.
7101
7102 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7103 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7104 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7105 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7106 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7107 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7108 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7109 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7110 character and string literals in expressions.
7111
7112 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7113 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7114 target-charset} command, described below.
7115
7116 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7117 support:
7118
7119 @table @code
7120 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
7121 @kindex set target-charset
7122 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7123 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7124 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7125 list the target character sets it supports.
7126 @end table
7127
7128 @table @code
7129 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
7130 @kindex set host-charset
7131 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7132
7133 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7134 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7135 @code{set host-charset} command.
7136
7137 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7138 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7139 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7140 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7141 list the host character sets it supports.
7142
7143 @item set charset @var{charset}
7144 @kindex set charset
7145 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7146 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7147 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7148 for both host and target.
7149
7150
7151 @item show charset
7152 @kindex show charset
7153 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7154
7155 @itemx show host-charset
7156 @kindex show host-charset
7157 Show the name of the current host charset.
7158
7159 @itemx show target-charset
7160 @kindex show target-charset
7161 Show the name of the current target charset.
7162
7163 @end table
7164
7165 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7166 sets:
7167
7168 @table @code
7169
7170 @item ASCII
7171 @cindex ASCII character set
7172 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7173 character set.
7174
7175 @item ISO-8859-1
7176 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7177 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7178 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7179 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7180 this as its host character set.
7181
7182 @item EBCDIC-US
7183 @itemx IBM1047
7184 @cindex EBCDIC character set
7185 @cindex IBM1047 character set
7186 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7187 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7188 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7189
7190 @end table
7191
7192 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7193 GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7194 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7195
7196 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7197 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7198 @file{charset-test.c}:
7199
7200 @smallexample
7201 #include <stdio.h>
7202
7203 char ascii_hello[]
7204 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7205 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7206 char ibm1047_hello[]
7207 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7208 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7209
7210 main ()
7211 @{
7212 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7213 @}
7214 @end smallexample
7215
7216 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7217 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7218 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7219
7220 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7221
7222 @smallexample
7223 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7224 $ gdb -nw charset-test
7225 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7226 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7227 @dots{}
7228 (@value{GDBP})
7229 @end smallexample
7230
7231 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7232 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7233 strings:
7234
7235 @smallexample
7236 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7237 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7238 (@value{GDBP})
7239 @end smallexample
7240
7241 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7242 initial character set:
7243 @smallexample
7244 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7245 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7246 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7247 (@value{GDBP})
7248 @end smallexample
7249
7250 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7251 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7252 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7253 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7254 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7255
7256 @smallexample
7257 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7258 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7259 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7260 $2 = 72 'H'
7261 (@value{GDBP})
7262 @end smallexample
7263
7264 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7265 literals you use in expressions:
7266
7267 @smallexample
7268 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7269 $3 = 43 '+'
7270 (@value{GDBP})
7271 @end smallexample
7272
7273 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7274 character.
7275
7276 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7277 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7278 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7279
7280 @smallexample
7281 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7282 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7283 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7284 $5 = 200 '\310'
7285 (@value{GDBP})
7286 @end smallexample
7287
7288 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7289 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7290
7291 @smallexample
7292 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7293 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7294 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7295 @end smallexample
7296
7297 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7298 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7299 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7300 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7301 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7302
7303 @smallexample
7304 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7305 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7306 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7307 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7308 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7309 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7310 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7311 $7 = 72 '\110'
7312 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7313 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7314 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7315 $9 = 200 'H'
7316 (@value{GDBP})
7317 @end smallexample
7318
7319 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7320 string literals you use in expressions:
7321
7322 @smallexample
7323 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7324 $10 = 78 '+'
7325 (@value{GDBP})
7326 @end smallexample
7327
7328 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7329 character.
7330
7331 @node Caching Remote Data
7332 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7333 @cindex caching data of remote targets
7334
7335 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7336 remote target (@pxref{Remote}). Such caching generally improves
7337 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7338 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7339 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7340 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7341 volatile registers are in use.
7342
7343 @table @code
7344 @kindex set remotecache
7345 @item set remotecache on
7346 @itemx set remotecache off
7347 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7348 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7349
7350 @kindex show remotecache
7351 @item show remotecache
7352 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7353
7354 @kindex info dcache
7355 @item info dcache
7356 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7357 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7358 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7359 state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7360 the data cache operation.
7361 @end table
7362
7363
7364 @node Macros
7365 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
7366
7367 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
7368 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
7369 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
7370 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
7371 where it was defined.
7372
7373 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
7374 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
7375 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
7376 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
7377
7378 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
7379 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
7380 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
7381 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
7382 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
7383 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
7384 see @ref{List}.
7385
7386 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
7387 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
7388 variable-arity macros.
7389
7390 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
7391 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
7392 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
7393
7394 @table @code
7395
7396 @kindex macro expand
7397 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
7398 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
7399 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
7400 @item macro expand @var{expression}
7401 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
7402 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
7403 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
7404 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
7405 it can be any string of tokens.
7406
7407 @kindex macro exp1
7408 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
7409 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
7410 @cindex expand macro once
7411 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
7412 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
7413 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
7414 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
7415 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
7416 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
7417 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
7418 can be any string of tokens.
7419
7420 @kindex info macro
7421 @cindex macro definition, showing
7422 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
7423 @item info macro @var{macro}
7424 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
7425 source location where that definition was established.
7426
7427 @kindex macro define
7428 @cindex user-defined macros
7429 @cindex defining macros interactively
7430 @cindex macros, user-defined
7431 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
7432 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
7433 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
7434 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
7435 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
7436 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
7437 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
7438 given in @var{arglist}.
7439
7440 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
7441 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
7442 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
7443 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
7444 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
7445
7446 @kindex macro undef
7447 @item macro undef @var{macro}
7448 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
7449 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
7450 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
7451 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
7452 debugged.
7453
7454 @kindex macro list
7455 @item macro list
7456 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
7457 defined using the @code{macro define} command.
7458 @end table
7459
7460 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
7461 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
7462 show our source files:
7463
7464 @smallexample
7465 $ cat sample.c
7466 #include <stdio.h>
7467 #include "sample.h"
7468
7469 #define M 42
7470 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7471
7472 main ()
7473 @{
7474 #define N 28
7475 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7476 #undef N
7477 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7478 #define N 1729
7479 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7480 @}
7481 $ cat sample.h
7482 #define Q <
7483 $
7484 @end smallexample
7485
7486 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
7487 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
7488 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
7489 information.
7490
7491 @smallexample
7492 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7493 $
7494 @end smallexample
7495
7496 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7497
7498 @smallexample
7499 $ gdb -nw sample
7500 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7501 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7502 GDB is free software, @dots{}
7503 (@value{GDBP})
7504 @end smallexample
7505
7506 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7507 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7508 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7509
7510 @smallexample
7511 (@value{GDBP}) list main
7512 3
7513 4 #define M 42
7514 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7515 6
7516 7 main ()
7517 8 @{
7518 9 #define N 28
7519 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7520 11 #undef N
7521 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7522 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7523 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7524 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7525 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7526 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7527 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7528 #define Q <
7529 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7530 expands to: (42 + 1)
7531 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7532 expands to: once (M + 1)
7533 (@value{GDBP})
7534 @end smallexample
7535
7536 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7537 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7538 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7539 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7540
7541 Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
7542 the source line of the current stack frame:
7543
7544 @smallexample
7545 (@value{GDBP}) break main
7546 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7547 (@value{GDBP}) run
7548 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7549
7550 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
7551 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7552 (@value{GDBP})
7553 @end smallexample
7554
7555 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7556
7557 @smallexample
7558 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7559 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7560 #define N 28
7561 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7562 expands to: 28 < 42
7563 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7564 $1 = 1
7565 (@value{GDBP})
7566 @end smallexample
7567
7568 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7569 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7570 thereof) in force at each point:
7571
7572 @smallexample
7573 (@value{GDBP}) next
7574 Hello, world!
7575 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7576 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7577 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7578 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7579 (@value{GDBP}) next
7580 We're so creative.
7581 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7582 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7583 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7584 #define N 1729
7585 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7586 expands to: 1729 < 42
7587 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7588 $2 = 0
7589 (@value{GDBP})
7590 @end smallexample
7591
7592
7593 @node Tracepoints
7594 @chapter Tracepoints
7595 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7596 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7597
7598 @cindex tracepoints
7599 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7600 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7601 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7602 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7603 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7604 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7605 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
7606
7607 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
7608 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
7609 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
7610 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
7611 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
7612 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
7613 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
7614 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
7615 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
7616 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
7617 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
7618
7619 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
7620 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
7621 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
7622 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
7623 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
7624 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
7625 Packets}.
7626
7627 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
7628
7629 @menu
7630 * Set Tracepoints::
7631 * Analyze Collected Data::
7632 * Tracepoint Variables::
7633 @end menu
7634
7635 @node Set Tracepoints
7636 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
7637
7638 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
7639 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
7640 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
7641 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
7642 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
7643 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
7644 work on.
7645
7646 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
7647 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
7648 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
7649 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
7650 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
7651 tracepoint was hit.
7652
7653 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
7654 conditions and actions.
7655
7656 @menu
7657 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
7658 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
7659 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
7660 * Tracepoint Actions::
7661 * Listing Tracepoints::
7662 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
7663 @end menu
7664
7665 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
7666 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
7667
7668 @table @code
7669 @cindex set tracepoint
7670 @kindex trace
7671 @item trace
7672 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
7673 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
7674 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
7675 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
7676 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
7677 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
7678 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
7679 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
7680 running.
7681
7682 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
7683
7684 @smallexample
7685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
7686
7687 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
7688
7689 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
7690
7691 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
7692
7693 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
7694 @end smallexample
7695
7696 @noindent
7697 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
7698
7699 @vindex $tpnum
7700 @cindex last tracepoint number
7701 @cindex recent tracepoint number
7702 @cindex tracepoint number
7703 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
7704 of the most recently set tracepoint.
7705
7706 @kindex delete tracepoint
7707 @cindex tracepoint deletion
7708 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7709 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
7710 default is to delete all tracepoints.
7711
7712 Examples:
7713
7714 @smallexample
7715 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
7716
7717 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
7718 @end smallexample
7719
7720 @noindent
7721 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
7722 @end table
7723
7724 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7725 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7726
7727 @table @code
7728 @kindex disable tracepoint
7729 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7730 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
7731 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
7732 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
7733 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
7734
7735 @kindex enable tracepoint
7736 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7737 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
7738 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
7739 run.
7740 @end table
7741
7742 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
7743 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
7744
7745 @table @code
7746 @kindex passcount
7747 @cindex tracepoint pass count
7748 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
7749 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
7750 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
7751 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
7752 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
7753 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
7754 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
7755 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
7756 user.
7757
7758 Examples:
7759
7760 @smallexample
7761 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
7762 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
7763
7764 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
7765 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
7766 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7767 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
7768 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
7769 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
7770 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
7771 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
7772 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
7773 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
7774 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
7775 @end smallexample
7776 @end table
7777
7778 @node Tracepoint Actions
7779 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
7780
7781 @table @code
7782 @kindex actions
7783 @cindex tracepoint actions
7784 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7785 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
7786 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
7787 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
7788 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
7789 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
7790 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
7791 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
7792 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
7793 @code{while-stepping}.
7794
7795 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
7796 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
7797 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
7798
7799 @smallexample
7800 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
7801
7802 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
7803
7804 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
7805 @end smallexample
7806
7807 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
7808 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
7809 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
7810 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
7811 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
7812 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
7813 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
7814 @code{end} command.
7815
7816 @smallexample
7817 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7818 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7819 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
7820 > collect bar,baz
7821 > collect $regs
7822 > while-stepping 12
7823 > collect $fp, $sp
7824 > end
7825 end
7826 @end smallexample
7827
7828 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
7829 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
7830 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
7831 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
7832 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
7833 special arguments are supported:
7834
7835 @table @code
7836 @item $regs
7837 collect all registers
7838
7839 @item $args
7840 collect all function arguments
7841
7842 @item $locals
7843 collect all local variables.
7844 @end table
7845
7846 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
7847 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
7848 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
7849
7850 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
7851 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
7852
7853 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
7854 @item while-stepping @var{n}
7855 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
7856 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
7857 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
7858 its own @code{end} command):
7859
7860 @smallexample
7861 > while-stepping 12
7862 > collect $regs, myglobal
7863 > end
7864 >
7865 @end smallexample
7866
7867 @noindent
7868 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
7869 @code{stepping}.
7870 @end table
7871
7872 @node Listing Tracepoints
7873 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
7874
7875 @table @code
7876 @kindex info tracepoints
7877 @kindex info tp
7878 @cindex information about tracepoints
7879 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7880 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
7881 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
7882 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
7883 shown:
7884
7885 @itemize @bullet
7886 @item
7887 its number
7888 @item
7889 whether it is enabled or disabled
7890 @item
7891 its address
7892 @item
7893 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
7894 @item
7895 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
7896 @item
7897 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
7898 @item
7899 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
7900 @end itemize
7901
7902 @smallexample
7903 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
7904 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
7905 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
7906 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
7907 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
7908 (@value{GDBP})
7909 @end smallexample
7910
7911 @noindent
7912 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
7913 @end table
7914
7915 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
7916 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
7917
7918 @table @code
7919 @kindex tstart
7920 @cindex start a new trace experiment
7921 @cindex collected data discarded
7922 @item tstart
7923 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
7924 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
7925 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
7926 experiment.
7927
7928 @kindex tstop
7929 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
7930 @item tstop
7931 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
7932 stops collecting data.
7933
7934 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
7935 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
7936 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
7937
7938 @kindex tstatus
7939 @cindex status of trace data collection
7940 @cindex trace experiment, status of
7941 @item tstatus
7942 This command displays the status of the current trace data
7943 collection.
7944 @end table
7945
7946 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
7947
7948 @smallexample
7949 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
7950 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7951 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
7952 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
7953 > while-stepping 11
7954 > collect $regs
7955 > end
7956 > end
7957 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
7958 [time passes @dots{}]
7959 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
7960 @end smallexample
7961
7962
7963 @node Analyze Collected Data
7964 @section Using the collected data
7965
7966 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
7967 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
7968 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
7969 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
7970 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
7971 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
7972 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
7973 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
7974 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
7975 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
7976 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
7977 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
7978 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
7979 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
7980 the buffer will fail.
7981
7982 @menu
7983 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
7984 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
7985 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
7986 @end menu
7987
7988 @node tfind
7989 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
7990
7991 @kindex tfind
7992 @cindex select trace snapshot
7993 @cindex find trace snapshot
7994 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
7995 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
7996 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
7997 snapshot is selected.
7998
7999 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
8000
8001 @table @code
8002 @item tfind start
8003 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
8004 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
8005
8006 @item tfind none
8007 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
8008
8009 @item tfind end
8010 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
8011
8012 @item tfind
8013 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
8014
8015 @item tfind -
8016 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
8017 retracing earlier steps.
8018
8019 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
8020 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
8021 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
8022 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8023 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8024
8025 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
8026 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8027 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8028 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8029 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8030
8031 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8032 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8033 addresses.
8034
8035 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8036 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8037 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8038
8039 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8040 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
8041 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
8042 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
8043 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
8044 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
8045 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
8046 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
8047 @end table
8048
8049 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
8050 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
8051 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
8052 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
8053 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
8054 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
8055 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
8056 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
8057 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
8058 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
8059 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
8060 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
8061 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
8062 tracepoint as the current one.
8063
8064 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8065 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8066 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8067 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
8068 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
8069
8070 @smallexample
8071 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8072 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8073 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
8074 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
8075 > tfind
8076 > end
8077
8078 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
8079 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
8080 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
8081 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
8082 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
8083 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8084 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8085 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8086 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8087 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8088 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8089 @end smallexample
8090
8091 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8092 the buffer:
8093
8094 @smallexample
8095 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8096 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8097 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8098 > tfind line
8099 > end
8100
8101 Frame 0, X = 1
8102 Frame 7, X = 2
8103 Frame 13, X = 255
8104 @end smallexample
8105
8106 @node tdump
8107 @subsection @code{tdump}
8108 @kindex tdump
8109 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8110 @cindex tracepoint data, display
8111
8112 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8113 the current trace snapshot.
8114
8115 @smallexample
8116 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8117 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8118 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8119 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8120 > end
8121
8122 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8123
8124 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8125 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8126 at gdb_test.c:444
8127 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8128
8129 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8130 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8131 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8132 d1 0x18 24
8133 d2 0x80 128
8134 d3 0x33 51
8135 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8136 d5 0x22 34
8137 d6 0xe0 224
8138 d7 0x380035 3670069
8139 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8140 a1 0x3000668 50333288
8141 a2 0x100 256
8142 a3 0x322000 3284992
8143 a4 0x3000698 50333336
8144 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8145 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8146 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8147 ps 0x0 0
8148 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8149 fpcontrol 0x0 0
8150 fpstatus 0x0 0
8151 fpiaddr 0x0 0
8152 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8153 p1 = (void *) 0x11
8154 p2 = (void *) 0x22
8155 p3 = (void *) 0x33
8156 p4 = (void *) 0x44
8157 p5 = (void *) 0x55
8158 p6 = (void *) 0x66
8159 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8160
8161 (@value{GDBP})
8162 @end smallexample
8163
8164 @node save-tracepoints
8165 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8166 @kindex save-tracepoints
8167 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8168
8169 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8170 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8171 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8172 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8173 Files}).
8174
8175 @node Tracepoint Variables
8176 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8177 @cindex tracepoint variables
8178 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8179
8180 @table @code
8181 @vindex $trace_frame
8182 @item (int) $trace_frame
8183 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8184 snapshot is selected.
8185
8186 @vindex $tracepoint
8187 @item (int) $tracepoint
8188 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8189
8190 @vindex $trace_line
8191 @item (int) $trace_line
8192 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8193
8194 @vindex $trace_file
8195 @item (char []) $trace_file
8196 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8197
8198 @vindex $trace_func
8199 @item (char []) $trace_func
8200 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8201 @end table
8202
8203 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8204 use @code{output} instead.
8205
8206 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8207 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8208 data.
8209
8210 @smallexample
8211 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8212
8213 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8214 > output $trace_file
8215 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8216 > tfind
8217 > end
8218 @end smallexample
8219
8220 @node Overlays
8221 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8222 @cindex overlays
8223
8224 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8225 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8226 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8227 use overlays.
8228
8229 @menu
8230 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8231 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8232 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8233 mapped by asking the inferior.
8234 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8235 @end menu
8236
8237 @node How Overlays Work
8238 @section How Overlays Work
8239 @cindex mapped overlays
8240 @cindex unmapped overlays
8241 @cindex load address, overlay's
8242 @cindex mapped address
8243 @cindex overlay area
8244
8245 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8246 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8247 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8248 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8249 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8250
8251 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8252 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8253 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8254 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8255 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8256 largest overlay as well.
8257
8258 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8259 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8260 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8261 there.
8262
8263 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8264 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8265 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8266
8267 @smallexample
8268 @group
8269 Data Instruction Larger
8270 Address Space Address Space Address Space
8271 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8272 | | | | | |
8273 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8274 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8275 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
8276 | and heap | | | | | |
8277 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8278 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
8279 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8280 | | | | | |
8281 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8282 address | | | | | |
8283 | overlay | <-' | | |
8284 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8285 | | <---. | | load address
8286 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8287 | | | |
8288 +-----------+ | |
8289 +-----------+
8290 | |
8291 +-----------+
8292
8293 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8294 @end group
8295 @end smallexample
8296
8297 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8298 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
8299 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
8300 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
8301 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
8302 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
8303 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
8304 program and the overlay area.
8305
8306 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
8307 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
8308 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
8309 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
8310 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
8311 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
8312 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
8313
8314 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
8315 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
8316 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
8317
8318 @itemize @bullet
8319
8320 @item
8321 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
8322 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
8323 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
8324 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
8325
8326 @item
8327 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
8328 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
8329 your program's performance.
8330
8331 @item
8332 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
8333 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
8334 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
8335 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
8336 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
8337 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
8338 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
8339
8340 @item
8341 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
8342 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
8343 instruction and data spaces.
8344
8345 @end itemize
8346
8347 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
8348 improved in many ways:
8349
8350 @itemize @bullet
8351
8352 @item
8353 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
8354 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
8355 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
8356 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
8357 area in the usual way.
8358
8359 @item
8360 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
8361 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
8362
8363 @item
8364 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
8365 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
8366 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
8367 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
8368 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
8369 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
8370 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
8371
8372 @end itemize
8373
8374
8375 @node Overlay Commands
8376 @section Overlay Commands
8377
8378 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
8379 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
8380 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
8381 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
8382 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
8383 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
8384
8385 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
8386 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
8387
8388 @table @code
8389 @item overlay off
8390 @kindex overlay
8391 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
8392 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
8393 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
8394 overlay support is disabled.
8395
8396 @item overlay manual
8397 @cindex manual overlay debugging
8398 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8399 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
8400 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
8401 commands described below.
8402
8403 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
8404 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
8405 @cindex map an overlay
8406 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
8407 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
8408 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
8409 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
8410 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
8411 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
8412
8413 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
8414 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
8415 @cindex unmap an overlay
8416 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
8417 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
8418 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
8419 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
8420
8421 @item overlay auto
8422 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8423 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
8424 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
8425 Overlay Debugging}.
8426
8427 @item overlay load-target
8428 @itemx overlay load
8429 @cindex reloading the overlay table
8430 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
8431 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
8432 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
8433 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
8434 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
8435
8436 @item overlay list-overlays
8437 @itemx overlay list
8438 @cindex listing mapped overlays
8439 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
8440 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
8441
8442 @end table
8443
8444 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
8445 of the function the address falls in:
8446
8447 @smallexample
8448 (@value{GDBP}) print main
8449 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
8450 @end smallexample
8451 @noindent
8452 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
8453 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
8454 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
8455 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
8456
8457 @smallexample
8458 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8459 No sections are mapped.
8460 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8461 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
8462 @end smallexample
8463 @noindent
8464 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
8465 name normally:
8466
8467 @smallexample
8468 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8469 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
8470 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
8471 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8472 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
8473 @end smallexample
8474
8475 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
8476 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
8477 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
8478 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
8479 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
8480
8481 @itemize @bullet
8482 @item
8483 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
8484 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
8485 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
8486 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
8487 @item
8488 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
8489 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
8490 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
8491 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
8492 breakpoints properly.
8493 @end itemize
8494
8495
8496 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8497 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8498 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
8499
8500 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8501 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8502 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8503 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8504 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8505 current state of the overlays.
8506
8507 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8508 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8509
8510 @table @asis
8511
8512 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
8513 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8514
8515 @smallexample
8516 struct
8517 @{
8518 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8519 unsigned long vma;
8520
8521 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8522 unsigned long size;
8523
8524 /* The overlay's load address. */
8525 unsigned long lma;
8526
8527 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8528 zero otherwise. */
8529 unsigned long mapped;
8530 @}
8531 @end smallexample
8532
8533 @item @code{_novlys}:
8534 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8535 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8536
8537 @end table
8538
8539 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8540 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8541 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8542 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8543 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8544 currently mapped.
8545
8546 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8547 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8548 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8549 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8550 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8551 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8552 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8553 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8554 are not being executed.
8555
8556 @node Overlay Sample Program
8557 @section Overlay Sample Program
8558 @cindex overlay example program
8559
8560 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8561 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8562 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8563 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8564 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8565 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8566 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8567
8568 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8569 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8570 suite. The program consists of the following files from
8571 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8572
8573 @table @file
8574 @item overlays.c
8575 The main program file.
8576 @item ovlymgr.c
8577 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8578 @item foo.c
8579 @itemx bar.c
8580 @itemx baz.c
8581 @itemx grbx.c
8582 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8583 @item d10v.ld
8584 @itemx m32r.ld
8585 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8586 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8587 @end table
8588
8589 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8590 cross-compiler like this:
8591
8592 @smallexample
8593 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8594 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8595 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8596 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8597 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8598 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8599 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8600 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8601 @end smallexample
8602
8603 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8604 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8605 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
8606
8607
8608 @node Languages
8609 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
8610 @cindex languages
8611
8612 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
8613 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
8614 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
8615 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
8616 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
8617 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
8618
8619 @cindex working language
8620 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
8621 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
8622 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
8623 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
8624 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
8625 language}.
8626
8627 @menu
8628 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
8629 * Show:: Displaying the language
8630 * Checks:: Type and range checks
8631 * Supported languages:: Supported languages
8632 * Unsupported languages:: Unsupported languages
8633 @end menu
8634
8635 @node Setting
8636 @section Switching between source languages
8637
8638 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
8639 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
8640 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
8641 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
8642 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
8643 are printed, etc.
8644
8645 In addition to the working language, every source file that
8646 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
8647 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
8648 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
8649 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
8650 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
8651 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
8652 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
8653 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
8654 Displaying the language}.
8655
8656 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
8657 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
8658 another language. In that case, make the
8659 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
8660 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
8661 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
8662
8663 @menu
8664 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
8665 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
8666 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8667 @end menu
8668
8669 @node Filenames
8670 @subsection List of filename extensions and languages
8671
8672 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
8673 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
8674
8675 @table @file
8676 @item .ada
8677 @itemx .ads
8678 @itemx .adb
8679 @itemx .a
8680 Ada source file.
8681
8682 @item .c
8683 C source file
8684
8685 @item .C
8686 @itemx .cc
8687 @itemx .cp
8688 @itemx .cpp
8689 @itemx .cxx
8690 @itemx .c++
8691 C@t{++} source file
8692
8693 @item .m
8694 Objective-C source file
8695
8696 @item .f
8697 @itemx .F
8698 Fortran source file
8699
8700 @item .mod
8701 Modula-2 source file
8702
8703 @item .s
8704 @itemx .S
8705 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
8706 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
8707 @end table
8708
8709 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
8710 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
8711
8712 @node Manually
8713 @subsection Setting the working language
8714
8715 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
8716 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
8717 your program.
8718
8719 @kindex set language
8720 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
8721 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
8722 a language, such as
8723 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
8724 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
8725
8726 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
8727 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
8728 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
8729 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
8730 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
8731 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
8732 command such as:
8733
8734 @smallexample
8735 print a = b + c
8736 @end smallexample
8737
8738 @noindent
8739 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
8740 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
8741 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
8742 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
8743
8744 @node Automatically
8745 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8746
8747 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
8748 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
8749 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
8750 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
8751 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
8752 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
8753 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
8754 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
8755 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
8756
8757 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
8758 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
8759 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
8760 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
8761 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
8762
8763 @node Show
8764 @section Displaying the language
8765
8766 The following commands help you find out which language is the
8767 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
8768
8769 @table @code
8770 @item show language
8771 @kindex show language
8772 Display the current working language. This is the
8773 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
8774 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
8775
8776 @item info frame
8777 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
8778 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
8779 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
8780 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
8781 information listed here.
8782
8783 @item info source
8784 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
8785 Display the source language of this source file.
8786 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
8787 information listed here.
8788 @end table
8789
8790 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
8791 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
8792 with a language explicitly:
8793
8794 @table @code
8795 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
8796 @kindex set extension-language
8797 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
8798 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
8799
8800 @item info extensions
8801 @kindex info extensions
8802 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
8803 @end table
8804
8805 @node Checks
8806 @section Type and range checking
8807
8808 @quotation
8809 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
8810 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
8811 section documents the intended facilities.
8812 @end quotation
8813 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
8814
8815 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
8816 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
8817 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
8818 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
8819 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
8820 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
8821 errors when your program is running.
8822
8823 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
8824 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
8825 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
8826 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
8827 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
8828 automatically based on your program's source language.
8829 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default
8830 settings of supported languages.
8831
8832 @menu
8833 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
8834 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
8835 @end menu
8836
8837 @cindex type checking
8838 @cindex checks, type
8839 @node Type Checking
8840 @subsection An overview of type checking
8841
8842 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
8843 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
8844 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
8845 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
8846
8847 @smallexample
8848 1 + 2 @result{} 3
8849 @exdent but
8850 @error{} 1 + 2.3
8851 @end smallexample
8852
8853 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
8854 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
8855
8856 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
8857 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
8858 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
8859 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
8860 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
8861 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
8862 also issues a warning.
8863
8864 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
8865 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
8866 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
8867 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
8868 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
8869 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
8870
8871 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
8872 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
8873 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
8874 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
8875 operators. @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for further
8876 details on specific languages.
8877
8878 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
8879
8880 @kindex set check type
8881 @kindex show check type
8882 @table @code
8883 @item set check type auto
8884 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
8885 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
8886 each language.
8887
8888 @item set check type on
8889 @itemx set check type off
8890 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8891 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
8892 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
8893 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
8894 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
8895
8896 @item set check type warn
8897 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
8898 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
8899 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
8900 numbers and structures.
8901
8902 @item show type
8903 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
8904 is setting it automatically.
8905 @end table
8906
8907 @cindex range checking
8908 @cindex checks, range
8909 @node Range Checking
8910 @subsection An overview of range checking
8911
8912 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
8913 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
8914 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
8915 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
8916 not exceed the bounds of the array.
8917
8918 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
8919 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
8920 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
8921 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
8922
8923 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
8924 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
8925 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
8926 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
8927 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
8928 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
8929
8930 @smallexample
8931 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
8932 @end smallexample
8933
8934 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
8935 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported languages, ,
8936 Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
8937
8938 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
8939
8940 @kindex set check range
8941 @kindex show check range
8942 @table @code
8943 @item set check range auto
8944 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
8945 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
8946 each language.
8947
8948 @item set check range on
8949 @itemx set check range off
8950 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8951 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
8952 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
8953 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
8954
8955 @item set check range warn
8956 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
8957 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
8958 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
8959 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
8960 systems).
8961
8962 @item show range
8963 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
8964 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
8965 @end table
8966
8967 @node Supported languages
8968 @section Supported languages
8969
8970 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
8971 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
8972 @c This is false ...
8973 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
8974 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
8975 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
8976 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
8977 language.
8978
8979 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
8980 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
8981 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
8982 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
8983 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
8984 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
8985 language reference or tutorial.
8986
8987 @menu
8988 * C:: C and C@t{++}
8989 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
8990 * Fortran:: Fortran
8991 * Pascal:: Pascal
8992 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
8993 * Ada:: Ada
8994 @end menu
8995
8996 @node C
8997 @subsection C and C@t{++}
8998
8999 @cindex C and C@t{++}
9000 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
9001
9002 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
9003 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
9004 together.
9005
9006 @cindex C@t{++}
9007 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
9008 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
9009 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
9010 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
9011 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
9012 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
9013 compiler (@code{aCC}).
9014
9015 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
9016 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
9017 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
9018 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
9019 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
9020 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
9021
9022 @menu
9023 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9024 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9025 * C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9026 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9027 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9028 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9029 * Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9030 @end menu
9031
9032 @node C Operators
9033 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
9034
9035 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9036
9037 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9038 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9039 often defined on groups of types.
9040
9041 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
9042
9043 @itemize @bullet
9044
9045 @item
9046 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
9047 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
9048
9049 @item
9050 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
9051 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
9052
9053 @item
9054 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
9055
9056 @item
9057 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
9058
9059 @end itemize
9060
9061 @noindent
9062 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9063 in order of increasing precedence:
9064
9065 @table @code
9066 @item ,
9067 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
9068 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
9069 expression being the last expression evaluated.
9070
9071 @item =
9072 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
9073 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
9074
9075 @item @var{op}=
9076 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
9077 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
9078 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
9079 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
9080 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
9081
9082 @item ?:
9083 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9084 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9085 integral type.
9086
9087 @item ||
9088 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9089
9090 @item &&
9091 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9092
9093 @item |
9094 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9095
9096 @item ^
9097 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9098
9099 @item &
9100 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9101
9102 @item ==@r{, }!=
9103 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9104 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9105
9106 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9107 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9108 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9109 and non-zero for true.
9110
9111 @item <<@r{, }>>
9112 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9113
9114 @item @@
9115 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9116
9117 @item +@r{, }-
9118 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9119 pointer types.
9120
9121 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9122 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9123 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9124 integral types.
9125
9126 @item ++@r{, }--
9127 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9128 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9129 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9130 operation takes place.
9131
9132 @item *
9133 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9134 @code{++}.
9135
9136 @item &
9137 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9138
9139 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9140 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9141 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
9142 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9143 stored.
9144
9145 @item -
9146 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9147 precedence as @code{++}.
9148
9149 @item !
9150 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9151 @code{++}.
9152
9153 @item ~
9154 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9155 @code{++}.
9156
9157
9158 @item .@r{, }->
9159 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9160 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9161 pointer based on the stored type information.
9162 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9163
9164 @item .*@r{, }->*
9165 Dereferences of pointers to members.
9166
9167 @item []
9168 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9169 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9170
9171 @item ()
9172 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9173
9174 @item ::
9175 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9176 and @code{class} types.
9177
9178 @item ::
9179 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9180 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9181 above.
9182 @end table
9183
9184 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9185 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9186 predefined meaning.
9187
9188 @node C Constants
9189 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
9190
9191 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9192
9193 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9194 following ways:
9195
9196 @itemize @bullet
9197 @item
9198 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9199 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9200 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9201 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9202 @code{long} value.
9203
9204 @item
9205 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9206 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9207 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9208 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9209 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9210 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9211 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9212 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9213 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9214 constant.
9215
9216 @item
9217 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9218 integral equivalents.
9219
9220 @item
9221 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9222 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9223 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9224 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9225 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9226 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9227 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9228 @samp{\n} for newline.
9229
9230 @item
9231 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9232 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9233 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9234 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9235 characters.
9236
9237 @item
9238 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9239 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9240
9241 @item
9242 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9243 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9244 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9245 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9246 @end itemize
9247
9248 @node C plus plus expressions
9249 @subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
9250
9251 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9252 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9253
9254 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9255 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
9256 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9257 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9258 @quotation
9259 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9260 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9261 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9262 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9263 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9264 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9265 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9266 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9267 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9268 C@t{++} code.
9269 @end quotation
9270
9271 @enumerate
9272
9273 @cindex member functions
9274 @item
9275 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9276
9277 @smallexample
9278 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9279 @end smallexample
9280
9281 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9282 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9283 @item
9284 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9285 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9286 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9287 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9288
9289 @cindex call overloaded functions
9290 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
9291 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9292 @item
9293 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9294 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9295 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9296 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9297 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
9298 default arguments.
9299
9300 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
9301 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
9302 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
9303 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
9304 number of function arguments.
9305
9306 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
9307 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
9308 ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
9309
9310 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
9311 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
9312 @smallexample
9313 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
9314 @end smallexample
9315
9316 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
9317 see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
9318
9319 @cindex reference declarations
9320 @item
9321 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
9322 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
9323 dereferenced.
9324
9325 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
9326 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
9327 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
9328 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
9329 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
9330
9331 @item
9332 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
9333 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
9334 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
9335 necessary, for example in an expression like
9336 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
9337 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
9338 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
9339 @end enumerate
9340
9341 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
9342 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
9343 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
9344 invoking user-defined operators.
9345
9346 @node C Defaults
9347 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
9348
9349 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
9350
9351 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
9352 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
9353 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9354 selects the working language.
9355
9356 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
9357 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
9358 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
9359 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
9360 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
9361 for further details.
9362
9363 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
9364 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
9365 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
9366
9367 @node C Checks
9368 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9369
9370 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
9371
9372 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
9373 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
9374 considers two variables type equivalent if:
9375
9376 @itemize @bullet
9377 @item
9378 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
9379 enumerated tag.
9380
9381 @item
9382 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
9383 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
9384
9385 @ignore
9386 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
9387 @c FIXME--beers?
9388 @item
9389 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
9390 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
9391 compilers.)
9392 @end ignore
9393 @end itemize
9394
9395 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
9396 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
9397 that is not itself an array.
9398
9399 @node Debugging C
9400 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
9401
9402 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
9403 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
9404 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
9405 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
9406
9407 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
9408 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
9409 ,Expressions}.
9410
9411 @node Debugging C plus plus
9412 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9413
9414 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
9415
9416 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
9417 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
9418
9419 @table @code
9420 @cindex break in overloaded functions
9421 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
9422 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
9423 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
9424 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
9425
9426 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
9427 @item rbreak @var{regex}
9428 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
9429 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
9430 classes.
9431 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
9432
9433 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
9434 @item catch throw
9435 @itemx catch catch
9436 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
9437 Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
9438
9439 @cindex inheritance
9440 @item ptype @var{typename}
9441 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
9442 @var{typename}.
9443 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
9444
9445 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
9446 @item set print demangle
9447 @itemx show print demangle
9448 @itemx set print asm-demangle
9449 @itemx show print asm-demangle
9450 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
9451 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
9452 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9453
9454 @item set print object
9455 @itemx show print object
9456 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
9457 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9458
9459 @item set print vtbl
9460 @itemx show print vtbl
9461 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
9462 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9463 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9464 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9465
9466 @kindex set overload-resolution
9467 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
9468 @item set overload-resolution on
9469 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
9470 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
9471 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
9472 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
9473 expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
9474 message.
9475
9476 @item set overload-resolution off
9477 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9478 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9479 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9480 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9481 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9482 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9483 argument types.
9484
9485 @kindex show overload-resolution
9486 @item show overload-resolution
9487 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9488
9489 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9490 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9491 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9492 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9493 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9494 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9495 @xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
9496 @end table
9497
9498 @node Objective-C
9499 @subsection Objective-C
9500
9501 @cindex Objective-C
9502 This section provides information about some commands and command
9503 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9504 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9505 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9506
9507 @menu
9508 * Method Names in Commands::
9509 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
9510 @end menu
9511
9512 @node Method Names in Commands
9513 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9514
9515 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9516 names as line specifications:
9517
9518 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9519 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9520 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9521 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9522 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9523 @itemize
9524 @item @code{clear}
9525 @item @code{break}
9526 @item @code{info line}
9527 @item @code{jump}
9528 @item @code{list}
9529 @end itemize
9530
9531 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9532
9533 @smallexample
9534 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9535 @end smallexample
9536
9537 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9538 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9539 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9540 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9541 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9542 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9543 debugged, enter:
9544
9545 @smallexample
9546 break -[Fruit create]
9547 @end smallexample
9548
9549 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9550 enter:
9551
9552 @smallexample
9553 list +[NSText initialize]
9554 @end smallexample
9555
9556 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9557 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9558 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9559 is also possible to specify just a method name:
9560
9561 @smallexample
9562 break create
9563 @end smallexample
9564
9565 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9566 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9567 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9568 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9569 none apply.
9570
9571 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9572 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9573
9574 @smallexample
9575 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9576 @end smallexample
9577
9578 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
9579 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
9580 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
9581 @kindex print-object
9582 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
9583
9584 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
9585
9586 @smallexample
9587 print -[@var{object} hash]
9588 @end smallexample
9589
9590 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
9591 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
9592 @noindent
9593 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
9594 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
9595 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
9596 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
9597 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
9598 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
9599
9600 @node Fortran
9601 @subsection Fortran
9602 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
9603
9604 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
9605 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
9606
9607 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
9608 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
9609 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
9610 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
9611 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
9612 underscore.
9613
9614 @menu
9615 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
9616 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
9617 * Special Fortran commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
9618 @end menu
9619
9620 @node Fortran Operators
9621 @subsubsection Fortran operators and expressions
9622
9623 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
9624
9625 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9626 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
9627 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
9628
9629 @table @code
9630 @item **
9631 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
9632 of the second one.
9633
9634 @item :
9635 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
9636 represent a section of array.
9637 @end table
9638
9639 @node Fortran Defaults
9640 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
9641
9642 @cindex Fortran Defaults
9643
9644 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
9645 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
9646 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
9647 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
9648
9649 @node Special Fortran commands
9650 @subsubsection Special Fortran commands
9651
9652 @cindex Special Fortran commands
9653
9654 @value{GDBN} had some commands to support Fortran specific feature,
9655 such as common block displaying.
9656
9657 @table @code
9658 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
9659 @kindex info common
9660 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
9661 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
9662 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
9663 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
9664 printed.
9665 @end table
9666
9667 @node Pascal
9668 @subsection Pascal
9669
9670 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
9671 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
9672 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
9673 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
9674 syntax.
9675
9676 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
9677 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
9678 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
9679
9680 @node Modula-2
9681 @subsection Modula-2
9682
9683 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
9684
9685 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
9686 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
9687 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
9688 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9689 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
9690 table.
9691
9692 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
9693 @menu
9694 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
9695 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
9696 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
9697 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
9698 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
9699 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
9700 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
9701 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9702 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9703 @end menu
9704
9705 @node M2 Operators
9706 @subsubsection Operators
9707 @cindex Modula-2 operators
9708
9709 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9710 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9711 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
9712 following definitions hold:
9713
9714 @itemize @bullet
9715
9716 @item
9717 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
9718 their subranges.
9719
9720 @item
9721 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
9722
9723 @item
9724 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
9725
9726 @item
9727 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
9728 @var{type}}.
9729
9730 @item
9731 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
9732
9733 @item
9734 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
9735
9736 @item
9737 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
9738 @end itemize
9739
9740 @noindent
9741 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
9742 increasing precedence:
9743
9744 @table @code
9745 @item ,
9746 Function argument or array index separator.
9747
9748 @item :=
9749 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
9750 @var{value}.
9751
9752 @item <@r{, }>
9753 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
9754 types.
9755
9756 @item <=@r{, }>=
9757 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
9758 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
9759 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
9760
9761 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
9762 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
9763 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
9764 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
9765 comment character.
9766
9767 @item IN
9768 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
9769 Same precedence as @code{<}.
9770
9771 @item OR
9772 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9773
9774 @item AND@r{, }&
9775 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9776
9777 @item @@
9778 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9779
9780 @item +@r{, }-
9781 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
9782 and difference on set types.
9783
9784 @item *
9785 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
9786 on set types.
9787
9788 @item /
9789 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
9790 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
9791
9792 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
9793 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
9794 precedence as @code{*}.
9795
9796 @item -
9797 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
9798
9799 @item ^
9800 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
9801
9802 @item NOT
9803 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
9804 @code{^}.
9805
9806 @item .
9807 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
9808 precedence as @code{^}.
9809
9810 @item []
9811 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
9812
9813 @item ()
9814 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
9815 as @code{^}.
9816
9817 @item ::@r{, }.
9818 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
9819 @end table
9820
9821 @quotation
9822 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
9823 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
9824 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
9825 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
9826 @end quotation
9827
9828
9829 @node Built-In Func/Proc
9830 @subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
9831 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
9832
9833 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
9834 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
9835
9836 @table @var
9837
9838 @item a
9839 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
9840
9841 @item c
9842 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
9843
9844 @item i
9845 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
9846
9847 @item m
9848 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
9849 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
9850 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
9851
9852 @item n
9853 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
9854
9855 @item r
9856 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
9857
9858 @item t
9859 represents a type.
9860
9861 @item v
9862 represents a variable.
9863
9864 @item x
9865 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
9866 explanation of the function for details.
9867 @end table
9868
9869 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
9870
9871 @table @code
9872 @item ABS(@var{n})
9873 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
9874
9875 @item CAP(@var{c})
9876 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
9877 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
9878
9879 @item CHR(@var{i})
9880 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9881
9882 @item DEC(@var{v})
9883 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9884
9885 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
9886 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9887 new value.
9888
9889 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9890 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
9891 set.
9892
9893 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
9894 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
9895
9896 @item HIGH(@var{a})
9897 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
9898
9899 @item INC(@var{v})
9900 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9901
9902 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
9903 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9904 new value.
9905
9906 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9907 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
9908 there. Returns the new set.
9909
9910 @item MAX(@var{t})
9911 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
9912
9913 @item MIN(@var{t})
9914 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
9915
9916 @item ODD(@var{i})
9917 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
9918
9919 @item ORD(@var{x})
9920 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
9921 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
9922 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
9923 integral, character and enumerated types.
9924
9925 @item SIZE(@var{x})
9926 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
9927
9928 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
9929 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
9930
9931 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
9932 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9933 @end table
9934
9935 @quotation
9936 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
9937 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
9938 an error.
9939 @end quotation
9940
9941 @cindex Modula-2 constants
9942 @node M2 Constants
9943 @subsubsection Constants
9944
9945 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
9946 ways:
9947
9948 @itemize @bullet
9949
9950 @item
9951 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
9952 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
9953 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
9954 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
9955
9956 @item
9957 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
9958 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
9959 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
9960 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
9961 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
9962 digits.
9963
9964 @item
9965 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
9966 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
9967 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
9968 followed by a @samp{C}.
9969
9970 @item
9971 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
9972 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
9973 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
9974 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
9975 sequences.
9976
9977 @item
9978 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
9979
9980 @item
9981 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
9982 @code{FALSE}.
9983
9984 @item
9985 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
9986
9987 @item
9988 Set constants are not yet supported.
9989 @end itemize
9990
9991 @node M2 Types
9992 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
9993 @cindex Modula-2 types
9994
9995 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
9996 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
9997 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
9998 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
9999 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
10000 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
10001
10002 The first example contains the following section of code:
10003
10004 @smallexample
10005 VAR
10006 s: SET OF CHAR ;
10007 r: [20..40] ;
10008 @end smallexample
10009
10010 @noindent
10011 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
10012 @code{r} and @code{s}.
10013
10014 @smallexample
10015 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10016 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
10017 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10018 SET OF CHAR
10019 (@value{GDBP}) print r
10020 21
10021 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
10022 [20..40]
10023 @end smallexample
10024
10025 @noindent
10026 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
10027
10028 @smallexample
10029 VAR
10030 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
10031 @end smallexample
10032
10033 @noindent
10034 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
10035
10036 @smallexample
10037 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10038 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
10039 @end smallexample
10040
10041 @noindent
10042 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
10043 expressions using the debugger.
10044
10045 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
10046 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
10047
10048 @smallexample
10049 VAR
10050 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
10051 @end smallexample
10052
10053 @smallexample
10054 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10055 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
10056 @end smallexample
10057
10058 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
10059 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
10060 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
10061 above. Unbounded arrays are also not yet recognized in @value{GDBN}.
10062
10063 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
10064
10065 @smallexample
10066 TYPE
10067 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10068 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10069 VAR
10070 s: t ;
10071 BEGIN
10072 s := blue ;
10073 @end smallexample
10074
10075 @noindent
10076 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10077 and value of a variable.
10078
10079 @smallexample
10080 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10081 $1 = blue
10082 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10083 type = [blue..yellow]
10084 @end smallexample
10085
10086 @noindent
10087 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10088 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10089 their @code{C} counterparts.
10090
10091 @smallexample
10092 VAR
10093 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10094 BEGIN
10095 s[1] := 1 ;
10096 @end smallexample
10097
10098 @smallexample
10099 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10100 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10101 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10102 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10103 @end smallexample
10104
10105 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10106 pointer types as shown in this example:
10107
10108 @smallexample
10109 VAR
10110 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10111 BEGIN
10112 NEW(s) ;
10113 s^[1] := 1 ;
10114 @end smallexample
10115
10116 @noindent
10117 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10118
10119 @smallexample
10120 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10121 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10122 @end smallexample
10123
10124 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10125 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10126 types:
10127
10128 @smallexample
10129 TYPE
10130 foo = RECORD
10131 f1: CARDINAL ;
10132 f2: CHAR ;
10133 f3: myarray ;
10134 END ;
10135
10136 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10137 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10138 VAR
10139 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10140 @end smallexample
10141
10142 @noindent
10143 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10144 below.
10145
10146 @smallexample
10147 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10148 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10149 f1 : CARDINAL;
10150 f2 : CHAR;
10151 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10152 END
10153 @end smallexample
10154
10155 @node M2 Defaults
10156 @subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
10157 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
10158
10159 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10160 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10161 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10162 selected the working language.
10163
10164 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10165 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10166 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
10167 the language automatically}, for further details.
10168
10169 @node Deviations
10170 @subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
10171 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10172
10173 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10174 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10175
10176 @itemize @bullet
10177 @item
10178 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10179 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10180 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10181 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10182 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10183 returned a pointer.)
10184
10185 @item
10186 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10187 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10188 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10189 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10190
10191 @item
10192 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10193 argument.
10194
10195 @item
10196 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10197 @end itemize
10198
10199 @node M2 Checks
10200 @subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
10201 @cindex Modula-2 checks
10202
10203 @quotation
10204 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10205 range checking.
10206 @end quotation
10207 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10208
10209 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
10210
10211 @itemize @bullet
10212 @item
10213 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
10214 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
10215
10216 @item
10217 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
10218 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
10219 @end itemize
10220
10221 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
10222 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10223
10224 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10225 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10226
10227 @node M2 Scope
10228 @subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10229 @cindex scope
10230 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10231 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10232 @ifinfo
10233 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10234 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10235 @end ifinfo
10236 @iftex
10237 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10238 @end iftex
10239
10240 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10241 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10242 similar syntax:
10243
10244 @smallexample
10245
10246 @var{module} . @var{id}
10247 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
10248 @end smallexample
10249
10250 @noindent
10251 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10252 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10253 identifier within your program, except another module.
10254
10255 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10256 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10257 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10258 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
10259
10260 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
10261 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
10262 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
10263 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
10264 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
10265 @var{module}.
10266
10267 @node GDB/M2
10268 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10269
10270 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
10271 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
10272 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
10273 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
10274 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
10275 analogue in Modula-2.
10276
10277 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
10278 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
10279 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
10280 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
10281 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
10282 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
10283
10284 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
10285 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
10286 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
10287
10288 @node Ada
10289 @subsection Ada
10290 @cindex Ada
10291
10292 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
10293 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
10294 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
10295 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10296 to be difficult.
10297
10298
10299 @cindex expressions in Ada
10300 @menu
10301 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
10302 and semantics supported by Ada mode
10303 in @value{GDBN}.
10304 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
10305 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
10306 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
10307 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
10308 @end menu
10309
10310 @node Ada Mode Intro
10311 @subsubsection Introduction
10312 @cindex Ada mode, general
10313
10314 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
10315 syntax, with some extensions.
10316 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
10317
10318 @itemize @bullet
10319 @item
10320 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
10321 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
10322 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
10323 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
10324
10325 @item
10326 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
10327 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10328
10329 @item
10330 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10331 @end itemize
10332
10333 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
10334 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
10335 packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
10336 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
10337 @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
10338
10339 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
10340 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
10341 was translated from an Ada source file.
10342
10343 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
10344 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
10345 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
10346 middle (to allow based literals).
10347
10348 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
10349 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
10350 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
10351 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
10352 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
10353 functions to procedures elsewhere.
10354
10355 @node Omissions from Ada
10356 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
10357 @cindex Ada, omissions from
10358
10359 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
10360
10361 @itemize @bullet
10362 @item
10363 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
10364
10365 @itemize @minus
10366 @item
10367 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
10368 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
10369
10370 @item
10371 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
10372
10373 @item
10374 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
10375
10376 @item
10377 @t{'Tag}.
10378
10379 @item
10380 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
10381 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
10382
10383 @item
10384 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
10385 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
10386
10387 @item
10388 @t{'Address}.
10389 @end itemize
10390
10391 @item
10392 The names in
10393 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
10394 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
10395 not currently available.
10396
10397 @item
10398 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
10399 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
10400 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
10401 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
10402 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
10403 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
10404 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
10405 indeterminate values.
10406
10407 @item
10408 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
10409 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
10410 are not implemented.
10411
10412 @item
10413 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
10414 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
10415 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
10416 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
10417 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
10418
10419 @smallexample
10420 set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
10421 set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
10422 set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
10423 set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
10424 set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
10425 set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
10426 @end smallexample
10427
10428 Changing a
10429 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
10430 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
10431 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
10432 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
10433 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
10434 declared to have a type such as:
10435
10436 @smallexample
10437 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
10438 Id : Integer;
10439 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
10440 end record;
10441 @end smallexample
10442
10443 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
10444 assignments:
10445
10446 @smallexample
10447 set A_Rec.Len := 4
10448 set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
10449 @end smallexample
10450
10451 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
10452 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
10453 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
10454 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
10455 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
10456 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
10457 redundant component associations, although which component values are
10458 assigned in such cases is not defined.
10459
10460 @item
10461 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
10462
10463 @item
10464 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
10465 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in which a subexpression
10466 appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much looser in its rules for allowing
10467 type matches. As a result, some function calls will be ambiguous, and the user
10468 will be asked to choose the proper resolution.
10469
10470 @item
10471 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
10472
10473 @item
10474 Entry calls are not implemented.
10475
10476 @item
10477 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
10478 formats are not supported.
10479
10480 @item
10481 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
10482 @end itemize
10483
10484 @node Additions to Ada
10485 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
10486 @cindex Ada, deviations from
10487
10488 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
10489 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
10490
10491 @itemize @bullet
10492 @item
10493 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory
10494 (typically a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is
10495 a positive integer, then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of
10496 @var{E} and the @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array.
10497 In Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use
10498 is in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in Ada.
10499 However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs
10500 in which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
10501
10502 @item
10503 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that appears
10504 in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name, you must typically
10505 surround it in single quotes.
10506
10507 @item
10508 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
10509 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
10510
10511 @item
10512 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
10513 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
10514 @end itemize
10515
10516 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright additions specific
10517 to Ada:
10518
10519 @itemize @bullet
10520 @item
10521 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
10522 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
10523
10524 @smallexample
10525 set x := y + 3
10526 print A(tmp := y + 1)
10527 @end smallexample
10528
10529 @item
10530 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
10531 the value of its right-hand operand.
10532 This allows, for example,
10533 complex conditional breaks:
10534
10535 @smallexample
10536 break f
10537 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
10538 @end smallexample
10539
10540 @item
10541 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
10542 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
10543 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
10544 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
10545 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
10546 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
10547 in strings. For example,
10548 @smallexample
10549 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
10550 @end smallexample
10551 @noindent
10552 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF}) after each
10553 period.
10554
10555 @item
10556 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
10557 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
10558 to write
10559
10560 @smallexample
10561 print 'max(x, y)
10562 @end smallexample
10563
10564 @item
10565 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
10566 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
10567 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound of 3 might print as
10568
10569 @smallexample
10570 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
10571 @end smallexample
10572
10573 @noindent
10574 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
10575 clause.
10576
10577 @item
10578 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
10579 multi-character subsequence of
10580 their names (an exact match gets preference).
10581 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
10582 in place of @t{a'length}.
10583
10584 @item
10585 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
10586 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
10587 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
10588 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
10589 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
10590 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
10591 For example,
10592 @smallexample
10593 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
10594 @end smallexample
10595
10596 @item
10597 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
10598 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
10599 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
10600 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
10601 object.
10602
10603 @end itemize
10604
10605 @node Stopping Before Main Program
10606 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
10607
10608 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
10609 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
10610 before reaching the main procedure.
10611 As defined in the Ada Reference
10612 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
10613 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
10614 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
10615 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
10616
10617 @node Ada Glitches
10618 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
10619 @cindex Ada, problems
10620
10621 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
10622 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
10623 @value{GDBN},
10624 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
10625 and the GNU Ada compiler.
10626
10627 @itemize @bullet
10628 @item
10629 Currently, the debugger
10630 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
10631 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
10632 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
10633 to get it printed properly.
10634
10635 @item
10636 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
10637 storage are invisible to the debugger.
10638
10639 @item
10640 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
10641 argument lists are treated as positional).
10642
10643 @item
10644 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
10645
10646 @item
10647 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
10648 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
10649 the host machine.
10650
10651 @item
10652 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
10653
10654 @item
10655 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
10656 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
10657 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
10658 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
10659 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
10660 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
10661 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
10662 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
10663 you can usually resolve the confusion
10664 by qualifying the problematic names with package
10665 @code{Standard} explicitly.
10666 @end itemize
10667
10668 @node Unsupported languages
10669 @section Unsupported languages
10670
10671 @cindex unsupported languages
10672 @cindex minimal language
10673 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
10674 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
10675 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
10676 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
10677 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
10678 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
10679
10680 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
10681 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
10682 language.
10683
10684 @node Symbols
10685 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
10686
10687 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
10688 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
10689 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
10690 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
10691 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
10692 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
10693 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
10694
10695 @cindex symbol names
10696 @cindex names of symbols
10697 @cindex quoting names
10698 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
10699 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
10700 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
10701 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
10702 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
10703 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
10704 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
10705 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
10706
10707 @smallexample
10708 p 'foo.c'::x
10709 @end smallexample
10710
10711 @noindent
10712 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
10713
10714 @table @code
10715 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
10716 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
10717 @kindex set case-sensitive
10718 @item set case-sensitive on
10719 @itemx set case-sensitive off
10720 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
10721 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
10722 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
10723 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
10724 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
10725 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
10726 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
10727 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
10728 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
10729 case-insensitive matches.
10730
10731 @kindex show case-sensitive
10732 @item show case-sensitive
10733 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
10734 lookups.
10735
10736 @kindex info address
10737 @cindex address of a symbol
10738 @item info address @var{symbol}
10739 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
10740 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
10741 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
10742 is always stored.
10743
10744 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
10745 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
10746 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
10747
10748 @kindex info symbol
10749 @cindex symbol from address
10750 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
10751 @item info symbol @var{addr}
10752 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
10753 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
10754 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
10755
10756 @smallexample
10757 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
10758 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
10759 @end smallexample
10760
10761 @noindent
10762 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
10763 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
10764
10765 @kindex whatis
10766 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
10767 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
10768 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
10769 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
10770 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
10771 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
10772 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
10773 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
10774 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
10775 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
10776 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10777
10778 @kindex ptype
10779 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
10780 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
10781 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
10782 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10783
10784 For example, for this variable declaration:
10785
10786 @smallexample
10787 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
10788 @end smallexample
10789
10790 @noindent
10791 the two commands give this output:
10792
10793 @smallexample
10794 @group
10795 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
10796 type = struct complex
10797 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
10798 type = struct complex @{
10799 double real;
10800 double imag;
10801 @}
10802 @end group
10803 @end smallexample
10804
10805 @noindent
10806 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
10807 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
10808
10809 @cindex incomplete type
10810 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
10811 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
10812 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
10813 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
10814 given these declarations:
10815
10816 @smallexample
10817 struct foo;
10818 struct foo *fooptr;
10819 @end smallexample
10820
10821 @noindent
10822 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
10823
10824 @smallexample
10825 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
10826 $1 = <incomplete type>
10827 @end smallexample
10828
10829 @noindent
10830 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
10831 completely specified.
10832
10833 @kindex info types
10834 @item info types @var{regexp}
10835 @itemx info types
10836 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
10837 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
10838 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
10839 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
10840 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
10841 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
10842 name is @code{value}.
10843
10844 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
10845 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
10846 lists all source files where a type is defined.
10847
10848 @kindex info scope
10849 @cindex local variables
10850 @item info scope @var{location}
10851 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
10852 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
10853 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
10854 to the scope defined by that location. For example:
10855
10856 @smallexample
10857 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
10858 Scope for command_line_handler:
10859 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
10860 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
10861 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
10862 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
10863 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
10864 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
10865 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
10866 @end smallexample
10867
10868 @noindent
10869 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
10870 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
10871 collect}.
10872
10873 @kindex info source
10874 @item info source
10875 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
10876 the function containing the current point of execution:
10877 @itemize @bullet
10878 @item
10879 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
10880 @item
10881 the directory it was compiled in,
10882 @item
10883 its length, in lines,
10884 @item
10885 which programming language it is written in,
10886 @item
10887 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
10888 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
10889 @item
10890 whether the debugging information includes information about
10891 preprocessor macros.
10892 @end itemize
10893
10894
10895 @kindex info sources
10896 @item info sources
10897 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
10898 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
10899 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
10900
10901 @kindex info functions
10902 @item info functions
10903 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
10904
10905 @item info functions @var{regexp}
10906 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
10907 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
10908 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
10909 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
10910 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
10911 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
10912 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
10913
10914 @kindex info variables
10915 @item info variables
10916 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
10917 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
10918
10919 @item info variables @var{regexp}
10920 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
10921 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
10922 @var{regexp}.
10923
10924 @kindex info classes
10925 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
10926 @item info classes
10927 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
10928 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
10929 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10930 expression.
10931
10932 @kindex info selectors
10933 @item info selectors
10934 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
10935 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
10936 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10937 expression.
10938
10939 @ignore
10940 This was never implemented.
10941 @kindex info methods
10942 @item info methods
10943 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
10944 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
10945 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
10946 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
10947 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
10948 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
10949 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
10950 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
10951 @end ignore
10952
10953 @cindex reloading symbols
10954 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
10955 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
10956 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
10957 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
10958 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
10959
10960 @table @code
10961 @kindex set symbol-reloading
10962 @item set symbol-reloading on
10963 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
10964 object file with a particular name is seen again.
10965
10966 @item set symbol-reloading off
10967 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
10968 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
10969 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
10970 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
10971 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
10972 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
10973 name.
10974
10975 @kindex show symbol-reloading
10976 @item show symbol-reloading
10977 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
10978 @end table
10979
10980 @cindex opaque data types
10981 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
10982 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
10983 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
10984 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
10985 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
10986 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
10987 another source file. The default is on.
10988
10989 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
10990 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
10991
10992 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
10993 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
10994 is printed as follows:
10995 @smallexample
10996 @{<no data fields>@}
10997 @end smallexample
10998
10999 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
11000 @item show opaque-type-resolution
11001 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
11002
11003 @kindex maint print symbols
11004 @cindex symbol dump
11005 @kindex maint print psymbols
11006 @cindex partial symbol dump
11007 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
11008 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
11009 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
11010 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
11011 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
11012 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
11013 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
11014 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
11015 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
11016 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
11017 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
11018 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
11019 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
11020 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
11021 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
11022 @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
11023 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
11024
11025 @kindex maint info symtabs
11026 @kindex maint info psymtabs
11027 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
11028 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11029 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11030 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11031 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11032 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11033
11034 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
11035 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
11036 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
11037 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
11038 structure in more detail. For example:
11039
11040 @smallexample
11041 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
11042 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11043 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11044 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11045 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
11046 readin no
11047 fullname (null)
11048 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
11049 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
11050 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
11051 dependencies (none)
11052 @}
11053 @}
11054 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11055 (@value{GDBP})
11056 @end smallexample
11057 @noindent
11058 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
11059 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
11060 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
11061 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
11062 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
11063
11064 @smallexample
11065 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
11066 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
11067 line 1574.
11068 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11069 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11070 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11071 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11072 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
11073 dirname (null)
11074 fullname (null)
11075 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
11076 debugformat DWARF 2
11077 @}
11078 @}
11079 (@value{GDBP})
11080 @end smallexample
11081 @end table
11082
11083
11084 @node Altering
11085 @chapter Altering Execution
11086
11087 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
11088 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
11089 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
11090 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
11091 program.
11092
11093 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
11094 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
11095 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
11096
11097 @menu
11098 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
11099 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
11100 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
11101 * Returning:: Returning from a function
11102 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
11103 * Patching:: Patching your program
11104 @end menu
11105
11106 @node Assignment
11107 @section Assignment to variables
11108
11109 @cindex assignment
11110 @cindex setting variables
11111 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
11112 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
11113
11114 @smallexample
11115 print x=4
11116 @end smallexample
11117
11118 @noindent
11119 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11120 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11121 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11122 information on operators in supported languages.
11123
11124 @kindex set variable
11125 @cindex variables, setting
11126 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11127 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11128 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11129 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11130 ,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11131
11132 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11133 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11134 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11135 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11136 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11137 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11138 command @code{set width}:
11139
11140 @smallexample
11141 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11142 type = double
11143 (@value{GDBP}) p width
11144 $4 = 13
11145 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11146 Invalid syntax in expression.
11147 @end smallexample
11148
11149 @noindent
11150 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11151 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11152
11153 @smallexample
11154 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11155 @end smallexample
11156
11157 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11158 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11159 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11160 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11161 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11162 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11163
11164 @smallexample
11165 @group
11166 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11167 type = double
11168 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11169 $1 = 1
11170 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11171 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11172 $2 = 1
11173 (@value{GDBP}) r
11174 The program being debugged has been started already.
11175 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11176 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11177 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11178 Invalid bfd target.
11179 (@value{GDBP}) show g
11180 The current BFD target is "=4".
11181 @end group
11182 @end smallexample
11183
11184 @noindent
11185 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
11186 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
11187 @code{g}, use
11188
11189 @smallexample
11190 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
11191 @end smallexample
11192
11193 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
11194 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
11195 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
11196 same length or shorter.
11197 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
11198 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
11199
11200 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
11201 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
11202 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
11203 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
11204 and representation in memory), and
11205
11206 @smallexample
11207 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
11208 @end smallexample
11209
11210 @noindent
11211 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
11212
11213 @node Jumping
11214 @section Continuing at a different address
11215
11216 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
11217 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
11218 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
11219
11220 @table @code
11221 @kindex jump
11222 @item jump @var{linespec}
11223 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
11224 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
11225 source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
11226 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
11227 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
11228 breakpoints}.
11229
11230 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11231 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11232 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11233 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11234 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11235 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11236 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11237 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
11238 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
11239
11240 @item jump *@var{address}
11241 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
11242 @end table
11243
11244 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
11245 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
11246 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
11247 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
11248 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
11249 example,
11250
11251 @smallexample
11252 set $pc = 0x485
11253 @end smallexample
11254
11255 @noindent
11256 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
11257 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
11258 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
11259
11260 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
11261 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
11262 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
11263 detail.
11264
11265 @c @group
11266 @node Signaling
11267 @section Giving your program a signal
11268 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
11269
11270 @table @code
11271 @kindex signal
11272 @item signal @var{signal}
11273 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
11274 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
11275 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
11276 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
11277
11278 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
11279 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
11280 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
11281 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
11282 signal.
11283
11284 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
11285 after executing the command.
11286 @end table
11287 @c @end group
11288
11289 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
11290 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
11291 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
11292 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
11293 passes the signal directly to your program.
11294
11295
11296 @node Returning
11297 @section Returning from a function
11298
11299 @table @code
11300 @cindex returning from a function
11301 @kindex return
11302 @item return
11303 @itemx return @var{expression}
11304 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
11305 command. If you give an
11306 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
11307 value.
11308 @end table
11309
11310 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
11311 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
11312 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
11313 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
11314
11315 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
11316 frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
11317 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
11318 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
11319 of functions.
11320
11321 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
11322 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
11323 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
11324 and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
11325 selected stack frame returns naturally.
11326
11327 @node Calling
11328 @section Calling program functions
11329
11330 @table @code
11331 @cindex calling functions
11332 @cindex inferior functions, calling
11333 @item print @var{expr}
11334 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
11335 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
11336 debugged.
11337
11338 @kindex call
11339 @item call @var{expr}
11340 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
11341 returned values.
11342
11343 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
11344 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
11345 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
11346 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
11347 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
11348 value history.
11349 @end table
11350
11351 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
11352 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
11353 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
11354 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
11355
11356 @table @code
11357 @item set unwindonsignal
11358 @kindex set unwindonsignal
11359 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
11360 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
11361 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
11362 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
11363 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
11364 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
11365 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
11366 received.
11367
11368 @item show unwindonsignal
11369 @kindex show unwindonsignal
11370 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
11371 @value{GDBN}.
11372 @end table
11373
11374 @cindex weak alias functions
11375 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
11376 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
11377 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
11378 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
11379 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
11380 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
11381 function instead.
11382
11383 @node Patching
11384 @section Patching programs
11385
11386 @cindex patching binaries
11387 @cindex writing into executables
11388 @cindex writing into corefiles
11389
11390 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
11391 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
11392 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
11393 patching your program's binary.
11394
11395 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
11396 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
11397 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
11398 repairs.
11399
11400 @table @code
11401 @kindex set write
11402 @item set write on
11403 @itemx set write off
11404 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
11405 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
11406 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
11407
11408 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
11409 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
11410 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
11411
11412 @item show write
11413 @kindex show write
11414 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
11415 as well as reading.
11416 @end table
11417
11418 @node GDB Files
11419 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
11420
11421 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
11422 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
11423 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
11424 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
11425
11426 @menu
11427 * Files:: Commands to specify files
11428 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
11429 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
11430 @end menu
11431
11432 @node Files
11433 @section Commands to specify files
11434
11435 @cindex symbol table
11436 @cindex core dump file
11437
11438 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
11439 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
11440 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
11441 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
11442
11443 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
11444 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
11445 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
11446 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the gdbserver
11447 program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
11448 new files are useful.
11449
11450 @table @code
11451 @cindex executable file
11452 @kindex file
11453 @item file @var{filename}
11454 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
11455 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
11456 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
11457 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
11458 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
11459 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
11460 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
11461 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
11462
11463 @cindex unlinked object files
11464 @cindex patching object files
11465 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
11466 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
11467 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
11468 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
11469 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
11470 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
11471 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
11472 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
11473
11474 @item file
11475 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
11476 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
11477
11478 @kindex exec-file
11479 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11480 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
11481 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
11482 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
11483 discard information on the executable file.
11484
11485 @kindex symbol-file
11486 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11487 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
11488 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
11489 table and program to run from the same file.
11490
11491 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
11492 program's symbol table.
11493
11494 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
11495 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
11496 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
11497 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
11498 @value{GDBN}.
11499
11500 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
11501 executing it once.
11502
11503 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
11504 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
11505 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
11506 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
11507 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
11508 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
11509 optimized code.
11510
11511 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
11512 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
11513 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
11514 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
11515 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
11516
11517 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
11518 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
11519 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
11520 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
11521 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
11522 warnings and messages}.)
11523
11524 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
11525 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
11526 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
11527 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
11528 in stabs format.
11529
11530 @kindex readnow
11531 @cindex reading symbols immediately
11532 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
11533 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11534 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11535 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
11536 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
11537 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
11538 entire symbol table available.
11539
11540 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
11541 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
11542 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
11543 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
11544 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
11545 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
11546 @c files.
11547
11548 @kindex core-file
11549 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
11550 @itemx core
11551 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
11552 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
11553 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
11554 executable file itself for other parts.
11555
11556 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
11557 to be used.
11558
11559 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
11560 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
11561 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
11562 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
11563 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
11564
11565 @kindex add-symbol-file
11566 @cindex dynamic linking
11567 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
11568 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11569 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
11570 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
11571 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
11572 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
11573 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
11574 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
11575 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
11576 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
11577 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
11578 @var{address} as an expression.
11579
11580 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
11581 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
11582 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
11583 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
11584 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
11585
11586 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
11587 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
11588 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
11589 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
11590 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
11591 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
11592 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
11593 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
11594 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
11595
11596 @itemize @bullet
11597 @item
11598 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
11599 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
11600 @item
11601 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
11602 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
11603 @item
11604 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
11605 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
11606 @end itemize
11607
11608 @noindent
11609 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
11610 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
11611 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
11612 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
11613 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
11614 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
11615 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
11616 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
11617 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
11618 way.
11619
11620 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
11621
11622 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
11623 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
11624 @cindex load symbols from memory
11625 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
11626 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
11627 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
11628 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
11629 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
11630 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
11631 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
11632 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
11633 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
11634
11635 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
11636 @kindex assf
11637 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
11638 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
11639 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
11640 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
11641 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
11642 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
11643 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
11644 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
11645 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
11646 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
11647
11648 @kindex section
11649 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
11650 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
11651 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
11652 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
11653 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
11654 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
11655 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
11656 their addresses.
11657
11658 @kindex info files
11659 @kindex info target
11660 @item info files
11661 @itemx info target
11662 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
11663 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
11664 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
11665 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
11666 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
11667 current ones.
11668
11669 @kindex maint info sections
11670 @item maint info sections
11671 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
11672 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
11673 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
11674 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
11675 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
11676 may be arbitrarily combined):
11677
11678 @table @code
11679 @item ALLOBJ
11680 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
11681 @item @var{sections}
11682 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
11683 @item @var{section-flags}
11684 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
11685 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
11686 @table @code
11687 @item ALLOC
11688 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
11689 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
11690 @item LOAD
11691 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
11692 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
11693 @item RELOC
11694 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
11695 @item READONLY
11696 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
11697 @item CODE
11698 Section contains executable code only.
11699 @item DATA
11700 Section contains data only (no executable code).
11701 @item ROM
11702 Section will reside in ROM.
11703 @item CONSTRUCTOR
11704 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
11705 @item HAS_CONTENTS
11706 Section is not empty.
11707 @item NEVER_LOAD
11708 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
11709 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
11710 A notification to the linker that the section contains
11711 COFF shared library information.
11712 @item IS_COMMON
11713 Section contains common symbols.
11714 @end table
11715 @end table
11716 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
11717 @cindex read-only sections
11718 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
11719 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
11720 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
11721 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
11722 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
11723 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
11724 enhancement to debugging performance.
11725
11726 The default is off.
11727
11728 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
11729 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
11730 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
11731 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
11732
11733 @item show trust-readonly-sections
11734 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
11735 @end table
11736
11737 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
11738 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
11739 name and remembers it that way.
11740
11741 @cindex shared libraries
11742 @value{GDBN} supports GNU/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
11743 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
11744
11745 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
11746 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
11747 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
11748 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
11749 debugging a core file).
11750
11751 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
11752 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
11753
11754 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
11755 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
11756 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
11757
11758 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
11759 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
11760 particularly large or there are many of them.
11761
11762 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
11763 commands:
11764
11765 @table @code
11766 @kindex set auto-solib-add
11767 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
11768 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
11769 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
11770 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
11771 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
11772 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
11773 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
11774
11775 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
11776 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
11777 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
11778 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
11779 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
11780 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
11781 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
11782 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
11783 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
11784
11785 @kindex show auto-solib-add
11786 @item show auto-solib-add
11787 Display the current autoloading mode.
11788 @end table
11789
11790 @cindex load shared library
11791 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
11792 command:
11793
11794 @table @code
11795 @kindex info sharedlibrary
11796 @kindex info share
11797 @item info share
11798 @itemx info sharedlibrary
11799 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
11800
11801 @kindex sharedlibrary
11802 @kindex share
11803 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
11804 @itemx share @var{regex}
11805 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
11806 Unix regular expression.
11807 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
11808 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
11809 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
11810 loaded.
11811
11812 @item nosharedlibrary
11813 @kindex nosharedlibrary
11814 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
11815 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
11816 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
11817 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
11818 discarded.
11819 @end table
11820
11821 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
11822 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
11823 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
11824
11825 @table @code
11826 @item set stop-on-solib-events
11827 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
11828 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
11829 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
11830 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
11831 shared library.
11832
11833 @item show stop-on-solib-events
11834 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
11835 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
11836 library events happen.
11837 @end table
11838
11839 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
11840 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
11841 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
11842 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
11843 not.
11844
11845 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
11846 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
11847 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
11848 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
11849 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
11850
11851 @table @code
11852 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
11853 @cindex system root, alternate
11854 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
11855 @kindex set sysroot
11856 @item set sysroot @var{path}
11857 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
11858 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
11859 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
11860 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
11861 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
11862 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
11863 under @var{path}.
11864
11865 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
11866 sysroot}.
11867
11868 @cindex default system root
11869 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
11870 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
11871 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
11872 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
11873 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
11874 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
11875 location.
11876
11877 @kindex show sysroot
11878 @item show sysroot
11879 Display the current shared library prefix.
11880
11881 @kindex set solib-search-path
11882 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
11883 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
11884 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
11885 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
11886 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
11887 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
11888 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
11889 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
11890 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
11891 of shared library symbols.
11892
11893 @kindex show solib-search-path
11894 @item show solib-search-path
11895 Display the current shared library search path.
11896 @end table
11897
11898
11899 @node Separate Debug Files
11900 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
11901 @cindex separate debugging information files
11902 @cindex debugging information in separate files
11903 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
11904 @cindex debugging information directory, global
11905 @cindex global debugging information directory
11906
11907 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
11908 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
11909 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
11910 Since debugging information can be very large --- sometimes larger
11911 than the executable code itself --- some systems distribute debugging
11912 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
11913 install only when they need to debug a problem.
11914
11915 If an executable's debugging information has been extracted to a
11916 separate file, the executable should contain a @dfn{debug link} giving
11917 the name of the debugging information file (with no directory
11918 components), and a checksum of its contents. (The exact form of a
11919 debug link is described below.) If the full name of the directory
11920 containing the executable is @var{execdir}, and the executable has a
11921 debug link that specifies the name @var{debugfile}, then @value{GDBN}
11922 will automatically search for the debugging information file in three
11923 places:
11924
11925 @itemize @bullet
11926 @item
11927 the directory containing the executable file (that is, it will look
11928 for a file named @file{@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}},
11929 @item
11930 a subdirectory of that directory named @file{.debug} (that is, the
11931 file @file{@var{execdir}/.debug/@var{debugfile}}, and
11932 @item
11933 a subdirectory of the global debug file directory that includes the
11934 executable's full path, and the name from the link (that is, the file
11935 @file{@var{globaldebugdir}/@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}}, where
11936 @var{globaldebugdir} is the global debug file directory, and
11937 @var{execdir} has been turned into a relative path).
11938 @end itemize
11939 @noindent
11940 @value{GDBN} checks under each of these names for a debugging
11941 information file whose checksum matches that given in the link, and
11942 reads the debugging information from the first one it finds.
11943
11944 So, for example, if you ask @value{GDBN} to debug @file{/usr/bin/ls},
11945 which has a link containing the name @file{ls.debug}, and the global
11946 debug directory is @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look
11947 for debug information in @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug},
11948 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}, and
11949 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
11950
11951 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
11952 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
11953
11954 @table @code
11955
11956 @kindex set debug-file-directory
11957 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
11958 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11959 information files to @var{directory}.
11960
11961 @kindex show debug-file-directory
11962 @item show debug-file-directory
11963 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11964 information files.
11965
11966 @end table
11967
11968 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
11969 @cindex debug links
11970 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
11971 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
11972
11973 @itemize
11974 @item
11975 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
11976 a zero byte,
11977 @item
11978 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
11979 boundary within the section, and
11980 @item
11981 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
11982 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
11983 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
11984 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
11985 @end itemize
11986
11987 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
11988 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
11989 described above.
11990
11991 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
11992 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
11993 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
11994 should have the same names, addresses and sizes as the original file,
11995 but they need not contain any data --- much like a @code{.bss} section
11996 in an ordinary executable.
11997
11998 As of December 2002, there is no standard GNU utility to produce
11999 separated executable / debugging information file pairs. Ulrich
12000 Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53,
12001 contains a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command
12002 @kbd{strip foo -f foo.debug} removes the debugging information from
12003 the executable file @file{foo}, places it in the file
12004 @file{foo.debug}, and leaves behind a debug link in @file{foo}.
12005
12006 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's (different
12007 polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the simplest way to
12008 describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections is to give the
12009 complete code for a function that computes it:
12010
12011 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
12012 @smallexample
12013 unsigned long
12014 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
12015 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
12016 @{
12017 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
12018 @{
12019 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
12020 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
12021 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
12022 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
12023 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
12024 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
12025 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
12026 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
12027 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
12028 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
12029 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
12030 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
12031 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
12032 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
12033 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
12034 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
12035 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
12036 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
12037 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
12038 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
12039 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
12040 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
12041 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
12042 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
12043 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
12044 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
12045 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
12046 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
12047 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
12048 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
12049 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
12050 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
12051 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
12052 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
12053 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
12054 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
12055 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
12056 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
12057 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
12058 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
12059 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
12060 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
12061 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
12062 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
12063 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
12064 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
12065 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
12066 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
12067 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
12068 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
12069 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
12070 0x2d02ef8d
12071 @};
12072 unsigned char *end;
12073
12074 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12075 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
12076 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
12077 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12078 @}
12079 @end smallexample
12080
12081
12082 @node Symbol Errors
12083 @section Errors reading symbol files
12084
12085 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
12086 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
12087 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
12088 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
12089 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
12090 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
12091 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
12092 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
12093 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
12094 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
12095 messages}).
12096
12097 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
12098
12099 @table @code
12100 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
12101
12102 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
12103 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
12104 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
12105 in its outer scope blocks.
12106
12107 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
12108 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
12109 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
12110 function.
12111
12112 @item block at @var{address} out of order
12113
12114 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
12115 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
12116 do so.
12117
12118 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
12119 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
12120 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
12121 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
12122 messages}.)
12123
12124 @item bad block start address patched
12125
12126 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
12127 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
12128 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
12129
12130 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
12131 starting on the previous source line.
12132
12133 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
12134
12135 @cindex foo
12136 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
12137 larger than the size of the string table.
12138
12139 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
12140 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
12141 with this name.
12142
12143 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
12144
12145 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
12146 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
12147 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
12148
12149 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
12150 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
12151 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
12152 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
12153 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
12154 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
12155
12156 @item stub type has NULL name
12157
12158 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
12159
12160 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
12161 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
12162 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
12163 it.
12164
12165 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
12166
12167 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
12168
12169 @end table
12170
12171 @node Targets
12172 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
12173
12174 @cindex debugging target
12175 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
12176
12177 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
12178 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
12179 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
12180 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
12181 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
12182 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
12183 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
12184 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
12185
12186 @cindex target architecture
12187 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
12188 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
12189 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
12190 command.
12191
12192 @table @code
12193 @kindex set architecture
12194 @kindex show architecture
12195 @item set architecture @var{arch}
12196 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
12197 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
12198 supported architectures.
12199
12200 @item show architecture
12201 Show the current target architecture.
12202
12203 @item set processor
12204 @itemx processor
12205 @kindex set processor
12206 @kindex show processor
12207 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
12208 and @code{show architecture}.
12209 @end table
12210
12211 @menu
12212 * Active Targets:: Active targets
12213 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
12214 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
12215 * Remote:: Remote debugging
12216
12217 @end menu
12218
12219 @node Active Targets
12220 @section Active targets
12221
12222 @cindex stacking targets
12223 @cindex active targets
12224 @cindex multiple targets
12225
12226 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
12227 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
12228 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
12229 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
12230 a core file.
12231
12232 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
12233 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
12234 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
12235 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
12236 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
12237 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
12238 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
12239 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
12240 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
12241
12242 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
12243 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
12244 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
12245 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
12246 process target is active.
12247
12248 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
12249 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
12250 files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
12251 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
12252 process}).
12253
12254 @node Target Commands
12255 @section Commands for managing targets
12256
12257 @table @code
12258 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
12259 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
12260 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
12261 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
12262 protocol of the target machine.
12263
12264 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
12265 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
12266 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
12267
12268 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
12269 after executing the command.
12270
12271 @kindex help target
12272 @item help target
12273 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
12274 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
12275 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
12276
12277 @item help target @var{name}
12278 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
12279 select it.
12280
12281 @kindex set gnutarget
12282 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
12283 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
12284 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
12285 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
12286 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
12287 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
12288
12289 @quotation
12290 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
12291 you must know the actual BFD name.
12292 @end quotation
12293
12294 @noindent
12295 @xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
12296
12297 @kindex show gnutarget
12298 @item show gnutarget
12299 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
12300 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
12301 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
12302 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
12303 @end table
12304
12305 @cindex common targets
12306 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
12307 configuration):
12308
12309 @table @code
12310 @kindex target
12311 @item target exec @var{program}
12312 @cindex executable file target
12313 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
12314 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
12315
12316 @item target core @var{filename}
12317 @cindex core dump file target
12318 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
12319 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
12320
12321 @item target remote @var{medium}
12322 @cindex remote target
12323 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
12324 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
12325 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
12326
12327 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
12328 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
12329
12330 @smallexample
12331 target remote /dev/ttya
12332 @end smallexample
12333
12334 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
12335 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
12336 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
12337 clobbered by the download.
12338
12339 @item target sim
12340 @cindex built-in simulator target
12341 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
12342 In general,
12343 @smallexample
12344 target sim
12345 load
12346 run
12347 @end smallexample
12348 @noindent
12349 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
12350 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
12351 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
12352 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
12353 Processors}.
12354
12355 @end table
12356
12357 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
12358
12359 @table @code
12360
12361 @item target nrom @var{dev}
12362 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
12363 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
12364
12365 @end table
12366
12367 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
12368 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
12369
12370 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
12371 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
12372 various aspects of this process.
12373
12374 @table @code
12375
12376 @item set hash
12377 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12378 @cindex hash mark while downloading
12379 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
12380 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
12381 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
12382 monitor.
12383
12384 @item show hash
12385 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12386 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
12387
12388 @item set debug monitor
12389 @kindex set debug monitor
12390 @cindex display remote monitor communications
12391 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
12392 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12393
12394 @item show debug monitor
12395 @kindex show debug monitor
12396 Show the current status of displaying communications between
12397 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12398 @end table
12399
12400 @table @code
12401
12402 @kindex load @var{filename}
12403 @item load @var{filename}
12404 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
12405 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
12406 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
12407 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
12408 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
12409 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12410
12411 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
12412 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
12413 target is @dots{}}''
12414
12415 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
12416 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
12417 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
12418 specifies a fixed address.
12419 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
12420
12421 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
12422 load programs into flash memory.
12423
12424 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
12425 @end table
12426
12427 @node Byte Order
12428 @section Choosing target byte order
12429
12430 @cindex choosing target byte order
12431 @cindex target byte order
12432
12433 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
12434 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
12435 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
12436 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
12437 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
12438 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
12439
12440 @table @code
12441 @kindex set endian
12442 @item set endian big
12443 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
12444
12445 @item set endian little
12446 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
12447
12448 @item set endian auto
12449 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
12450 executable.
12451
12452 @item show endian
12453 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
12454
12455 @end table
12456
12457 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
12458 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
12459 target system.
12460
12461 @node Remote
12462 @section Remote debugging
12463 @cindex remote debugging
12464
12465 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
12466 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
12467 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
12468 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
12469 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
12470
12471 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
12472 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
12473 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
12474 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
12475 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
12476 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
12477
12478 Other remote targets may be available in your
12479 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
12480
12481 Once you've connected to the remote target, @value{GDBN} allows you to
12482 send arbitrary commands to the remote monitor:
12483
12484 @table @code
12485 @item remote @var{command}
12486 @kindex remote@r{, a command}
12487 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12488 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the remote monitor.
12489 @end table
12490
12491
12492 @node Remote Debugging
12493 @chapter Debugging remote programs
12494
12495 @menu
12496 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
12497 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
12498 * Remote configuration:: Remote configuration
12499 * remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
12500 @end menu
12501
12502 @node Connecting
12503 @section Connecting to a remote target
12504
12505 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
12506 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
12507 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
12508 program as the first argument.
12509
12510 @cindex @code{target remote}
12511 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
12512 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
12513 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
12514 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
12515 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
12516 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
12517
12518 @table @code
12519
12520 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
12521 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
12522 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
12523 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
12524
12525 @smallexample
12526 target remote /dev/ttyb
12527 @end smallexample
12528
12529 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
12530 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
12531 (@pxref{Remote configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
12532 @code{target} command.
12533
12534 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
12535 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12536 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
12537 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
12538 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
12539 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
12540 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
12541 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
12542 target.
12543
12544 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
12545 @code{manyfarms}:
12546
12547 @smallexample
12548 target remote manyfarms:2828
12549 @end smallexample
12550
12551 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
12552 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
12553 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
12554 port 1234 on your local machine:
12555
12556 @smallexample
12557 target remote :1234
12558 @end smallexample
12559 @noindent
12560
12561 Note that the colon is still required here.
12562
12563 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12564 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
12565 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
12566 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
12567
12568 @smallexample
12569 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
12570 @end smallexample
12571
12572 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
12573 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
12574 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
12575 cause havoc with your debugging session.
12576
12577 @item target remote | @var{command}
12578 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
12579 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
12580 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
12581 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
12582 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
12583 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
12584 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
12585 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
12586
12587 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
12588 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
12589 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
12590
12591 @end table
12592
12593 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
12594 commands to examine and change data and to step and continue the
12595 remote program.
12596
12597 @cindex interrupting remote programs
12598 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
12599 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
12600 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
12601 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
12602 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
12603 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
12604
12605 @smallexample
12606 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
12607 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
12608 @end smallexample
12609
12610 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
12611 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
12612 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
12613 goes back to waiting.
12614
12615 @table @code
12616 @kindex detach (remote)
12617 @item detach
12618 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
12619 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
12620 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
12621 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
12622 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
12623
12624 @kindex disconnect
12625 @item disconnect
12626 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
12627 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
12628 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
12629 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
12630 another target.
12631
12632 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12633 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
12634 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
12635 @kindex monitor
12636 @item monitor @var{cmd}
12637 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
12638 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
12639 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
12640 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
12641 and implement.
12642 @end table
12643
12644 @node Server
12645 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
12646
12647 @kindex gdbserver
12648 @cindex remote connection without stubs
12649 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
12650 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
12651 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
12652
12653 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
12654 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
12655 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
12656 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
12657 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
12658 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
12659 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
12660 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
12661 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
12662 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
12663 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
12664 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
12665 choice for debugging.
12666
12667 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
12668 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
12669 protocol.
12670
12671 @table @emph
12672 @item On the target machine,
12673 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
12674 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
12675 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
12676 system does all the symbol handling.
12677
12678 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
12679 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
12680 syntax is:
12681
12682 @smallexample
12683 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
12684 @end smallexample
12685
12686 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
12687 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
12688 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
12689 @file{/dev/com1}:
12690
12691 @smallexample
12692 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
12693 @end smallexample
12694
12695 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
12696 with it.
12697
12698 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
12699
12700 @smallexample
12701 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
12702 @end smallexample
12703
12704 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
12705 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
12706 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
12707 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
12708 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
12709 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
12710 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
12711 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
12712 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
12713 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
12714 @code{target remote} command.
12715
12716 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
12717 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
12718
12719 @smallexample
12720 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
12721 @end smallexample
12722
12723 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
12724 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
12725
12726 @pindex pidof
12727 @cindex attach to a program by name
12728 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
12729 @code{pidof} utility:
12730
12731 @smallexample
12732 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach `pidof @var{program}`
12733 @end smallexample
12734
12735 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
12736 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
12737 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
12738
12739 @item On the host machine,
12740 first make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
12741 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
12742 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
12743 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-system-root}).
12744
12745 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
12746 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
12747 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
12748 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
12749 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
12750 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
12751 programs.
12752
12753 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
12754 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
12755 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
12756 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
12757 @samp{Connection refused}. You don't need to use the @code{load}
12758 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
12759 already on the target.
12760
12761 @end table
12762
12763 @subsection Monitor commands for @code{gdbserver}
12764 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
12765
12766 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
12767 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
12768 Here are the available commands; they are only of interest when
12769 debugging @value{GDBN} or @code{gdbserver}.
12770
12771 @table @code
12772 @item monitor help
12773 List the available monitor commands.
12774
12775 @item monitor set debug 0
12776 @itemx monitor set debug 1
12777 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
12778
12779 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
12780 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
12781 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
12782 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
12783
12784 @end table
12785
12786 @node Remote configuration
12787 @section Remote configuration
12788
12789 @kindex set remote
12790 @kindex show remote
12791 This section documents the configuration options available when
12792 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
12793 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
12794 system-call-allowed}.
12795
12796 @table @code
12797 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
12798 @cindex address size for remote targets
12799 @cindex bits in remote address
12800 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
12801 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
12802 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
12803 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
12804
12805 @item show remoteaddresssize
12806 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
12807
12808 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
12809 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
12810 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
12811 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
12812 remote targets.
12813
12814 @item show remotebaud
12815 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
12816
12817 @item set remotebreak
12818 @cindex interrupt remote programs
12819 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
12820 @anchor{set remotebreak}
12821 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
12822 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
12823 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
12824 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
12825 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
12826
12827 @item show remotebreak
12828 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
12829 interrupt the remote program.
12830
12831 @item set remotedevice @var{device}
12832 @cindex serial port name
12833 Set the name of the serial port through which to communicate to the
12834 remote target to @var{device}. This is the device used by
12835 @value{GDBN} to open the serial communications line to the remote
12836 target. There's no default, so you must set a valid port name for the
12837 remote serial communications to work. (Some varieties of the
12838 @code{target} command accept the port name as part of their
12839 arguments.)
12840
12841 @item show remotedevice
12842 Show the current name of the serial port.
12843
12844 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
12845 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
12846 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
12847 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
12848 @code{ascii}.
12849
12850 @item show remotelogbase
12851 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
12852 protocol.
12853
12854 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
12855 @cindex record serial communications on file
12856 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
12857 default is not to record at all.
12858
12859 @item show remotelogfile.
12860 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
12861 serial communications.
12862
12863 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
12864 @cindex timeout for serial communications
12865 @cindex remote timeout
12866 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
12867 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
12868
12869 @item show remotetimeout
12870 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
12871 responses.
12872
12873 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
12874 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
12875 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
12876 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
12877 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
12878 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
12879 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
12880 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
12881 @end table
12882
12883 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
12884 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
12885 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
12886 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
12887 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
12888 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
12889 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
12890 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
12891 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
12892
12893 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
12894 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
12895 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
12896 @value{GDBN} developers.
12897
12898 The available settings are:
12899
12900 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.2 0.35
12901 @item Command Name
12902 @tab Remote Packet
12903 @tab Related Features
12904
12905 @item @code{fetch-register-packet}
12906 @tab @code{p}
12907 @tab @code{info registers}
12908
12909 @item @code{set-register-packet}
12910 @tab @code{P}
12911 @tab @code{set}
12912
12913 @item @code{binary-download-packet}
12914 @tab @code{X}
12915 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
12916
12917 @item @code{read-aux-vector-packet}
12918 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
12919 @tab @code{info auxv}
12920
12921 @item @code{symbol-lookup-packet}
12922 @tab @code{qSymbol}
12923 @tab Detecting multiple threads
12924
12925 @item @code{verbose-resume-packet}
12926 @tab @code{vCont}
12927 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
12928
12929 @item @code{software-breakpoint-packet}
12930 @tab @code{Z0}
12931 @tab @code{break}
12932
12933 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint-packet}
12934 @tab @code{Z1}
12935 @tab @code{hbreak}
12936
12937 @item @code{write-watchpoint-packet}
12938 @tab @code{Z2}
12939 @tab @code{watch}
12940
12941 @item @code{read-watchpoint-packet}
12942 @tab @code{Z3}
12943 @tab @code{rwatch}
12944
12945 @item @code{access-watchpoint-packet}
12946 @tab @code{Z4}
12947 @tab @code{awatch}
12948
12949 @item @code{get-thread-local-storage-address-packet}
12950 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
12951 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
12952
12953 @item @code{supported-packets}
12954 @tab @code{qSupported}
12955 @tab Remote communications parameters
12956
12957 @item @code{pass-signals-packet}
12958 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
12959 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
12960
12961 @end multitable
12962
12963 @node remote stub
12964 @section Implementing a remote stub
12965
12966 @cindex debugging stub, example
12967 @cindex remote stub, example
12968 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
12969 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
12970 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
12971 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
12972 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
12973 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
12974 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
12975 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
12976
12977 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
12978 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
12979 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
12980 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
12981 program, you need:
12982
12983 @enumerate
12984 @item
12985 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
12986 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
12987 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
12988
12989 @item
12990 A C subroutine library to support your program's
12991 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
12992
12993 @item
12994 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
12995 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
12996 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
12997 documentation.
12998 @end enumerate
12999
13000 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
13001 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
13002 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
13003
13004 @table @emph
13005 @item On the host,
13006 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
13007 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
13008 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13009
13010 @item On the target,
13011 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
13012 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
13013 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
13014
13015 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
13016 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
13017 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
13018 @end table
13019
13020 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
13021 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
13022 @sc{sparc} boards.
13023
13024 @cindex remote serial stub list
13025 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
13026
13027 @table @code
13028
13029 @item i386-stub.c
13030 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
13031 @cindex Intel
13032 @cindex i386
13033 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
13034
13035 @item m68k-stub.c
13036 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
13037 @cindex Motorola 680x0
13038 @cindex m680x0
13039 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
13040
13041 @item sh-stub.c
13042 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
13043 @cindex Renesas
13044 @cindex SH
13045 For Renesas SH architectures.
13046
13047 @item sparc-stub.c
13048 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
13049 @cindex Sparc
13050 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
13051
13052 @item sparcl-stub.c
13053 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
13054 @cindex Fujitsu
13055 @cindex SparcLite
13056 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
13057
13058 @end table
13059
13060 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
13061 recently added stubs.
13062
13063 @menu
13064 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
13065 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
13066 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
13067 @end menu
13068
13069 @node Stub Contents
13070 @subsection What the stub can do for you
13071
13072 @cindex remote serial stub
13073 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
13074 subroutines:
13075
13076 @table @code
13077 @item set_debug_traps
13078 @findex set_debug_traps
13079 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
13080 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
13081 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
13082 beginning of your program.
13083
13084 @item handle_exception
13085 @findex handle_exception
13086 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
13087 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
13088 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
13089 run when a trap is triggered.
13090
13091 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
13092 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
13093 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
13094 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
13095 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
13096 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
13097 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
13098 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
13099 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
13100 machine.
13101
13102 @item breakpoint
13103 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
13104 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
13105 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
13106 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
13107 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
13108 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
13109 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
13110 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
13111 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
13112 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
13113 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
13114
13115 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
13116 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
13117 start of your debugging session.
13118 @end table
13119
13120 @node Bootstrapping
13121 @subsection What you must do for the stub
13122
13123 @cindex remote stub, support routines
13124 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
13125 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
13126 debugging target machine.
13127
13128 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
13129 serial port.
13130
13131 @table @code
13132 @item int getDebugChar()
13133 @findex getDebugChar
13134 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
13135 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
13136 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13137
13138 @item void putDebugChar(int)
13139 @findex putDebugChar
13140 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
13141 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
13142 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13143 @end table
13144
13145 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
13146 @cindex interrupting remote targets
13147 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
13148 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
13149 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
13150 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
13151 remote system to stop.
13152
13153 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
13154 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
13155 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
13156 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
13157
13158 Other routines you need to supply are:
13159
13160 @table @code
13161 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
13162 @findex exceptionHandler
13163 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
13164 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
13165 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
13166 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
13167 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
13168 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
13169 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
13170 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
13171 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
13172 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
13173 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
13174 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
13175 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
13176
13177 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
13178 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
13179 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
13180 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
13181 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
13182
13183 @item void flush_i_cache()
13184 @findex flush_i_cache
13185 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
13186 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
13187 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
13188
13189 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
13190 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
13191 @end table
13192
13193 @noindent
13194 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
13195
13196 @table @code
13197 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
13198 @findex memset
13199 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
13200 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
13201 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
13202 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
13203 @end table
13204
13205 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
13206 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
13207 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
13208 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
13209
13210
13211 @node Debug Session
13212 @subsection Putting it all together
13213
13214 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
13215 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
13216 steps.
13217
13218 @enumerate
13219 @item
13220 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
13221 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
13222 @display
13223 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
13224 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
13225 @end display
13226
13227 @item
13228 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
13229
13230 @smallexample
13231 set_debug_traps();
13232 breakpoint();
13233 @end smallexample
13234
13235 @item
13236 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
13237 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
13238
13239 @smallexample
13240 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
13241 @end smallexample
13242
13243 @noindent
13244 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
13245 function in your program, that function is called when
13246 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
13247 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
13248 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
13249
13250 @item
13251 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
13252 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
13253
13254 @item
13255 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
13256 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
13257
13258 @item
13259 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
13260 @c document that. FIXME.
13261 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
13262 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
13263
13264 @item
13265 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
13266 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
13267
13268 @end enumerate
13269
13270 @node Configurations
13271 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
13272
13273 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
13274 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
13275 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
13276
13277 There are three major categories of configurations: native
13278 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
13279 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
13280 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
13281 are quite different from each other.
13282
13283 @menu
13284 * Native::
13285 * Embedded OS::
13286 * Embedded Processors::
13287 * Architectures::
13288 @end menu
13289
13290 @node Native
13291 @section Native
13292
13293 This section describes details specific to particular native
13294 configurations.
13295
13296 @menu
13297 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
13298 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
13299 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
13300 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
13301 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
13302 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
13303 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
13304 @end menu
13305
13306 @node HP-UX
13307 @subsection HP-UX
13308
13309 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
13310 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
13311 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
13312
13313
13314 @node BSD libkvm Interface
13315 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
13316
13317 @cindex libkvm
13318 @cindex kernel memory image
13319 @cindex kernel crash dump
13320
13321 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
13322 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
13323 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
13324 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
13325 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
13326 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
13327 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
13328 @code{kvm} target:
13329
13330 @smallexample
13331 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
13332 @end smallexample
13333
13334 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
13335 argument:
13336
13337 @smallexample
13338 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
13339 @end smallexample
13340
13341 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
13342 available:
13343
13344 @table @code
13345 @kindex kvm
13346 @item kvm pcb
13347 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
13348
13349 @item kvm proc
13350 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
13351 modern FreeBSD systems.
13352 @end table
13353
13354 @node SVR4 Process Information
13355 @subsection SVR4 process information
13356 @cindex /proc
13357 @cindex examine process image
13358 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
13359
13360 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
13361 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
13362 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
13363 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
13364 proc} is available to report information about the process running
13365 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
13366 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
13367 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
13368 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
13369
13370 @table @code
13371 @kindex info proc
13372 @cindex process ID
13373 @item info proc
13374 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
13375 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
13376 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
13377 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
13378 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
13379 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
13380 executable file's absolute file name.
13381
13382 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
13383 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
13384 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
13385 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
13386 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
13387 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
13388
13389 @item info proc mappings
13390 @cindex memory address space mappings
13391 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
13392 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
13393 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
13394 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
13395 memory access rights to that range.
13396
13397 @item info proc stat
13398 @itemx info proc status
13399 @cindex process detailed status information
13400 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
13401 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
13402 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
13403 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
13404 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
13405 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
13406 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
13407
13408 @item info proc all
13409 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
13410 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
13411
13412 @ignore
13413 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
13414 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
13415 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
13416 @kindex info proc times
13417 @item info proc times
13418 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
13419 its children.
13420
13421 @kindex info proc id
13422 @item info proc id
13423 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
13424 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
13425 @end ignore
13426
13427 @item set procfs-trace
13428 @kindex set procfs-trace
13429 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
13430 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
13431
13432 @item show procfs-trace
13433 @kindex show procfs-trace
13434 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
13435
13436 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
13437 @kindex set procfs-file
13438 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
13439 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
13440 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
13441 standard output.
13442
13443 @item show procfs-file
13444 @kindex show procfs-file
13445 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
13446
13447 @item proc-trace-entry
13448 @itemx proc-trace-exit
13449 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
13450 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
13451 @kindex proc-trace-entry
13452 @kindex proc-trace-exit
13453 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
13454 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
13455 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
13456 from the @code{syscall} interface.
13457
13458 @item info pidlist
13459 @kindex info pidlist
13460 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
13461 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
13462 processes and all the threads within each process.
13463
13464 @item info meminfo
13465 @kindex info meminfo
13466 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
13467 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
13468 @end table
13469
13470 @node DJGPP Native
13471 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
13472 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
13473 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
13474 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
13475
13476 @cindex DPMI
13477 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
13478 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
13479 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
13480 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
13481
13482 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
13483 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
13484 subsection describes those commands.
13485
13486 @table @code
13487 @kindex info dos
13488 @item info dos
13489 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
13490 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13491
13492 @kindex sysinfo
13493 @cindex MS-DOS system info
13494 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
13495 @item info dos sysinfo
13496 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
13497 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
13498 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
13499
13500 @cindex GDT
13501 @cindex LDT
13502 @cindex IDT
13503 @cindex segment descriptor tables
13504 @cindex descriptor tables display
13505 @item info dos gdt
13506 @itemx info dos ldt
13507 @itemx info dos idt
13508 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
13509 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
13510 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
13511 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
13512 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
13513 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
13514 rights.
13515
13516 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
13517 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
13518 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
13519 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
13520 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
13521
13522 @cindex garbled pointers
13523 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
13524 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
13525 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
13526 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
13527 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
13528 debugged program's data segment:
13529
13530 @smallexample
13531 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
13532 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
13533 @end smallexample
13534
13535 @noindent
13536 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
13537 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
13538
13539 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
13540 @item info dos pde
13541 @itemx info dos pte
13542 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
13543 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
13544 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
13545 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
13546 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
13547 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
13548 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
13549 that is currently in use.
13550
13551 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
13552 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
13553 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
13554 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
13555 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
13556 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
13557 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
13558
13559 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
13560 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
13561 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
13562 controller.
13563
13564 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
13565
13566 @cindex physical address from linear address
13567 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
13568 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
13569 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
13570 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
13571 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
13572 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
13573 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
13574
13575 @smallexample
13576 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
13577 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
13578 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
13579 @end smallexample
13580
13581 @noindent
13582 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
13583 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
13584 attributes of that page.
13585
13586 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
13587 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
13588 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
13589 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
13590 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
13591 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
13592
13593 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
13594 transfer buffer:
13595
13596 @smallexample
13597 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
13598 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
13599 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
13600 @end smallexample
13601
13602 @noindent
13603 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
13604 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
13605 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
13606 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
13607 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
13608
13609 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
13610 @end table
13611
13612 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
13613 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
13614 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
13615 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
13616
13617 @table @code
13618 @kindex set com1base
13619 @kindex set com1irq
13620 @kindex set com2base
13621 @kindex set com2irq
13622 @kindex set com3base
13623 @kindex set com3irq
13624 @kindex set com4base
13625 @kindex set com4irq
13626 @item set com1base @var{addr}
13627 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
13628 port.
13629
13630 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
13631 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
13632 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
13633
13634 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
13635 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
13636 other 3 COM ports.
13637
13638 @kindex show com1base
13639 @kindex show com1irq
13640 @kindex show com2base
13641 @kindex show com2irq
13642 @kindex show com3base
13643 @kindex show com3irq
13644 @kindex show com4base
13645 @kindex show com4irq
13646 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
13647 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
13648 lines used by the COM ports.
13649
13650 @item info serial
13651 @kindex info serial
13652 @cindex DOS serial port status
13653 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
13654 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
13655 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
13656 counts of various errors encountered so far.
13657 @end table
13658
13659
13660 @node Cygwin Native
13661 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
13662 @cindex MS Windows debugging
13663 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
13664 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
13665
13666 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
13667 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
13668 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this subsection. The
13669 subsubsection @pxref{Non-debug DLL symbols} describes working with DLLs
13670 that have no debugging symbols.
13671
13672
13673 @table @code
13674 @kindex info w32
13675 @item info w32
13676 This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
13677 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13678
13679 @item info w32 selector
13680 This command displays information returned by
13681 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
13682 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
13683 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
13684 Without argument, this command displays information
13685 about the six segment registers.
13686
13687 @kindex info dll
13688 @item info dll
13689 This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
13690
13691 @kindex dll-symbols
13692 @item dll-symbols
13693 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
13694 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
13695
13696 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
13697 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
13698 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
13699 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
13700 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
13701 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
13702 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
13703 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
13704 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
13705 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
13706 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
13707
13708 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
13709 @item show cygwin-exceptions
13710 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
13711 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
13712
13713 @kindex set new-console
13714 @item set new-console @var{mode}
13715 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
13716 be started in a new console on next start.
13717 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
13718 be started in the same console as the debugger.
13719
13720 @kindex show new-console
13721 @item show new-console
13722 Displays whether a new console is used
13723 when the debuggee is started.
13724
13725 @kindex set new-group
13726 @item set new-group @var{mode}
13727 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
13728 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
13729 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
13730 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
13731
13732 @kindex show new-group
13733 @item show new-group
13734 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
13735
13736 @kindex set debugevents
13737 @item set debugevents
13738 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
13739 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
13740 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
13741 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
13742 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
13743
13744 @kindex set debugexec
13745 @item set debugexec
13746 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
13747 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
13748
13749 @kindex set debugexceptions
13750 @item set debugexceptions
13751 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
13752 debuggee seen by the debugger.
13753
13754 @kindex set debugmemory
13755 @item set debugmemory
13756 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
13757 and writes by the debugger.
13758
13759 @kindex set shell
13760 @item set shell
13761 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
13762 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
13763
13764 @kindex show shell
13765 @item show shell
13766 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
13767
13768 @end table
13769
13770 @menu
13771 * Non-debug DLL symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13772 @end menu
13773
13774 @node Non-debug DLL symbols
13775 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13776 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
13777 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
13778
13779 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
13780 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
13781 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
13782 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
13783 information contained in the DLL's export table. This subsubsection
13784 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
13785 ``minimal symbols''.
13786
13787 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
13788 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
13789 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
13790 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
13791 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
13792 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
13793 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
13794 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
13795 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
13796 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
13797
13798 @subsubsection DLL name prefixes
13799
13800 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
13801 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
13802 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
13803 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
13804 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
13805 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
13806 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
13807 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
13808 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
13809
13810 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
13811 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
13812 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
13813 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
13814 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
13815 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
13816
13817 @smallexample
13818 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
13819 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
13820
13821 Non-debugging symbols:
13822 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
13823 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
13824 @end smallexample
13825
13826 @smallexample
13827 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
13828 All functions matching regular expression "!":
13829
13830 Non-debugging symbols:
13831 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
13832 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
13833 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
13834 [etc...]
13835 @end smallexample
13836
13837 @subsubsection Working with minimal symbols
13838
13839 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
13840 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
13841 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
13842 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
13843 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
13844 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
13845 a function within a DLL without a running program.
13846
13847 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
13848 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
13849 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
13850 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
13851 problem:
13852
13853 @smallexample
13854 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
13855 $1 = 268572168
13856 @end smallexample
13857
13858 @smallexample
13859 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
13860 0x10021610: "\230y\""
13861 @end smallexample
13862
13863 And two possible solutions:
13864
13865 @smallexample
13866 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
13867 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13868 @end smallexample
13869
13870 @smallexample
13871 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
13872 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
13873 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
13874 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
13875 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
13876 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13877 @end smallexample
13878
13879 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
13880 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
13881 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
13882 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
13883 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
13884
13885 @smallexample
13886 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
13887 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
13888 @end smallexample
13889
13890 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
13891 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
13892 safe.
13893
13894 @node Hurd Native
13895 @subsection Commands specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd systems
13896 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
13897
13898 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
13899 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
13900
13901 @table @code
13902 @item set signals
13903 @itemx set sigs
13904 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
13905 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13906 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
13907 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
13908 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
13909 @code{signals}.
13910
13911 @item show signals
13912 @itemx show sigs
13913 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
13914 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13915 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
13916
13917 @item set signal-thread
13918 @itemx set sigthread
13919 @kindex set signal-thread
13920 @kindex set sigthread
13921 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
13922 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
13923 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
13924 signal-thread}.
13925
13926 @item show signal-thread
13927 @itemx show sigthread
13928 @kindex show signal-thread
13929 @kindex show sigthread
13930 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
13931 delivered a signal.
13932
13933 @item set stopped
13934 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13935 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
13936 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
13937 continued by delivering a signal to it.
13938
13939 @item show stopped
13940 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13941 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
13942 stopped.
13943
13944 @item set exceptions
13945 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13946 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
13947 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
13948 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
13949 trapping on.
13950
13951 @item show exceptions
13952 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13953 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
13954
13955 @item set task pause
13956 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
13957 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13958 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13959 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
13960 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
13961 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
13962 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
13963 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
13964 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
13965
13966 @item show task pause
13967 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
13968 Show the current state of task suspension.
13969
13970 @item set task detach-suspend-count
13971 @cindex task suspend count
13972 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13973 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
13974 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
13975
13976 @item show task detach-suspend-count
13977 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
13978
13979 @item set task exception-port
13980 @itemx set task excp
13981 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13982 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
13983 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
13984 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
13985
13986 @item set noninvasive
13987 @cindex noninvasive task options
13988 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
13989 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
13990 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
13991 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
13992
13993 @item info send-rights
13994 @itemx info receive-rights
13995 @itemx info port-rights
13996 @itemx info port-sets
13997 @itemx info dead-names
13998 @itemx info ports
13999 @itemx info psets
14000 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14001 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14002 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14003 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14004 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14005 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
14006 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
14007 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
14008 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
14009
14010 @item set thread pause
14011 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
14012 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14013 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14014 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
14015 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
14016 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
14017 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
14018 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
14019 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
14020 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
14021 only the current thread.
14022
14023 @item show thread pause
14024 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
14025 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
14026
14027 @item set thread run
14028 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14029
14030 @item show thread run
14031 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14032
14033 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
14034 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14035 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14036 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
14037 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
14038 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
14039 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
14040
14041 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
14042 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
14043 detaching.
14044
14045 @item set thread exception-port
14046 @itemx set thread excp
14047 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
14048 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
14049 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
14050
14051 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
14052 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
14053 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
14054 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
14055
14056 @item set thread default
14057 @itemx show thread default
14058 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14059 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
14060 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
14061 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
14062 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
14063 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
14064 the non-default commands.
14065 @end table
14066
14067
14068 @node Neutrino
14069 @subsection QNX Neutrino
14070 @cindex QNX Neutrino
14071
14072 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
14073 Neutrino target:
14074
14075 @table @code
14076 @item set debug nto-debug
14077 @kindex set debug nto-debug
14078 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
14079 Neutrino support.
14080
14081 @item show debug nto-debug
14082 @kindex show debug nto-debug
14083 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
14084 @end table
14085
14086
14087 @node Embedded OS
14088 @section Embedded Operating Systems
14089
14090 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
14091 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
14092 architectures.
14093
14094 @menu
14095 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14096 @end menu
14097
14098 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
14099 various real-time operating systems.
14100
14101 @node VxWorks
14102 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14103
14104 @cindex VxWorks
14105
14106 @table @code
14107
14108 @kindex target vxworks
14109 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
14110 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
14111 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
14112
14113 @end table
14114
14115 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
14116 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
14117
14118 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
14119 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
14120 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14121 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
14122 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
14123 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
14124 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
14125
14126 @table @code
14127 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
14128 @kindex vxworks-timeout
14129 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
14130 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14131 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
14132 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
14133 of a thin network line.
14134 @end table
14135
14136 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
14137 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
14138 procedures.
14139
14140 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
14141 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
14142 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
14143 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
14144 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
14145 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
14146 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
14147 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
14148 manual.
14149 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
14150
14151 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
14152 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14153 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
14154 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
14155
14156 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14157
14158 @smallexample
14159 (vxgdb)
14160 @end smallexample
14161
14162 @menu
14163 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
14164 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
14165 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
14166 @end menu
14167
14168 @node VxWorks Connection
14169 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
14170
14171 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
14172 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
14173
14174 @smallexample
14175 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
14176 @end smallexample
14177
14178 @need 750
14179 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14180
14181 @smallexample
14182 Attaching remote machine across net...
14183 Connected to tt.
14184 @end smallexample
14185
14186 @need 1000
14187 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
14188 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
14189 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
14190 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
14191 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
14192
14193 @smallexample
14194 prog.o: No such file or directory.
14195 @end smallexample
14196
14197 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
14198 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
14199 command again.
14200
14201 @node VxWorks Download
14202 @subsubsection VxWorks download
14203
14204 @cindex download to VxWorks
14205 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
14206 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
14207 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
14208 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
14209 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
14210 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
14211 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
14212 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
14213 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
14214 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
14215 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
14216 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
14217 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
14218 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
14219 program, type this on VxWorks:
14220
14221 @smallexample
14222 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
14223 @end smallexample
14224
14225 @noindent
14226 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14227
14228 @smallexample
14229 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
14230 (vxgdb) load prog.o
14231 @end smallexample
14232
14233 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
14234
14235 @smallexample
14236 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
14237 @end smallexample
14238
14239 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
14240 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
14241 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
14242 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
14243 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
14244 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
14245 table.)
14246
14247 @node VxWorks Attach
14248 @subsubsection Running tasks
14249
14250 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
14251 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
14252 follows:
14253
14254 @smallexample
14255 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
14256 @end smallexample
14257
14258 @noindent
14259 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
14260 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
14261 the time of attachment.
14262
14263 @node Embedded Processors
14264 @section Embedded Processors
14265
14266 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
14267 configurations.
14268
14269 @cindex send command to simulator
14270 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
14271 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
14272
14273 @table @code
14274 @item sim @var{command}
14275 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
14276 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
14277 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
14278 acceptable commands.
14279 @end table
14280
14281
14282 @menu
14283 * ARM:: ARM RDI
14284 * H8/300:: Renesas H8/300
14285 * H8/500:: Renesas H8/500
14286 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
14287 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
14288 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
14289 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
14290 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
14291 * PowerPC:: PowerPC
14292 * SH:: Renesas SH
14293 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
14294 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
14295 * ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
14296 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
14297 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
14298 * CRIS:: CRIS
14299 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
14300 * WinCE:: Windows CE child processes
14301 @end menu
14302
14303 @node ARM
14304 @subsection ARM
14305 @cindex ARM RDI
14306
14307 @table @code
14308 @kindex target rdi
14309 @item target rdi @var{dev}
14310 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
14311 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
14312 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
14313
14314 @kindex target rdp
14315 @item target rdp @var{dev}
14316 ARM Demon monitor.
14317
14318 @end table
14319
14320 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
14321
14322 @table @code
14323 @item set arm disassembler
14324 @kindex set arm
14325 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
14326 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
14327
14328 @item show arm disassembler
14329 @kindex show arm
14330 Show the current disassembly style.
14331
14332 @item set arm apcs32
14333 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
14334 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
14335
14336 @item show arm apcs32
14337 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
14338
14339 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
14340 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
14341 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
14342
14343 @table @code
14344 @item auto
14345 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
14346 @item softfpa
14347 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
14348 processors.
14349 @item fpa
14350 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
14351 @item softvfp
14352 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
14353 @item vfp
14354 VFP co-processor.
14355 @end table
14356
14357 @item show arm fpu
14358 Show the current type of the FPU.
14359
14360 @item set arm abi
14361 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
14362
14363 @item show arm abi
14364 Show the currently used ABI.
14365
14366 @item set debug arm
14367 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
14368 target support subsystem.
14369
14370 @item show debug arm
14371 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
14372 @end table
14373
14374 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
14375 using the RDI interface:
14376
14377 @table @code
14378 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14379 @kindex rdilogfile
14380 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
14381 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
14382 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
14383 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
14384 @file{rdi.log}.
14385
14386 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
14387 @kindex rdilogenable
14388 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
14389 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
14390 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
14391 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
14392 are logged to a file.
14393
14394 @item set rdiromatzero
14395 @kindex set rdiromatzero
14396 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
14397 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
14398 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
14399 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
14400 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
14401
14402 @item show rdiromatzero
14403 @kindex show rdiromatzero
14404 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
14405
14406 @item set rdiheartbeat
14407 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
14408 @cindex RDI heartbeat
14409 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
14410 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
14411 well as the Angel monitor.
14412
14413 @item show rdiheartbeat
14414 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
14415 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
14416 @end table
14417
14418
14419 @node H8/300
14420 @subsection Renesas H8/300
14421
14422 @table @code
14423
14424 @kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
14425 @item target hms @var{dev}
14426 A Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
14427 Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
14428 line and the communications speed used.
14429
14430 @kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
14431 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
14432 E7000 emulator for Renesas H8 and SH.
14433
14434 @kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
14435 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
14436 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
14437 @itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
14438 Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
14439
14440 @end table
14441
14442 @cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
14443 @cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
14444 @cindex download to Renesas SH
14445 @cindex Renesas SH download
14446 When you select remote debugging to a Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500
14447 board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Renesas
14448 board and also opens it as the current executable target for
14449 @value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
14450
14451 @value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
14452 Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
14453
14454 @enumerate
14455 @item
14456 that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
14457 for Renesas microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
14458 emulator for the Renesas SH and the Renesas 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
14459 the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Renesas SH,
14460 H8/300, or H8/500.)
14461
14462 @item
14463 what serial device connects your host to your Renesas board (the first
14464 serial device available on your host is the default).
14465
14466 @item
14467 what speed to use over the serial device.
14468 @end enumerate
14469
14470 @menu
14471 * Renesas Boards:: Connecting to Renesas boards.
14472 * Renesas ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
14473 * Renesas Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros.
14474 @end menu
14475
14476 @node Renesas Boards
14477 @subsubsection Connecting to Renesas boards
14478
14479 @c only for Unix hosts
14480 @kindex device
14481 @cindex serial device, Renesas micros
14482 Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
14483 need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
14484 first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
14485 hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
14486
14487 @kindex speed
14488 @cindex serial line speed, Renesas micros
14489 @code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
14490 speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
14491 hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
14492 the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
14493 @w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
14494
14495 The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
14496 use a Unix host to debug your Renesas microprocessor programs. If you
14497 use a DOS host,
14498 @value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
14499 called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
14500 through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
14501 to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
14502
14503 The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
14504 program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
14505 sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
14506 the Renesas SH and the H8/500.
14507
14508 First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
14509 board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
14510 port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
14511 When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
14512 debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
14513 for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
14514 @code{COM2}.
14515
14516 @smallexample
14517 C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
14518 C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
14519
14520 Resident portion of MODE loaded
14521
14522 COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
14523
14524 @end smallexample
14525
14526 @quotation
14527 @emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
14528 @code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
14529 disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
14530 your development board.
14531 @end quotation
14532
14533 @kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
14534 Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
14535 connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBN}} with
14536 the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
14537 you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
14538 commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
14539 cross-debugging to the Renesas board, and the @code{load} command to
14540 download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
14541 the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
14542 (If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
14543 executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
14544 @code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
14545 itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
14546
14547 @smallexample
14548 (eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
14549 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
14550 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
14551 the conditions.
14552 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
14553 for details.
14554 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
14555 (@value{GDBP}) target hms
14556 Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
14557 (@value{GDBP}) load t.x
14558 .text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
14559 .data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
14560 .stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
14561 @end smallexample
14562
14563 At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
14564 you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
14565 sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
14566 @code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
14567 resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
14568 @code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
14569
14570 Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
14571 available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
14572 you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
14573
14574 Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
14575 @itemize @bullet
14576 @item
14577 to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{Ctrl-c} on the DOS host---it has
14578 no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
14579
14580 @item
14581 to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
14582 normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
14583 to detect program completion.
14584 @end itemize
14585
14586 In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
14587 development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
14588
14589 @node Renesas ICE
14590 @subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
14591
14592 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas ICE}
14593 You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
14594 Renesas SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
14595 e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
14596
14597 @table @code
14598 @item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
14599 Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
14600 @var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
14601 @samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
14602 (for example, @samp{9600}).
14603
14604 @item target e7000 @var{hostname}
14605 If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
14606 specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
14607 @end table
14608
14609 The following special commands are available when debugging with the
14610 Renesas E7000 ICE:
14611
14612 @table @code
14613 @item e7000 @var{command}
14614 @kindex e7000
14615 @cindex send command to E7000 monitor
14616 This sends the specified @var{command} to the E7000 monitor.
14617
14618 @item ftplogin @var{machine} @var{username} @var{password} @var{dir}
14619 @kindex ftplogin@r{, E7000}
14620 This command records information for subsequent interface with the
14621 E7000 monitor via the FTP protocol: @value{GDBN} will log into the
14622 named @var{machine} using specified @var{username} and @var{password},
14623 and then chdir to the named directory @var{dir}.
14624
14625 @item ftpload @var{file}
14626 @kindex ftpload@r{, E7000}
14627 This command uses credentials recorded by @code{ftplogin} to fetch and
14628 load the named @var{file} from the E7000 monitor.
14629
14630 @item drain
14631 @kindex drain@r{, E7000}
14632 This command drains any pending text buffers stored on the E7000.
14633
14634 @item set usehardbreakpoints
14635 @itemx show usehardbreakpoints
14636 @kindex set usehardbreakpoints@r{, E7000}
14637 @kindex show usehardbreakpoints@r{, E7000}
14638 @cindex hardware breakpoints, and E7000
14639 These commands set and show the use of hardware breakpoints for all
14640 breakpoints. @xref{Set Breaks, hardware-assisted breakpoint}, for
14641 more information about using hardware breakpoints selectively.
14642 @end table
14643
14644 @node Renesas Special
14645 @subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros
14646
14647 Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
14648
14649 @table @code
14650
14651 @kindex set machine
14652 @kindex show machine
14653 @item set machine h8300
14654 @itemx set machine h8300h
14655 Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
14656 architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
14657 to check which variant is currently in effect.
14658
14659 @end table
14660
14661 @node H8/500
14662 @subsection H8/500
14663
14664 @table @code
14665
14666 @kindex set memory @var{mod}
14667 @cindex memory models, H8/500
14668 @item set memory @var{mod}
14669 @itemx show memory
14670 Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
14671 @samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
14672 memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
14673 @code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
14674
14675 @end table
14676
14677 @node M32R/D
14678 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
14679
14680 @table @code
14681 @kindex target m32r
14682 @item target m32r @var{dev}
14683 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
14684
14685 @kindex target m32rsdi
14686 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
14687 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
14688 @end table
14689
14690 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
14691
14692 @table @code
14693 @item set download-path @var{path}
14694 @kindex set download-path
14695 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
14696 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14697
14698 @item show download-path
14699 @kindex show download-path
14700 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14701
14702 @item set board-address @var{addr}
14703 @kindex set board-address
14704 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
14705 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
14706
14707 @item show board-address
14708 @kindex show board-address
14709 Show the current IP address of the target board.
14710
14711 @item set server-address @var{addr}
14712 @kindex set server-address
14713 @cindex download server address (M32R)
14714 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
14715 host machine.
14716
14717 @item show server-address
14718 @kindex show server-address
14719 Display the IP address of the download server.
14720
14721 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14722 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
14723 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
14724 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
14725 executable file is uploaded.
14726
14727 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14728 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
14729 Test the @code{upload} command.
14730 @end table
14731
14732 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
14733
14734 @table @code
14735 @item sdireset
14736 @kindex sdireset
14737 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
14738 This command resets the SDI connection.
14739
14740 @item sdistatus
14741 @kindex sdistatus
14742 This command shows the SDI connection status.
14743
14744 @item debug_chaos
14745 @kindex debug_chaos
14746 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
14747 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
14748
14749 @item use_debug_dma
14750 @kindex use_debug_dma
14751 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
14752
14753 @item use_mon_code
14754 @kindex use_mon_code
14755 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
14756
14757 @item use_ib_break
14758 @kindex use_ib_break
14759 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
14760
14761 @item use_dbt_break
14762 @kindex use_dbt_break
14763 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
14764 @end table
14765
14766 @node M68K
14767 @subsection M68k
14768
14769 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
14770 target command for the following ROM monitors.
14771
14772 @table @code
14773
14774 @kindex target abug
14775 @item target abug @var{dev}
14776 ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
14777
14778 @kindex target cpu32bug
14779 @item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
14780 CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
14781
14782 @kindex target dbug
14783 @item target dbug @var{dev}
14784 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
14785
14786 @kindex target est
14787 @item target est @var{dev}
14788 EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
14789
14790 @kindex target rom68k
14791 @item target rom68k @var{dev}
14792 ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
14793
14794 @end table
14795
14796 @table @code
14797
14798 @kindex target rombug
14799 @item target rombug @var{dev}
14800 ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
14801
14802 @end table
14803
14804 @node MIPS Embedded
14805 @subsection MIPS Embedded
14806
14807 @cindex MIPS boards
14808 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
14809 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
14810 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
14811
14812 @need 1000
14813 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
14814
14815 @table @code
14816 @item target mips @var{port}
14817 @kindex target mips @var{port}
14818 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
14819 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
14820 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
14821 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
14822 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
14823 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
14824
14825 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
14826 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
14827 debugger:
14828
14829 @smallexample
14830 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
14831 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
14832 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
14833 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
14834 (@value{GDBP}) run
14835 @end smallexample
14836
14837 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
14838 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
14839 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
14840 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
14841 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
14842
14843 @item target pmon @var{port}
14844 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
14845 PMON ROM monitor.
14846
14847 @item target ddb @var{port}
14848 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
14849 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
14850
14851 @item target lsi @var{port}
14852 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
14853 LSI variant of PMON.
14854
14855 @kindex target r3900
14856 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
14857 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
14858
14859 @kindex target array
14860 @item target array @var{dev}
14861 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
14862
14863 @end table
14864
14865
14866 @noindent
14867 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
14868
14869 @table @code
14870 @item set mipsfpu double
14871 @itemx set mipsfpu single
14872 @itemx set mipsfpu none
14873 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
14874 @itemx show mipsfpu
14875 @kindex set mipsfpu
14876 @kindex show mipsfpu
14877 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
14878 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
14879 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
14880 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
14881 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
14882 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
14883 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
14884 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
14885 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
14886 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
14887 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
14888 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
14889 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
14890
14891 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
14892 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
14893 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
14894
14895 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
14896 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
14897
14898 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
14899 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
14900 @itemx show timeout
14901 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
14902 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
14903 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
14904 @kindex set timeout
14905 @kindex show timeout
14906 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
14907 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
14908 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
14909 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
14910 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
14911 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
14912 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
14913 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
14914 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
14915 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
14916
14917 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
14918 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
14919 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
14920 to run before stopping.
14921
14922 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
14923 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14924 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
14925 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
14926 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
14927 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
14928
14929 @item show syn-garbage-limit
14930 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14931 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
14932 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
14933
14934 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
14935 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14936 @cindex remote monitor prompt
14937 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
14938 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
14939 @table @asis
14940 @item pmon target
14941 @samp{PMON}
14942 @item ddb target
14943 @samp{NEC010}
14944 @item lsi target
14945 @samp{PMON>}
14946 @end table
14947
14948 @item show monitor-prompt
14949 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14950 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
14951 remote monitor.
14952
14953 @item set monitor-warnings
14954 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14955 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
14956 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
14957 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
14958 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
14959
14960 @item show monitor-warnings
14961 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14962 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
14963
14964 @item pmon @var{command}
14965 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
14966 @cindex send PMON command
14967 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
14968 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
14969 @end table
14970
14971 @node OpenRISC 1000
14972 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
14973 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
14974
14975 @cindex or1k boards
14976 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
14977 about platform and commands.
14978
14979 @table @code
14980
14981 @kindex target jtag
14982 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
14983
14984 Connects to remote JTAG server.
14985 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
14986 connected via parallel port to the board.
14987
14988 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
14989
14990 @kindex or1ksim
14991 @item or1ksim @var{command}
14992 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
14993 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
14994
14995 @kindex info or1k spr
14996 @item info or1k spr
14997 Displays spr groups.
14998
14999 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
15000 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
15001 Displays register names in selected group.
15002
15003 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
15004 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
15005 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
15006 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
15007 Shows information about specified spr register.
15008
15009 @kindex spr
15010 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
15011 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
15012 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
15013 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
15014 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
15015 @end table
15016
15017 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
15018 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
15019 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
15020 triggers can be set using:
15021 @table @code
15022 @item $LEA/$LDATA
15023 Load effective address/data
15024 @item $SEA/$SDATA
15025 Store effective address/data
15026 @item $AEA/$ADATA
15027 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
15028 @item $FETCH
15029 Fetch data
15030 @end table
15031
15032 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
15033 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
15034
15035 @code{htrace} commands:
15036 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
15037 @table @code
15038 @kindex hwatch
15039 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
15040 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
15041 or Data. For example:
15042
15043 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15044
15045 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15046
15047 @kindex htrace
15048 @item htrace info
15049 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
15050
15051 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
15052 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
15053
15054 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
15055 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
15056
15057 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
15058 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
15059
15060 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
15061 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
15062 triggered.
15063
15064 @item htrace enable
15065 @itemx htrace disable
15066 Enables/disables the HW trace.
15067
15068 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
15069 Clears currently recorded trace data.
15070
15071 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
15072 will be written there.
15073
15074 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
15075 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
15076
15077 @item htrace mode continuous
15078 Set continuous trace mode.
15079
15080 @item htrace mode suspend
15081 Set suspend trace mode.
15082
15083 @end table
15084
15085 @node PowerPC
15086 @subsection PowerPC
15087
15088 @table @code
15089 @kindex target dink32
15090 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
15091 DINK32 ROM monitor.
15092
15093 @kindex target ppcbug
15094 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
15095 @kindex target ppcbug1
15096 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
15097 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
15098
15099 @kindex target sds
15100 @item target sds @var{dev}
15101 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
15102 @end table
15103
15104 @cindex SDS protocol
15105 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
15106 by@value{GDBN}:
15107
15108 @table @code
15109 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
15110 @kindex set sdstimeout
15111 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
15112 default is 2 seconds.
15113
15114 @item show sdstimeout
15115 @kindex show sdstimeout
15116 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
15117
15118 @item sds @var{command}
15119 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
15120 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
15121 @end table
15122
15123
15124 @node PA
15125 @subsection HP PA Embedded
15126
15127 @table @code
15128
15129 @kindex target op50n
15130 @item target op50n @var{dev}
15131 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
15132
15133 @kindex target w89k
15134 @item target w89k @var{dev}
15135 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
15136
15137 @end table
15138
15139 @node SH
15140 @subsection Renesas SH
15141
15142 @table @code
15143
15144 @kindex target hms@r{, with Renesas SH}
15145 @item target hms @var{dev}
15146 A Renesas SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
15147 commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
15148 the communications speed used.
15149
15150 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas SH}
15151 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
15152 E7000 emulator for Renesas SH.
15153
15154 @kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
15155 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
15156 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
15157 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
15158 Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
15159
15160 @end table
15161
15162 @node Sparclet
15163 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
15164
15165 @cindex Sparclet
15166
15167 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
15168 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
15169 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15170 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
15171 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
15172
15173 @table @code
15174 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
15175 @kindex remotetimeout
15176 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
15177 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15178 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
15179 @end table
15180
15181 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
15182 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
15183 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
15184 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
15185 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
15186
15187 @smallexample
15188 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
15189 @end smallexample
15190
15191 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
15192
15193 @smallexample
15194 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
15195 @end smallexample
15196
15197 @cindex running, on Sparclet
15198 Once you have set
15199 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15200 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
15201 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
15202
15203 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15204
15205 @smallexample
15206 (gdbslet)
15207 @end smallexample
15208
15209 @menu
15210 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
15211 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
15212 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
15213 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
15214 @end menu
15215
15216 @node Sparclet File
15217 @subsubsection Setting file to debug
15218
15219 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
15220
15221 @smallexample
15222 (gdbslet) file prog
15223 @end smallexample
15224
15225 @need 1000
15226 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
15227 @value{GDBN} locates
15228 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
15229 path.
15230 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
15231 files will be searched as well.
15232 @value{GDBN} locates
15233 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
15234 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
15235 If it fails
15236 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
15237
15238 @smallexample
15239 prog: No such file or directory.
15240 @end smallexample
15241
15242 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
15243 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
15244 @code{target} command again.
15245
15246 @node Sparclet Connection
15247 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
15248
15249 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
15250 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
15251
15252 @smallexample
15253 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
15254 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
15255 main () at ../prog.c:3
15256 @end smallexample
15257
15258 @need 750
15259 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15260
15261 @smallexample
15262 Connected to ttya.
15263 @end smallexample
15264
15265 @node Sparclet Download
15266 @subsubsection Sparclet download
15267
15268 @cindex download to Sparclet
15269 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
15270 you can use the @value{GDBN}
15271 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
15272 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
15273 command.
15274 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
15275 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
15276 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
15277 of each of the file's sections.
15278 For instance, if the program
15279 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
15280 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15281
15282 @smallexample
15283 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
15284 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
15285 @end smallexample
15286
15287 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
15288 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
15289 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
15290
15291 @node Sparclet Execution
15292 @subsubsection Running and debugging
15293
15294 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
15295 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
15296 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
15297 manual for the list of commands.
15298
15299 @smallexample
15300 (gdbslet) b main
15301 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
15302 (gdbslet) run
15303 Starting program: prog
15304 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
15305 3 char *symarg = 0;
15306 (gdbslet) step
15307 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
15308 (gdbslet)
15309 @end smallexample
15310
15311 @node Sparclite
15312 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
15313
15314 @table @code
15315
15316 @kindex target sparclite
15317 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
15318 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
15319 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
15320 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
15321 remote protocol.
15322
15323 @end table
15324
15325 @node ST2000
15326 @subsection Tandem ST2000
15327
15328 @value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
15329 STDBUG protocol.
15330
15331 To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
15332 manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
15333
15334 @smallexample
15335 target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
15336 @end smallexample
15337
15338 @noindent
15339 to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
15340 the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
15341 ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
15342 connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
15343 concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
15344
15345 The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
15346 this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
15347 would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
15348 (such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
15349 available on your host computer.
15350 @c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
15351 @c basically hearsay.
15352
15353 @cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
15354 These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
15355 environment:
15356
15357 @table @code
15358 @item st2000 @var{command}
15359 @kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
15360 @cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
15361 @cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
15362 Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
15363 manual for available commands.
15364
15365 @item connect
15366 @cindex connect (to STDBUG)
15367 Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
15368 you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
15369 sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
15370 @kbd{@key{RET} ~ .} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
15371 @kbd{@key{RET} ~ Ctrl-d} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
15372 @end table
15373
15374 @node Z8000
15375 @subsection Zilog Z8000
15376
15377 @cindex Z8000
15378 @cindex simulator, Z8000
15379 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
15380
15381 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
15382 a Z8000 simulator.
15383
15384 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
15385 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
15386 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
15387 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
15388
15389 @table @code
15390 @item target sim @var{args}
15391 @kindex sim
15392 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
15393 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
15394 options, specify them via @var{args}.
15395 @end table
15396
15397 @noindent
15398 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
15399 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
15400 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
15401 to run your program, and so on.
15402
15403 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
15404 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
15405 additional items of information as specially named registers:
15406
15407 @table @code
15408
15409 @item cycles
15410 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
15411
15412 @item insts
15413 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
15414
15415 @item time
15416 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
15417
15418 @end table
15419
15420 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
15421 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
15422 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
15423 simulated clock ticks.
15424
15425 @node AVR
15426 @subsection Atmel AVR
15427 @cindex AVR
15428
15429 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
15430 following AVR-specific commands:
15431
15432 @table @code
15433 @item info io_registers
15434 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
15435 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
15436 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
15437 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
15438 @end table
15439
15440 @node CRIS
15441 @subsection CRIS
15442 @cindex CRIS
15443
15444 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
15445 following CRIS-specific commands:
15446
15447 @table @code
15448 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
15449 @cindex CRIS version
15450 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
15451 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
15452 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
15453
15454 @item show cris-version
15455 Show the current CRIS version.
15456
15457 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
15458 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
15459 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
15460 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
15461 @code{R59}.
15462
15463 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
15464 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
15465
15466 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
15467 @cindex CRIS mode
15468 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
15469 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
15470 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
15471
15472 @item show cris-mode
15473 Show the current CRIS mode.
15474 @end table
15475
15476 @node Super-H
15477 @subsection Renesas Super-H
15478 @cindex Super-H
15479
15480 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
15481 commands:
15482
15483 @table @code
15484 @item regs
15485 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
15486 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
15487 @end table
15488
15489 @node WinCE
15490 @subsection Windows CE
15491 @cindex Windows CE
15492
15493 The following commands are available for Windows CE:
15494
15495 @table @code
15496 @item set remotedirectory @var{dir}
15497 @kindex set remotedirectory
15498 Tell @value{GDBN} to upload files from the named directory @var{dir}.
15499 The default is @file{/gdb}, i.e.@: the root directory on the current
15500 drive.
15501
15502 @item show remotedirectory
15503 @kindex show remotedirectory
15504 Show the current value of the upload directory.
15505
15506 @item set remoteupload @var{method}
15507 @kindex set remoteupload
15508 Set the method used to upload files to remote device. Valid values
15509 for @var{method} are @samp{always}, @samp{newer}, and @samp{never}.
15510 The default is @samp{newer}.
15511
15512 @item show remoteupload
15513 @kindex show remoteupload
15514 Show the current setting of the upload method.
15515
15516 @item set remoteaddhost
15517 @kindex set remoteaddhost
15518 Tell @value{GDBN} whether to add this host to the remote stub's
15519 arguments when you debug over a network.
15520
15521 @item show remoteaddhost
15522 @kindex show remoteaddhost
15523 Show whether to add this host to remote stub's arguments when
15524 debugging over a network.
15525 @end table
15526
15527
15528 @node Architectures
15529 @section Architectures
15530
15531 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
15532 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
15533
15534 @menu
15535 * i386::
15536 * A29K::
15537 * Alpha::
15538 * MIPS::
15539 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
15540 @end menu
15541
15542 @node i386
15543 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific issues.
15544
15545 @table @code
15546 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
15547 @kindex set struct-convention
15548 @cindex struct return convention
15549 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
15550 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
15551 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
15552 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
15553 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
15554 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
15555 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
15556 be returned in a register.
15557
15558 @item show struct-convention
15559 @kindex show struct-convention
15560 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
15561 from functions.
15562 @end table
15563
15564 @node A29K
15565 @subsection A29K
15566
15567 @table @code
15568
15569 @kindex set rstack_high_address
15570 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
15571 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
15572 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
15573 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
15574 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
15575 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
15576 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
15577 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
15578 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
15579 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
15580 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
15581 hexadecimal.
15582
15583 @kindex show rstack_high_address
15584 @item show rstack_high_address
15585 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
15586 processors.
15587
15588 @end table
15589
15590 @node Alpha
15591 @subsection Alpha
15592
15593 See the following section.
15594
15595 @node MIPS
15596 @subsection MIPS
15597
15598 @cindex stack on Alpha
15599 @cindex stack on MIPS
15600 @cindex Alpha stack
15601 @cindex MIPS stack
15602 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
15603 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
15604 find the beginning of a function.
15605
15606 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
15607 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
15608 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
15609 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
15610 commands:
15611
15612 @table @code
15613 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
15614 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
15615 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
15616 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
15617 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
15618 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
15619 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
15620 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
15621
15622 @item show heuristic-fence-post
15623 Display the current limit.
15624 @end table
15625
15626 @noindent
15627 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
15628 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
15629
15630 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
15631 programs:
15632
15633 @table @code
15634 @item set mips saved-gpreg-size @var{size}
15635 @kindex set mips saved-gpreg-size
15636 @cindex MIPS GP register size on stack
15637 Set the size of MIPS general-purpose registers saved on the stack.
15638 The argument @var{size} can be one of the following:
15639
15640 @table @samp
15641 @item 32
15642 32-bit GP registers
15643 @item 64
15644 64-bit GP registers
15645 @item auto
15646 Use the target's default setting or autodetect the saved size from the
15647 information contained in the executable. This is the default
15648 @end table
15649
15650 @item show mips saved-gpreg-size
15651 @kindex show mips saved-gpreg-size
15652 Show the current size of MIPS GP registers on the stack.
15653
15654 @item set mips stack-arg-size @var{size}
15655 @kindex set mips stack-arg-size
15656 @cindex MIPS stack space for arguments
15657 Set the amount of stack space reserved for arguments to functions.
15658 The argument can be one of @code{"32"}, @code{"64"} or @code{"auto"}
15659 (the default).
15660
15661 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
15662 @kindex set mips abi
15663 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
15664 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
15665 values of @var{arg} are:
15666
15667 @table @samp
15668 @item auto
15669 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
15670 default).
15671 @item o32
15672 @item o64
15673 @item n32
15674 @item n64
15675 @item eabi32
15676 @item eabi64
15677 @item auto
15678 @end table
15679
15680 @item show mips abi
15681 @kindex show mips abi
15682 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
15683
15684 @item set mipsfpu
15685 @itemx show mipsfpu
15686 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
15687
15688 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
15689 @kindex set mips mask-address
15690 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
15691 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
15692 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
15693 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15694 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15695
15696 @item show mips mask-address
15697 @kindex show mips mask-address
15698 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
15699 not.
15700
15701 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15702 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15703 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
15704 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
15705 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
15706 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
15707
15708 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15709 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15710 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
15711
15712 @item set debug mips
15713 @kindex set debug mips
15714 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
15715 target code in @value{GDBN}.
15716
15717 @item show debug mips
15718 @kindex show debug mips
15719 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
15720 @end table
15721
15722
15723 @node HPPA
15724 @subsection HPPA
15725 @cindex HPPA support
15726
15727 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
15728 following special commands:
15729
15730 @table @code
15731 @item set debug hppa
15732 @kindex set debug hppa
15733 This command determines whether HPPA architecture specific debugging
15734 messages are to be displayed.
15735
15736 @item show debug hppa
15737 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
15738
15739 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
15740 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
15741 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
15742 given @var{address}.
15743
15744 @end table
15745
15746
15747 @node Controlling GDB
15748 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
15749
15750 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
15751 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
15752 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
15753 described here.
15754
15755 @menu
15756 * Prompt:: Prompt
15757 * Editing:: Command editing
15758 * Command History:: Command history
15759 * Screen Size:: Screen size
15760 * Numbers:: Numbers
15761 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
15762 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
15763 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
15764 @end menu
15765
15766 @node Prompt
15767 @section Prompt
15768
15769 @cindex prompt
15770
15771 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
15772 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
15773 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
15774 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
15775 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
15776 which one you are talking to.
15777
15778 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
15779 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
15780 or a prompt that does not.
15781
15782 @table @code
15783 @kindex set prompt
15784 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
15785 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
15786
15787 @kindex show prompt
15788 @item show prompt
15789 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
15790 @end table
15791
15792 @node Editing
15793 @section Command editing
15794 @cindex readline
15795 @cindex command line editing
15796
15797 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
15798 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
15799 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
15800 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
15801 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
15802 debugging sessions.
15803
15804 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
15805 command @code{set}.
15806
15807 @table @code
15808 @kindex set editing
15809 @cindex editing
15810 @item set editing
15811 @itemx set editing on
15812 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
15813
15814 @item set editing off
15815 Disable command line editing.
15816
15817 @kindex show editing
15818 @item show editing
15819 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
15820 @end table
15821
15822 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
15823 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
15824 encouraged to read that chapter.
15825
15826 @node Command History
15827 @section Command history
15828 @cindex command history
15829
15830 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
15831 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
15832 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
15833 history facility.
15834
15835 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
15836 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
15837 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
15838
15839 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
15840 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }. This
15841 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
15842 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
15843 pressed on a line by itself.
15844
15845 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
15846 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
15847 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
15848 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
15849
15850 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
15851 history.
15852
15853 @table @code
15854 @cindex history substitution
15855 @cindex history file
15856 @kindex set history filename
15857 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
15858 @item set history filename @var{fname}
15859 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
15860 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
15861 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
15862 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
15863 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
15864 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
15865 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
15866 is not set.
15867
15868 @cindex save command history
15869 @kindex set history save
15870 @item set history save
15871 @itemx set history save on
15872 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
15873 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
15874
15875 @item set history save off
15876 Stop recording command history in a file.
15877
15878 @cindex history size
15879 @kindex set history size
15880 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
15881 @item set history size @var{size}
15882 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
15883 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
15884 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
15885 @end table
15886
15887 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
15888 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
15889
15890 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
15891 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
15892 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
15893 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
15894 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
15895 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
15896 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
15897 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
15898
15899 The commands to control history expansion are:
15900
15901 @table @code
15902 @item set history expansion on
15903 @itemx set history expansion
15904 @kindex set history expansion
15905 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
15906
15907 @item set history expansion off
15908 Disable history expansion.
15909
15910 @c @group
15911 @kindex show history
15912 @item show history
15913 @itemx show history filename
15914 @itemx show history save
15915 @itemx show history size
15916 @itemx show history expansion
15917 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
15918 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
15919 @c @end group
15920 @end table
15921
15922 @table @code
15923 @kindex show commands
15924 @cindex show last commands
15925 @cindex display command history
15926 @item show commands
15927 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
15928
15929 @item show commands @var{n}
15930 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
15931
15932 @item show commands +
15933 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
15934 @end table
15935
15936 @node Screen Size
15937 @section Screen size
15938 @cindex size of screen
15939 @cindex pauses in output
15940
15941 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
15942 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
15943 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
15944 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
15945 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
15946 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
15947 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
15948 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
15949
15950 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
15951 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
15952 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
15953 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
15954 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
15955 width} commands:
15956
15957 @table @code
15958 @kindex set height
15959 @kindex set width
15960 @kindex show width
15961 @kindex show height
15962 @item set height @var{lpp}
15963 @itemx show height
15964 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
15965 @itemx show width
15966 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
15967 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
15968 commands display the current settings.
15969
15970 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
15971 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
15972 file or to an editor buffer.
15973
15974 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
15975 from wrapping its output.
15976
15977 @item set pagination on
15978 @itemx set pagination off
15979 @kindex set pagination
15980 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
15981 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
15982
15983 @item show pagination
15984 @kindex show pagination
15985 Show the current pagination mode.
15986 @end table
15987
15988 @node Numbers
15989 @section Numbers
15990 @cindex number representation
15991 @cindex entering numbers
15992
15993 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
15994 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
15995 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
15996 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
15997 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
15998 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
15999 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
16000 both input and output with the commands described below.
16001
16002 @table @code
16003 @kindex set input-radix
16004 @item set input-radix @var{base}
16005 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
16006 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
16007 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
16008 example, any of
16009
16010 @smallexample
16011 set input-radix 012
16012 set input-radix 10.
16013 set input-radix 0xa
16014 @end smallexample
16015
16016 @noindent
16017 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
16018 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
16019 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
16020 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
16021 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
16022 change the radix.
16023
16024 @kindex set output-radix
16025 @item set output-radix @var{base}
16026 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
16027 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
16028 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
16029
16030 @kindex show input-radix
16031 @item show input-radix
16032 Display the current default base for numeric input.
16033
16034 @kindex show output-radix
16035 @item show output-radix
16036 Display the current default base for numeric display.
16037
16038 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
16039 @itemx show radix
16040 @kindex set radix
16041 @kindex show radix
16042 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
16043 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
16044 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
16045 default value of 10.
16046
16047 @end table
16048
16049 @node ABI
16050 @section Configuring the current ABI
16051
16052 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
16053 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
16054 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
16055 current ABI.
16056
16057 @cindex OS ABI
16058 @kindex set osabi
16059 @kindex show osabi
16060
16061 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
16062 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
16063 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
16064 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
16065 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
16066 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
16067 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
16068 platform provides.
16069
16070 @table @code
16071 @item show osabi
16072 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
16073
16074 @item set osabi
16075 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
16076
16077 @item set osabi @var{abi}
16078 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
16079 @end table
16080
16081 @cindex float promotion
16082
16083 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
16084 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
16085 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
16086 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
16087 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
16088 @code{double} and then passed.
16089
16090 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
16091 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
16092 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
16093
16094 @table @code
16095 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
16096 @item set coerce-float-to-double
16097 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
16098 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
16099 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
16100
16101 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
16102 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
16103 functions.
16104
16105 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
16106 @item show coerce-float-to-double
16107 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
16108 @end table
16109
16110 @kindex set cp-abi
16111 @kindex show cp-abi
16112 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
16113 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
16114 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
16115 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
16116 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
16117 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
16118 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
16119 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
16120 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
16121 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
16122 ``auto''.
16123
16124 @table @code
16125 @item show cp-abi
16126 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
16127
16128 @item set cp-abi
16129 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
16130
16131 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
16132 @itemx set cp-abi auto
16133 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
16134 @end table
16135
16136 @node Messages/Warnings
16137 @section Optional warnings and messages
16138
16139 @cindex verbose operation
16140 @cindex optional warnings
16141 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
16142 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
16143 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
16144 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
16145
16146 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
16147 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
16148 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
16149
16150 @table @code
16151 @kindex set verbose
16152 @item set verbose on
16153 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16154
16155 @item set verbose off
16156 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16157
16158 @kindex show verbose
16159 @item show verbose
16160 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
16161 @end table
16162
16163 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
16164 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
16165 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
16166 symbol files}).
16167
16168 @table @code
16169
16170 @kindex set complaints
16171 @item set complaints @var{limit}
16172 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
16173 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
16174 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
16175 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
16176
16177 @kindex show complaints
16178 @item show complaints
16179 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
16180
16181 @end table
16182
16183 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
16184 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
16185 you try to run a program which is already running:
16186
16187 @smallexample
16188 (@value{GDBP}) run
16189 The program being debugged has been started already.
16190 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
16191 @end smallexample
16192
16193 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
16194 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
16195
16196 @table @code
16197
16198 @kindex set confirm
16199 @cindex flinching
16200 @cindex confirmation
16201 @cindex stupid questions
16202 @item set confirm off
16203 Disables confirmation requests.
16204
16205 @item set confirm on
16206 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
16207
16208 @kindex show confirm
16209 @item show confirm
16210 Displays state of confirmation requests.
16211
16212 @end table
16213
16214 @cindex command tracing
16215 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
16216 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
16217 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
16218 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
16219
16220 @table @code
16221 @kindex set trace-commands
16222 @cindex command scripts, debugging
16223 @item set trace-commands on
16224 Enable command tracing.
16225 @item set trace-commands off
16226 Disable command tracing.
16227 @item show trace-commands
16228 Display the current state of command tracing.
16229 @end table
16230
16231 @node Debugging Output
16232 @section Optional messages about internal happenings
16233 @cindex optional debugging messages
16234
16235 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
16236 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
16237 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
16238 section documents those commands.
16239
16240 @table @code
16241 @kindex set exec-done-display
16242 @item set exec-done-display
16243 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
16244 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
16245 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
16246 @kindex show exec-done-display
16247 @item show exec-done-display
16248 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
16249 notification.
16250 @kindex set debug
16251 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
16252 @cindex architecture debugging info
16253 @item set debug arch
16254 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
16255 @kindex show debug
16256 @item show debug arch
16257 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
16258 @item set debug aix-thread
16259 @cindex AIX threads
16260 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
16261 module.
16262 @item show debug aix-thread
16263 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
16264 @item set debug event
16265 @cindex event debugging info
16266 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
16267 default is off.
16268 @item show debug event
16269 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
16270 info.
16271 @item set debug expression
16272 @cindex expression debugging info
16273 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
16274 expression parsing. The default is off.
16275 @item show debug expression
16276 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
16277 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
16278 @item set debug frame
16279 @cindex frame debugging info
16280 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
16281 default is off.
16282 @item show debug frame
16283 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
16284 info.
16285 @item set debug infrun
16286 @cindex inferior debugging info
16287 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
16288 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
16289 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
16290 @item show debug infrun
16291 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
16292 @item set debug lin-lwp
16293 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
16294 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
16295 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
16296 @item show debug lin-lwp
16297 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
16298 @item set debug observer
16299 @cindex observer debugging info
16300 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
16301 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
16302 @item show debug observer
16303 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
16304 @item set debug overload
16305 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
16306 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
16307 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
16308 is off.
16309 @item show debug overload
16310 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
16311 debugging info.
16312 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
16313 @cindex serial connections, debugging
16314 @cindex debug remote protocol
16315 @cindex remote protocol debugging
16316 @cindex display remote packets
16317 @item set debug remote
16318 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
16319 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
16320 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
16321 @item show debug remote
16322 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
16323 @item set debug serial
16324 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
16325 default is off.
16326 @item show debug serial
16327 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
16328 info.
16329 @item set debug solib-frv
16330 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
16331 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
16332 @item show debug solib-frv
16333 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
16334 messages.
16335 @item set debug target
16336 @cindex target debugging info
16337 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
16338 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
16339 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
16340 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
16341 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
16342 @item show debug target
16343 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
16344 info.
16345 @item set debugvarobj
16346 @cindex variable object debugging info
16347 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
16348 info. The default is off.
16349 @item show debugvarobj
16350 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
16351 debugging info.
16352 @item set debug xml
16353 @cindex XML parser debugging
16354 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
16355 @item show debug xml
16356 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
16357 @end table
16358
16359 @node Sequences
16360 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
16361
16362 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
16363 command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
16364 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
16365 files.
16366
16367 @menu
16368 * Define:: How to define your own commands
16369 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
16370 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
16371 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
16372 @end menu
16373
16374 @node Define
16375 @section User-defined commands
16376
16377 @cindex user-defined command
16378 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
16379 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
16380 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
16381 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
16382 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
16383 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
16384
16385 @smallexample
16386 define adder
16387 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16388 end
16389 @end smallexample
16390
16391 @noindent
16392 To execute the command use:
16393
16394 @smallexample
16395 adder 1 2 3
16396 @end smallexample
16397
16398 @noindent
16399 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
16400 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
16401 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
16402 functions calls.
16403
16404 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
16405 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
16406 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
16407 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
16408
16409 @smallexample
16410 define adder
16411 if $argc == 2
16412 print $arg0 + $arg1
16413 end
16414 if $argc == 3
16415 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16416 end
16417 end
16418 @end smallexample
16419
16420 @table @code
16421
16422 @kindex define
16423 @item define @var{commandname}
16424 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
16425 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
16426
16427 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
16428 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
16429 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16430
16431 @kindex document
16432 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
16433 @item document @var{commandname}
16434 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
16435 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
16436 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
16437 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
16438 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
16439 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
16440
16441 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
16442 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
16443 does not change the documentation.
16444
16445 @kindex dont-repeat
16446 @cindex don't repeat command
16447 @item dont-repeat
16448 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
16449 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
16450 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
16451
16452 @kindex help user-defined
16453 @item help user-defined
16454 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
16455 (if any) for each.
16456
16457 @kindex show user
16458 @item show user
16459 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
16460 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
16461 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
16462 definitions for all user-defined commands.
16463
16464 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
16465 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
16466 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
16467 @item show max-user-call-depth
16468 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
16469 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
16470 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
16471 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
16472 @end table
16473
16474 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
16475 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
16476
16477 When user-defined commands are executed, the
16478 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
16479 stops execution of the user-defined command.
16480
16481 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
16482 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
16483 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
16484 messages when used in a user-defined command.
16485
16486 @node Hooks
16487 @section User-defined command hooks
16488 @cindex command hooks
16489 @cindex hooks, for commands
16490 @cindex hooks, pre-command
16491
16492 @kindex hook
16493 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
16494 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
16495 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
16496 before that command.
16497
16498 @cindex hooks, post-command
16499 @kindex hookpost
16500 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
16501 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
16502 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
16503 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
16504 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
16505
16506 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
16507 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
16508
16509 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
16510 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
16511
16512 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
16513 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
16514 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
16515 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
16516 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
16517
16518 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
16519 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
16520 you could define:
16521
16522 @smallexample
16523 define hook-stop
16524 handle SIGALRM nopass
16525 end
16526
16527 define hook-run
16528 handle SIGALRM pass
16529 end
16530
16531 define hook-continue
16532 handle SIGALRM pass
16533 end
16534 @end smallexample
16535
16536 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
16537 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
16538 you could define:
16539
16540 @smallexample
16541 define hook-echo
16542 echo <<<---
16543 end
16544
16545 define hookpost-echo
16546 echo --->>>\n
16547 end
16548
16549 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
16550 <<<---Hello World--->>>
16551 (@value{GDBP})
16552
16553 @end smallexample
16554
16555 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
16556 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
16557 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
16558 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
16559 @c or not?
16560 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
16561 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
16562 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
16563
16564 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
16565 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
16566
16567 @node Command Files
16568 @section Command files
16569
16570 @cindex command files
16571 @cindex scripting commands
16572 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
16573 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
16574 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
16575 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
16576 terminal.
16577
16578 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
16579 command:
16580
16581 @table @code
16582 @kindex source
16583 @cindex execute commands from a file
16584 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
16585 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
16586 @end table
16587
16588 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
16589 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
16590 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
16591 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
16592 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
16593
16594 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
16595 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
16596
16597 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
16598 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
16599 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
16600
16601 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
16602 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
16603 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
16604 when called from command files.
16605
16606 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
16607 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
16608 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
16609 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
16610 the next command.
16611
16612 @smallexample
16613 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
16614 @end smallexample
16615
16616 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
16617 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
16618 would be directed to @file{log}.
16619
16620 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
16621 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
16622 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
16623 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
16624 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
16625 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
16626 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
16627 conditionally, etc.
16628
16629 @table @code
16630 @kindex if
16631 @kindex else
16632 @item if
16633 @itemx else
16634 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
16635 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
16636 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
16637 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
16638 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
16639 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
16640 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16641
16642 @kindex while
16643 @item while
16644 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
16645 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
16646 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
16647 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
16648 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
16649 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
16650
16651 @kindex loop_break
16652 @item loop_break
16653 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
16654 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
16655 line.
16656
16657 @kindex loop_continue
16658 @item loop_continue
16659 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
16660 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
16661 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
16662 the controlling expression.
16663
16664 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
16665 @item end
16666 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
16667 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
16668 @end table
16669
16670
16671 @node Output
16672 @section Commands for controlled output
16673
16674 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
16675 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
16676 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
16677 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
16678 want.
16679
16680 @table @code
16681 @kindex echo
16682 @item echo @var{text}
16683 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
16684 @c because it is not in ANSI.
16685 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
16686 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
16687 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
16688 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
16689 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
16690 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
16691 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
16692 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
16693 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
16694
16695 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
16696 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
16697
16698 @smallexample
16699 echo This is some text\n\
16700 which is continued\n\
16701 onto several lines.\n
16702 @end smallexample
16703
16704 produces the same output as
16705
16706 @smallexample
16707 echo This is some text\n
16708 echo which is continued\n
16709 echo onto several lines.\n
16710 @end smallexample
16711
16712 @kindex output
16713 @item output @var{expression}
16714 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
16715 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
16716 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
16717 on expressions.
16718
16719 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
16720 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
16721 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
16722 formats}, for more information.
16723
16724 @kindex printf
16725 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
16726 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
16727 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
16728 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
16729 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
16730 subroutine
16731 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
16732 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
16733 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
16734 @c supported.
16735
16736 @smallexample
16737 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
16738 @end smallexample
16739
16740 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
16741
16742 @smallexample
16743 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
16744 @end smallexample
16745
16746 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
16747 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
16748 letter.
16749 @end table
16750
16751 @node Interpreters
16752 @chapter Command Interpreters
16753 @cindex command interpreters
16754
16755 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
16756 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
16757 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
16758
16759 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
16760 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
16761 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
16762 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
16763
16764 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
16765 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
16766 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
16767 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
16768
16769 @table @code
16770 @item console
16771 @cindex console interpreter
16772 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
16773 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
16774 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
16775
16776 @item mi
16777 @cindex mi interpreter
16778 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
16779 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
16780 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
16781 Interface}.
16782
16783 @item mi2
16784 @cindex mi2 interpreter
16785 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
16786
16787 @item mi1
16788 @cindex mi1 interpreter
16789 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
16790
16791 @end table
16792
16793 @cindex invoke another interpreter
16794 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
16795 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
16796 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
16797 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
16798 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
16799 the IDE inoperable!
16800
16801 @kindex interpreter-exec
16802 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
16803 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
16804 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
16805 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
16806
16807 @smallexample
16808 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
16809 @end smallexample
16810
16811 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
16812 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
16813
16814 @node TUI
16815 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
16816 @cindex TUI
16817 @cindex Text User Interface
16818
16819 @menu
16820 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
16821 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
16822 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
16823 * TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
16824 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
16825 @end menu
16826
16827 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short, is a terminal
16828 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
16829 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
16830 commands in separate text windows.
16831
16832 The TUI is enabled by invoking @value{GDBN} using either
16833 @pindex gdbtui
16834 @samp{gdbtui} or @samp{gdb -tui}.
16835
16836 @node TUI Overview
16837 @section TUI overview
16838
16839 The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
16840 @value{GDBN} runs:
16841
16842 @itemize @bullet
16843 @item
16844 A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
16845 windows on the terminal.
16846
16847 @item
16848 A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
16849 the TUI.
16850 @end itemize
16851
16852 In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
16853 on the terminal:
16854
16855 @table @emph
16856 @item command
16857 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
16858 prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
16859 managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
16860 window is always visible.
16861
16862 @item source
16863 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
16864 line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
16865
16866 @item assembly
16867 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
16868
16869 @item register
16870 This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
16871 a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
16872 changed are highlighted.
16873
16874 @end table
16875
16876 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
16877 by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
16878 Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
16879 indicates the breakpoint type:
16880
16881 @table @code
16882 @item B
16883 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16884
16885 @item b
16886 Breakpoint which was never hit.
16887
16888 @item H
16889 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16890
16891 @item h
16892 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
16893
16894 @end table
16895
16896 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
16897
16898 @table @code
16899 @item +
16900 Breakpoint is enabled.
16901
16902 @item -
16903 Breakpoint is disabled.
16904
16905 @end table
16906
16907 The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
16908 and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
16909 changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
16910 These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
16911 layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
16912 The following layouts are available:
16913
16914 @itemize @bullet
16915 @item
16916 source
16917
16918 @item
16919 assembly
16920
16921 @item
16922 source and assembly
16923
16924 @item
16925 source and registers
16926
16927 @item
16928 assembly and registers
16929
16930 @end itemize
16931
16932 On top of the command window a status line gives various information
16933 concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
16934 updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
16935 are displayed:
16936
16937 @table @emph
16938 @item target
16939 Indicates the current gdb target
16940 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16941
16942 @item process
16943 Gives information about the current process or thread number.
16944 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
16945
16946 @item function
16947 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
16948 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
16949 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
16950 the string @code{??} is displayed.
16951
16952 @item line
16953 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
16954 When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
16955
16956 @item pc
16957 Indicates the current program counter address.
16958
16959 @end table
16960
16961 @node TUI Keys
16962 @section TUI Key Bindings
16963 @cindex TUI key bindings
16964
16965 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
16966 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
16967 They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
16968 directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
16969 a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
16970 @value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
16971 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
16972
16973 @table @kbd
16974 @kindex C-x C-a
16975 @item C-x C-a
16976 @kindex C-x a
16977 @itemx C-x a
16978 @kindex C-x A
16979 @itemx C-x A
16980 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
16981 the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
16982 its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
16983 mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
16984 The screen is then refreshed.
16985
16986 @kindex C-x 1
16987 @item C-x 1
16988 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
16989 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
16990 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
16991
16992 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
16993
16994 @kindex C-x 2
16995 @item C-x 2
16996 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
16997 layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
16998 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
16999 previous layout and the new one.
17000
17001 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
17002
17003 @kindex C-x o
17004 @item C-x o
17005 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
17006 (like scrolling and arrow keys) to the active window. This command
17007 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
17008
17009 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
17010
17011 @kindex C-x s
17012 @item C-x s
17013 Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
17014 (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
17015
17016 @end table
17017
17018 The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
17019
17020 @table @key
17021 @kindex PgUp
17022 @item PgUp
17023 Scroll the active window one page up.
17024
17025 @kindex PgDn
17026 @item PgDn
17027 Scroll the active window one page down.
17028
17029 @kindex Up
17030 @item Up
17031 Scroll the active window one line up.
17032
17033 @kindex Down
17034 @item Down
17035 Scroll the active window one line down.
17036
17037 @kindex Left
17038 @item Left
17039 Scroll the active window one column left.
17040
17041 @kindex Right
17042 @item Right
17043 Scroll the active window one column right.
17044
17045 @kindex C-L
17046 @item C-L
17047 Refresh the screen.
17048
17049 @end table
17050
17051 In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
17052 for scrolling. This means they are available for readline when the
17053 active window is the command window. When the command window
17054 does not have the focus, it is necessary to use other readline
17055 key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b} and @kbd{C-f}.
17056
17057 @node TUI Single Key Mode
17058 @section TUI Single Key Mode
17059 @cindex TUI single key mode
17060
17061 The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
17062 key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
17063 some gdb commands.
17064
17065 @table @kbd
17066 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17067 @item c
17068 continue
17069
17070 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17071 @item d
17072 down
17073
17074 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17075 @item f
17076 finish
17077
17078 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17079 @item n
17080 next
17081
17082 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17083 @item q
17084 exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
17085
17086 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17087 @item r
17088 run
17089
17090 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17091 @item s
17092 step
17093
17094 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17095 @item u
17096 up
17097
17098 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17099 @item v
17100 info locals
17101
17102 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17103 @item w
17104 where
17105
17106 @end table
17107
17108 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
17109 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
17110 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
17111 with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
17112 @emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
17113 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
17114
17115
17116 @node TUI Commands
17117 @section TUI specific commands
17118 @cindex TUI commands
17119
17120 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
17121 These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
17122 the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
17123 is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
17124 in the TUI mode.
17125
17126 @table @code
17127 @item info win
17128 @kindex info win
17129 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
17130
17131 @item layout next
17132 @kindex layout
17133 Display the next layout.
17134
17135 @item layout prev
17136 Display the previous layout.
17137
17138 @item layout src
17139 Display the source window only.
17140
17141 @item layout asm
17142 Display the assembly window only.
17143
17144 @item layout split
17145 Display the source and assembly window.
17146
17147 @item layout regs
17148 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
17149
17150 @item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
17151 @kindex focus
17152 Set the focus to the named window.
17153 This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
17154 can be affected to another window.
17155
17156 @item refresh
17157 @kindex refresh
17158 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
17159
17160 @item tui reg float
17161 @kindex tui reg
17162 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
17163
17164 @item tui reg general
17165 Show the general registers in the register window.
17166
17167 @item tui reg next
17168 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
17169 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
17170 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
17171 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
17172
17173 @item tui reg system
17174 Show the system registers in the register window.
17175
17176 @item update
17177 @kindex update
17178 Update the source window and the current execution point.
17179
17180 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
17181 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
17182 @kindex winheight
17183 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
17184 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
17185 decrease it.
17186
17187 @item tabset
17188 @kindex tabset @var{nchars}
17189 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
17190
17191 @end table
17192
17193 @node TUI Configuration
17194 @section TUI configuration variables
17195 @cindex TUI configuration variables
17196
17197 The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
17198 appearance of windows on the terminal.
17199
17200 @table @code
17201 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
17202 @kindex set tui border-kind
17203 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
17204 The possible values are the following:
17205 @table @code
17206 @item space
17207 Use a space character to draw the border.
17208
17209 @item ascii
17210 Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
17211
17212 @item acs
17213 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
17214 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
17215
17216 @end table
17217
17218 @item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
17219 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
17220 Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
17221 The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
17222 @code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
17223
17224 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
17225 @kindex set tui border-mode
17226 Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
17227 The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
17228 @table @code
17229 @item normal
17230 Use normal attributes to display the border.
17231
17232 @item standout
17233 Use standout mode.
17234
17235 @item reverse
17236 Use reverse video mode.
17237
17238 @item half
17239 Use half bright mode.
17240
17241 @item half-standout
17242 Use half bright and standout mode.
17243
17244 @item bold
17245 Use extra bright or bold mode.
17246
17247 @item bold-standout
17248 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
17249
17250 @end table
17251
17252 @end table
17253
17254 @node Emacs
17255 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
17256
17257 @cindex Emacs
17258 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
17259 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
17260 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
17261 @value{GDBN}.
17262
17263 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
17264 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
17265 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
17266 created Emacs buffer.
17267 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
17268
17269 Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
17270 things:
17271
17272 @itemize @bullet
17273 @item
17274 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
17275 @end itemize
17276
17277 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
17278 and output done by the program you are debugging.
17279
17280 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
17281 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
17282 in this way.
17283
17284 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
17285 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
17286 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
17287 stop.
17288
17289 @itemize @bullet
17290 @item
17291 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
17292 @end itemize
17293
17294 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
17295 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
17296 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
17297 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
17298 and the source.
17299
17300 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
17301 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
17302
17303 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
17304 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
17305 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
17306 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
17307 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
17308 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
17309 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
17310 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
17311 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
17312
17313 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
17314 line of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer and this serves as a default for
17315 the commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate
17316 on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
17317
17318 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
17319 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
17320 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
17321 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
17322 one you want.
17323
17324 In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
17325 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
17326
17327 @table @kbd
17328 @item C-h m
17329 Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
17330
17331 @item C-c C-s
17332 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
17333 update the display window to show the current file and location.
17334
17335 @item C-c C-n
17336 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
17337 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
17338 to show the current file and location.
17339
17340 @item C-c C-i
17341 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
17342 display window accordingly.
17343
17344 @item C-c C-f
17345 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
17346 @code{finish} command.
17347
17348 @item C-c C-r
17349 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
17350 command.
17351
17352 @item C-c <
17353 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
17354 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
17355 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
17356
17357 @item C-c >
17358 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
17359 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
17360 @end table
17361
17362 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
17363 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
17364
17365 If you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, then Emacs displays a separate frame which
17366 shows a backtrace when the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer is current. Move
17367 point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it become the
17368 current frame and display the associated source in the source buffer.
17369 Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the selected frame become the
17370 current one.
17371
17372 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
17373 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
17374 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
17375 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
17376 frame.
17377
17378 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
17379 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
17380 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
17381 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
17382 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
17383 to correspond properly with the code.
17384
17385 The description given here is for GNU Emacs version 21.3 and a more
17386 detailed description of its interaction with @value{GDBN} is given in
17387 the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}).
17388
17389 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
17390 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
17391 @ignore
17392 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
17393 @kindex Epoch
17394 @kindex inspect
17395
17396 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
17397 called the @code{epoch}
17398 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
17399 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
17400 each value is printed in its own window.
17401 @end ignore
17402
17403
17404 @node GDB/MI
17405 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
17406
17407 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
17408
17409 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
17410 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
17411 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
17412 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
17413 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
17414 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
17415
17416 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
17417 in the form of a reference manual.
17418
17419 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
17420 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
17421 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
17422
17423 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
17424
17425 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
17426 This chapter uses the following notation:
17427
17428 @itemize @bullet
17429 @item
17430 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
17431
17432 @item
17433 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
17434 it may or may not be given.
17435
17436 @item
17437 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17438 may repeat zero or more times.
17439
17440 @item
17441 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17442 may repeat one or more times.
17443
17444 @item
17445 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
17446 @end itemize
17447
17448 @ignore
17449 @heading Dependencies
17450 @end ignore
17451
17452 @menu
17453 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
17454 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
17455 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
17456 * GDB/MI Output Records::
17457 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
17458 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
17459 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
17460 * GDB/MI Program Context::
17461 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
17462 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
17463 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
17464 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
17465 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
17466 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
17467 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
17468 * GDB/MI File Commands::
17469 @ignore
17470 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
17471 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
17472 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
17473 @end ignore
17474 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
17475 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
17476 @end menu
17477
17478 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17479 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
17480 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
17481
17482 @menu
17483 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
17484 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
17485 @end menu
17486
17487 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
17488 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
17489
17490 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
17491 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
17492 @table @code
17493 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
17494 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
17495
17496 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
17497 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
17498 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17499
17500 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
17501 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
17502 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
17503
17504 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17505 "any sequence of digits"
17506
17507 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
17508 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
17509
17510 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
17511 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
17512
17513 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
17514 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
17515
17516 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
17517 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
17518 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
17519
17520 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
17521 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
17522
17523 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17524 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17525 @end table
17526
17527 @noindent
17528 Notes:
17529
17530 @itemize @bullet
17531 @item
17532 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
17533 output is described below.
17534
17535 @item
17536 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
17537 finishes.
17538
17539 @item
17540 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
17541 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
17542 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
17543 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
17544 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
17545 @end itemize
17546
17547 Pragmatics:
17548
17549 @itemize @bullet
17550 @item
17551 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
17552
17553 @item
17554 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
17555 @end itemize
17556
17557 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
17558 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
17559
17560 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
17561 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
17562 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
17563 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
17564 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
17565 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
17566
17567 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
17568 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
17569 @var{token}.
17570
17571 @table @code
17572 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
17573 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
17574
17575 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
17576 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17577
17578 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
17579 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
17580
17581 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
17582 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
17583
17584 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
17585 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
17586
17587 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
17588 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
17589
17590 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
17591 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
17592
17593 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
17594 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17595
17596 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
17597 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
17598
17599 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
17600 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
17601 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
17602
17603 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
17604 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
17605
17606 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
17607 @code{ @var{string} }
17608
17609 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
17610 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
17611
17612 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
17613 @code{@var{c-string}}
17614
17615 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
17616 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
17617
17618 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
17619 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
17620 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
17621
17622 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
17623 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
17624
17625 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
17626 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
17627
17628 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
17629 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
17630
17631 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
17632 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
17633
17634 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17635 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17636
17637 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17638 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
17639 @end table
17640
17641 @noindent
17642 Notes:
17643
17644 @itemize @bullet
17645 @item
17646 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
17647
17648 @item
17649 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
17650 command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
17651 @var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
17652 original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
17653
17654 @item
17655 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17656 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
17657 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
17658 prefixed by @samp{+}.
17659
17660 @item
17661 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17662 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
17663 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
17664 @samp{*}.
17665
17666 @item
17667 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17668 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
17669 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
17670 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
17671
17672 @item
17673 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17674 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
17675 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
17676 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
17677
17678 @item
17679 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17680 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
17681 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
17682
17683 @item
17684 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17685 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
17686 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
17687 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
17688
17689 @item
17690 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17691 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
17692 @var{values}.
17693
17694
17695 @end itemize
17696
17697 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
17698 details about the various output records.
17699
17700 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17701 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
17702 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
17703
17704 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
17705 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
17706
17707 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
17708 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
17709 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
17710 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
17711 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
17712 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
17713
17714 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
17715 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
17716 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
17717
17718 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17719 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
17720 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
17721 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
17722
17723 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
17724 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
17725
17726 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
17727 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
17728 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
17729 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
17730 might change.
17731
17732 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
17733 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
17734 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
17735 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
17736
17737 @itemize @bullet
17738 @item
17739 New MI commands may be added.
17740
17741 @item
17742 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
17743
17744 @item
17745 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
17746 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
17747
17748 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
17749 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
17750
17751 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
17752 @c resolve inconsistencies.
17753 @end itemize
17754
17755 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
17756 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
17757 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
17758 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
17759 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
17760
17761 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
17762 @c version?
17763
17764 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
17765 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
17766 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
17767 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}. There is also the mailing list
17768 @email{dmi-discuss@@lists.freestandards.org}, hosted by the Free Standards
17769 Group, which has the aim of creating a more general MI protocol
17770 called Debugger Machine Interface (DMI) that will become a standard
17771 for all debuggers, not just @value{GDBN}.
17772 @cindex mailing lists
17773
17774 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17775 @node GDB/MI Output Records
17776 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
17777
17778 @menu
17779 * GDB/MI Result Records::
17780 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
17781 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
17782 @end menu
17783
17784 @node GDB/MI Result Records
17785 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
17786
17787 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17788 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
17789 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
17790 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
17791
17792 @table @code
17793 @findex ^done
17794 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
17795 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
17796 values.
17797
17798 @item "^running"
17799 @findex ^running
17800 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
17801 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
17802 running.
17803
17804 @item "^connected"
17805 @findex ^connected
17806 GDB has connected to a remote target.
17807
17808 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
17809 @findex ^error
17810 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
17811 error message.
17812
17813 @item "^exit"
17814 @findex ^exit
17815 GDB has terminated.
17816
17817 @end table
17818
17819 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
17820 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
17821
17822 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
17823 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17824 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
17825 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
17826 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
17827
17828 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
17829 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
17830 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
17831 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
17832 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
17833
17834 @table @code
17835 @item "~" @var{string-output}
17836 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
17837 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
17838
17839 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
17840 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
17841 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
17842 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
17843
17844 @item "&" @var{string-output}
17845 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
17846 internals.
17847 @end table
17848
17849 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
17850 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
17851
17852 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17853 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
17854 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
17855 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
17856 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
17857 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
17858
17859 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
17860 In particular, the @var{exec-async-output} records.
17861
17862 @table @code
17863 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
17864 @end table
17865
17866 @var{reason} can be one of the following:
17867
17868 @table @code
17869 @item breakpoint-hit
17870 A breakpoint was reached.
17871 @item watchpoint-trigger
17872 A watchpoint was triggered.
17873 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
17874 A read watchpoint was triggered.
17875 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
17876 An access watchpoint was triggered.
17877 @item function-finished
17878 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17879 @item location-reached
17880 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17881 @item watchpoint-scope
17882 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
17883 @item end-stepping-range
17884 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
17885 similar CLI command was accomplished.
17886 @item exited-signalled
17887 The inferior exited because of a signal.
17888 @item exited
17889 The inferior exited.
17890 @item exited-normally
17891 The inferior exited normally.
17892 @item signal-received
17893 A signal was received by the inferior.
17894 @end table
17895
17896
17897 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17898 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
17899 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
17900 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
17901
17902 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
17903 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
17904 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
17905 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
17906
17907 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
17908 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
17909
17910 @subheading Setting a breakpoint
17911
17912 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
17913 information of the breakpoint.
17914
17915 @smallexample
17916 -> -break-insert main
17917 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
17918 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
17919 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
17920 <- (gdb)
17921 @end smallexample
17922
17923 @subheading Program Execution
17924
17925 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
17926 reason that execution stopped.
17927
17928 @smallexample
17929 -> -exec-run
17930 <- ^running
17931 <- (gdb)
17932 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
17933 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
17934 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
17935 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
17936 <- (gdb)
17937 -> -exec-continue
17938 <- ^running
17939 <- (gdb)
17940 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
17941 <- (gdb)
17942 @end smallexample
17943
17944 @subheading Quitting GDB
17945
17946 Quitting GDB just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
17947
17948 @smallexample
17949 -> (gdb)
17950 <- -gdb-exit
17951 <- ^exit
17952 @end smallexample
17953
17954 @subheading A Bad Command
17955
17956 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
17957
17958 @smallexample
17959 -> -rubbish
17960 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
17961 <- (gdb)
17962 @end smallexample
17963
17964
17965 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17966 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
17967 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
17968
17969 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
17970 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
17971
17972 @subheading Motivation
17973
17974 The motivation for this collection of commands.
17975
17976 @subheading Introduction
17977
17978 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
17979
17980 @subheading Commands
17981
17982 For each command in the block, the following is described:
17983
17984 @subsubheading Synopsis
17985
17986 @smallexample
17987 -command @var{args}@dots{}
17988 @end smallexample
17989
17990 @subsubheading Result
17991
17992 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17993
17994 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
17995
17996 @subsubheading Example
17997
17998 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
17999 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
18000
18001
18002 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18003 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
18004 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
18005
18006 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
18007 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
18008 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
18009 breakpoints.
18010
18011 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
18012 @findex -break-after
18013
18014 @subsubheading Synopsis
18015
18016 @smallexample
18017 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
18018 @end smallexample
18019
18020 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
18021 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
18022 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
18023 @samp{-break-list} command below.
18024
18025 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18026
18027 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
18028
18029 @subsubheading Example
18030
18031 @smallexample
18032 (gdb)
18033 -break-insert main
18034 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",
18035 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
18036 (gdb)
18037 -break-after 1 3
18038 ~
18039 ^done
18040 (gdb)
18041 -break-list
18042 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18043 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18044 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18045 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18046 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18047 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18048 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18049 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18050 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18051 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18052 (gdb)
18053 @end smallexample
18054
18055 @ignore
18056 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
18057 @findex -break-catch
18058
18059 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
18060 @findex -break-commands
18061 @end ignore
18062
18063
18064 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
18065 @findex -break-condition
18066
18067 @subsubheading Synopsis
18068
18069 @smallexample
18070 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
18071 @end smallexample
18072
18073 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
18074 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
18075 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
18076 command below).
18077
18078 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18079
18080 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
18081
18082 @subsubheading Example
18083
18084 @smallexample
18085 (gdb)
18086 -break-condition 1 1
18087 ^done
18088 (gdb)
18089 -break-list
18090 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18091 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18092 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18093 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18094 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18095 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18096 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18097 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18098 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18099 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18100 (gdb)
18101 @end smallexample
18102
18103 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
18104 @findex -break-delete
18105
18106 @subsubheading Synopsis
18107
18108 @smallexample
18109 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18110 @end smallexample
18111
18112 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
18113 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
18114
18115 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18116
18117 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
18118
18119 @subsubheading Example
18120
18121 @smallexample
18122 (gdb)
18123 -break-delete 1
18124 ^done
18125 (gdb)
18126 -break-list
18127 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18128 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18129 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18130 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18131 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18132 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18133 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18134 body=[]@}
18135 (gdb)
18136 @end smallexample
18137
18138 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
18139 @findex -break-disable
18140
18141 @subsubheading Synopsis
18142
18143 @smallexample
18144 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18145 @end smallexample
18146
18147 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
18148 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
18149
18150 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18151
18152 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
18153
18154 @subsubheading Example
18155
18156 @smallexample
18157 (gdb)
18158 -break-disable 2
18159 ^done
18160 (gdb)
18161 -break-list
18162 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18163 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18164 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18165 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18166 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18167 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18168 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18169 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
18170 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18171 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18172 (gdb)
18173 @end smallexample
18174
18175 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
18176 @findex -break-enable
18177
18178 @subsubheading Synopsis
18179
18180 @smallexample
18181 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18182 @end smallexample
18183
18184 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
18185
18186 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18187
18188 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
18189
18190 @subsubheading Example
18191
18192 @smallexample
18193 (gdb)
18194 -break-enable 2
18195 ^done
18196 (gdb)
18197 -break-list
18198 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18199 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18200 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18201 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18202 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18203 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18204 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18205 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18206 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18207 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18208 (gdb)
18209 @end smallexample
18210
18211 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
18212 @findex -break-info
18213
18214 @subsubheading Synopsis
18215
18216 @smallexample
18217 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
18218 @end smallexample
18219
18220 @c REDUNDANT???
18221 Get information about a single breakpoint.
18222
18223 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18224
18225 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
18226
18227 @subsubheading Example
18228 N.A.
18229
18230 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
18231 @findex -break-insert
18232
18233 @subsubheading Synopsis
18234
18235 @smallexample
18236 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -r ]
18237 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
18238 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{line} | @var{addr} ]
18239 @end smallexample
18240
18241 @noindent
18242 If specified, @var{line}, can be one of:
18243
18244 @itemize @bullet
18245 @item function
18246 @c @item +offset
18247 @c @item -offset
18248 @c @item linenum
18249 @item filename:linenum
18250 @item filename:function
18251 @item *address
18252 @end itemize
18253
18254 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
18255
18256 @table @samp
18257 @item -t
18258 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
18259 @item -h
18260 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
18261 @item -c @var{condition}
18262 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
18263 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
18264 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
18265 @item -r
18266 Insert a regular breakpoint in all the functions whose names match the
18267 given regular expression. Other flags are not applicable to regular
18268 expressions.
18269 @end table
18270
18271 @subsubheading Result
18272
18273 The result is in the form:
18274
18275 @smallexample
18276 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
18277 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
18278 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
18279 times="@var{times}"@}
18280 @end smallexample
18281
18282 @noindent
18283 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
18284 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
18285 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
18286 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
18287 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
18288 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
18289 which use the same output).
18290
18291 Note: this format is open to change.
18292 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
18293
18294 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18295
18296 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
18297 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
18298
18299 @subsubheading Example
18300
18301 @smallexample
18302 (gdb)
18303 -break-insert main
18304 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
18305 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
18306 (gdb)
18307 -break-insert -t foo
18308 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
18309 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
18310 (gdb)
18311 -break-list
18312 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18313 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18314 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18315 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18316 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18317 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18318 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18319 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18320 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
18321 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
18322 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
18323 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
18324 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
18325 (gdb)
18326 -break-insert -r foo.*
18327 ~int foo(int, int);
18328 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
18329 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
18330 (gdb)
18331 @end smallexample
18332
18333 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
18334 @findex -break-list
18335
18336 @subsubheading Synopsis
18337
18338 @smallexample
18339 -break-list
18340 @end smallexample
18341
18342 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
18343
18344 @table @samp
18345 @item Number
18346 number of the breakpoint
18347 @item Type
18348 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
18349 @item Disposition
18350 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
18351 or @samp{nokeep}
18352 @item Enabled
18353 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
18354 @item Address
18355 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
18356 @item What
18357 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
18358 name, line number
18359 @item Times
18360 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
18361 @end table
18362
18363 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
18364 @code{body} field is an empty list.
18365
18366 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18367
18368 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
18369
18370 @subsubheading Example
18371
18372 @smallexample
18373 (gdb)
18374 -break-list
18375 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18376 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18377 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18378 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18379 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18380 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18381 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18382 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18383 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
18384 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18385 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18386 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
18387 (gdb)
18388 @end smallexample
18389
18390 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
18391
18392 @smallexample
18393 (gdb)
18394 -break-list
18395 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18396 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18397 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18398 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18399 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18400 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18401 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18402 body=[]@}
18403 (gdb)
18404 @end smallexample
18405
18406 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
18407 @findex -break-watch
18408
18409 @subsubheading Synopsis
18410
18411 @smallexample
18412 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
18413 @end smallexample
18414
18415 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
18416 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
18417 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
18418 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
18419 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
18420 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
18421 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
18422 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting watchpoints}.
18423
18424 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
18425 breakpoints inserted.
18426
18427 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18428
18429 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
18430 @samp{rwatch}.
18431
18432 @subsubheading Example
18433
18434 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
18435
18436 @smallexample
18437 (gdb)
18438 -break-watch x
18439 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
18440 (gdb)
18441 -exec-continue
18442 ^running
18443 (gdb)
18444 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
18445 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
18446 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18447 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
18448 (gdb)
18449 @end smallexample
18450
18451 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
18452 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
18453 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
18454
18455 @smallexample
18456 (gdb)
18457 -break-watch C
18458 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
18459 (gdb)
18460 -exec-continue
18461 ^running
18462 (gdb)
18463 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
18464 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18465 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18466 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18467 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18468 (gdb)
18469 -exec-continue
18470 ^running
18471 (gdb)
18472 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
18473 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18474 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18475 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18476 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18477 (gdb)
18478 @end smallexample
18479
18480 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
18481 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
18482 deleted.
18483
18484 @smallexample
18485 (gdb)
18486 -break-watch C
18487 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
18488 (gdb)
18489 -break-list
18490 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18491 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18492 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18493 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18494 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18495 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18496 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18497 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18498 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18499 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18500 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
18501 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18502 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
18503 (gdb)
18504 -exec-continue
18505 ^running
18506 (gdb)
18507 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
18508 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18509 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18510 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18511 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18512 (gdb)
18513 -break-list
18514 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18515 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18516 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18517 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18518 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18519 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18520 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18521 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18522 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18523 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18524 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
18525 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18526 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
18527 (gdb)
18528 -exec-continue
18529 ^running
18530 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
18531 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18532 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18533 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18534 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18535 (gdb)
18536 -break-list
18537 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18538 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18539 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18540 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18541 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18542 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18543 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18544 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18545 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18546 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18547 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
18548 times="1"@}]@}
18549 (gdb)
18550 @end smallexample
18551
18552 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18553 @node GDB/MI Program Context
18554 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
18555
18556 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18557 @findex -exec-arguments
18558
18559
18560 @subsubheading Synopsis
18561
18562 @smallexample
18563 -exec-arguments @var{args}
18564 @end smallexample
18565
18566 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
18567 @samp{-exec-run}.
18568
18569 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18570
18571 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
18572
18573 @subsubheading Example
18574
18575 @c FIXME!
18576 Don't have one around.
18577
18578
18579 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
18580 @findex -exec-show-arguments
18581
18582 @subsubheading Synopsis
18583
18584 @smallexample
18585 -exec-show-arguments
18586 @end smallexample
18587
18588 Print the arguments of the program.
18589
18590 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18591
18592 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
18593
18594 @subsubheading Example
18595 N.A.
18596
18597
18598 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
18599 @findex -environment-cd
18600
18601 @subsubheading Synopsis
18602
18603 @smallexample
18604 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
18605 @end smallexample
18606
18607 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
18608
18609 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18610
18611 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
18612
18613 @subsubheading Example
18614
18615 @smallexample
18616 (gdb)
18617 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18618 ^done
18619 (gdb)
18620 @end smallexample
18621
18622
18623 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
18624 @findex -environment-directory
18625
18626 @subsubheading Synopsis
18627
18628 @smallexample
18629 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18630 @end smallexample
18631
18632 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
18633 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
18634 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
18635 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18636 occurs as normal.
18637 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18638 multiple directories in a single command
18639 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18640 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18641 If blanks are needed as
18642 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18643 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18644 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18645 character must not be used
18646 in any directory name.
18647 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
18648
18649 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18650
18651 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
18652
18653 @subsubheading Example
18654
18655 @smallexample
18656 (gdb)
18657 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18658 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18659 (gdb)
18660 -environment-directory ""
18661 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18662 (gdb)
18663 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
18664 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
18665 (gdb)
18666 -environment-directory -r
18667 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
18668 (gdb)
18669 @end smallexample
18670
18671
18672 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
18673 @findex -environment-path
18674
18675 @subsubheading Synopsis
18676
18677 @smallexample
18678 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18679 @end smallexample
18680
18681 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
18682 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
18683 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
18684 supplied in addition to the
18685 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18686 occurs as normal.
18687 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18688 multiple directories in a single command
18689 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18690 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18691 If blanks are needed as
18692 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18693 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18694 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18695 character must not be used
18696 in any directory name.
18697 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
18698
18699
18700 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18701
18702 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
18703
18704 @subsubheading Example
18705
18706 @smallexample
18707 (gdb)
18708 -environment-path
18709 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
18710 (gdb)
18711 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
18712 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
18713 (gdb)
18714 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
18715 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
18716 (gdb)
18717 @end smallexample
18718
18719
18720 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
18721 @findex -environment-pwd
18722
18723 @subsubheading Synopsis
18724
18725 @smallexample
18726 -environment-pwd
18727 @end smallexample
18728
18729 Show the current working directory.
18730
18731 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18732
18733 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
18734
18735 @subsubheading Example
18736
18737 @smallexample
18738 (gdb)
18739 -environment-pwd
18740 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
18741 (gdb)
18742 @end smallexample
18743
18744 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18745 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
18746 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
18747
18748
18749 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
18750 @findex -thread-info
18751
18752 @subsubheading Synopsis
18753
18754 @smallexample
18755 -thread-info
18756 @end smallexample
18757
18758 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18759
18760 No equivalent.
18761
18762 @subsubheading Example
18763 N.A.
18764
18765
18766 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
18767 @findex -thread-list-all-threads
18768
18769 @subsubheading Synopsis
18770
18771 @smallexample
18772 -thread-list-all-threads
18773 @end smallexample
18774
18775 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18776
18777 The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
18778
18779 @subsubheading Example
18780 N.A.
18781
18782
18783 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
18784 @findex -thread-list-ids
18785
18786 @subsubheading Synopsis
18787
18788 @smallexample
18789 -thread-list-ids
18790 @end smallexample
18791
18792 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
18793 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
18794
18795 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18796
18797 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
18798
18799 @subsubheading Example
18800
18801 No threads present, besides the main process:
18802
18803 @smallexample
18804 (gdb)
18805 -thread-list-ids
18806 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
18807 (gdb)
18808 @end smallexample
18809
18810
18811 Several threads:
18812
18813 @smallexample
18814 (gdb)
18815 -thread-list-ids
18816 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18817 number-of-threads="3"
18818 (gdb)
18819 @end smallexample
18820
18821
18822 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
18823 @findex -thread-select
18824
18825 @subsubheading Synopsis
18826
18827 @smallexample
18828 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
18829 @end smallexample
18830
18831 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
18832 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
18833
18834 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18835
18836 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
18837
18838 @subsubheading Example
18839
18840 @smallexample
18841 (gdb)
18842 -exec-next
18843 ^running
18844 (gdb)
18845 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
18846 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
18847 (gdb)
18848 -thread-list-ids
18849 ^done,
18850 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18851 number-of-threads="3"
18852 (gdb)
18853 -thread-select 3
18854 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
18855 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
18856 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
18857 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
18858 (gdb)
18859 @end smallexample
18860
18861 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18862 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
18863 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
18864
18865 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
18866 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently GDB only really executes
18867 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
18868 other cases.
18869
18870 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
18871 @findex -exec-continue
18872
18873 @subsubheading Synopsis
18874
18875 @smallexample
18876 -exec-continue
18877 @end smallexample
18878
18879 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
18880 encountered, or until the inferior exits.
18881
18882 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18883
18884 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
18885
18886 @subsubheading Example
18887
18888 @smallexample
18889 -exec-continue
18890 ^running
18891 (gdb)
18892 @@Hello world
18893 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
18894 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="13"@}
18895 (gdb)
18896 @end smallexample
18897
18898
18899 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
18900 @findex -exec-finish
18901
18902 @subsubheading Synopsis
18903
18904 @smallexample
18905 -exec-finish
18906 @end smallexample
18907
18908 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
18909 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
18910
18911 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18912
18913 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
18914
18915 @subsubheading Example
18916
18917 Function returning @code{void}.
18918
18919 @smallexample
18920 -exec-finish
18921 ^running
18922 (gdb)
18923 @@hello from foo
18924 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
18925 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
18926 (gdb)
18927 @end smallexample
18928
18929 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
18930 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
18931 value itself.
18932
18933 @smallexample
18934 -exec-finish
18935 ^running
18936 (gdb)
18937 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
18938 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
18939 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
18940 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
18941 (gdb)
18942 @end smallexample
18943
18944
18945 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
18946 @findex -exec-interrupt
18947
18948 @subsubheading Synopsis
18949
18950 @smallexample
18951 -exec-interrupt
18952 @end smallexample
18953
18954 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
18955 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
18956 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
18957 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
18958 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
18959
18960 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18961
18962 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
18963
18964 @subsubheading Example
18965
18966 @smallexample
18967 (gdb)
18968 111-exec-continue
18969 111^running
18970
18971 (gdb)
18972 222-exec-interrupt
18973 222^done
18974 (gdb)
18975 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
18976 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18977 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
18978 (gdb)
18979
18980 (gdb)
18981 -exec-interrupt
18982 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
18983 (gdb)
18984 @end smallexample
18985
18986
18987 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
18988 @findex -exec-next
18989
18990 @subsubheading Synopsis
18991
18992 @smallexample
18993 -exec-next
18994 @end smallexample
18995
18996 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
18997 of the next source line is reached.
18998
18999 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19000
19001 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
19002
19003 @subsubheading Example
19004
19005 @smallexample
19006 -exec-next
19007 ^running
19008 (gdb)
19009 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
19010 (gdb)
19011 @end smallexample
19012
19013
19014 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
19015 @findex -exec-next-instruction
19016
19017 @subsubheading Synopsis
19018
19019 @smallexample
19020 -exec-next-instruction
19021 @end smallexample
19022
19023 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
19024 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
19025 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
19026 printed as well.
19027
19028 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19029
19030 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
19031
19032 @subsubheading Example
19033
19034 @smallexample
19035 (gdb)
19036 -exec-next-instruction
19037 ^running
19038
19039 (gdb)
19040 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19041 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
19042 (gdb)
19043 @end smallexample
19044
19045
19046 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
19047 @findex -exec-return
19048
19049 @subsubheading Synopsis
19050
19051 @smallexample
19052 -exec-return
19053 @end smallexample
19054
19055 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
19056 Displays the new current frame.
19057
19058 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19059
19060 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
19061
19062 @subsubheading Example
19063
19064 @smallexample
19065 (gdb)
19066 200-break-insert callee4
19067 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
19068 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19069 (gdb)
19070 000-exec-run
19071 000^running
19072 (gdb)
19073 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
19074 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
19075 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19076 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19077 (gdb)
19078 205-break-delete
19079 205^done
19080 (gdb)
19081 111-exec-return
19082 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
19083 args=[@{name="strarg",
19084 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
19085 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19086 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
19087 (gdb)
19088 @end smallexample
19089
19090
19091 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
19092 @findex -exec-run
19093
19094 @subsubheading Synopsis
19095
19096 @smallexample
19097 -exec-run
19098 @end smallexample
19099
19100 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
19101 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
19102 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
19103 the program has exited exceptionally.
19104
19105 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19106
19107 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
19108
19109 @subsubheading Examples
19110
19111 @smallexample
19112 (gdb)
19113 -break-insert main
19114 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19115 (gdb)
19116 -exec-run
19117 ^running
19118 (gdb)
19119 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
19120 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
19121 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19122 (gdb)
19123 @end smallexample
19124
19125 @noindent
19126 Program exited normally:
19127
19128 @smallexample
19129 (gdb)
19130 -exec-run
19131 ^running
19132 (gdb)
19133 x = 55
19134 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
19135 (gdb)
19136 @end smallexample
19137
19138 @noindent
19139 Program exited exceptionally:
19140
19141 @smallexample
19142 (gdb)
19143 -exec-run
19144 ^running
19145 (gdb)
19146 x = 55
19147 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
19148 (gdb)
19149 @end smallexample
19150
19151 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
19152 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
19153
19154 @smallexample
19155 (gdb)
19156 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
19157 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
19158 @end smallexample
19159
19160
19161 @c @subheading -exec-signal
19162
19163
19164 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
19165 @findex -exec-step
19166
19167 @subsubheading Synopsis
19168
19169 @smallexample
19170 -exec-step
19171 @end smallexample
19172
19173 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19174 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
19175 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
19176 function.
19177
19178 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19179
19180 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
19181
19182 @subsubheading Example
19183
19184 Stepping into a function:
19185
19186 @smallexample
19187 -exec-step
19188 ^running
19189 (gdb)
19190 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19191 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
19192 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
19193 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
19194 (gdb)
19195 @end smallexample
19196
19197 Regular stepping:
19198
19199 @smallexample
19200 -exec-step
19201 ^running
19202 (gdb)
19203 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
19204 (gdb)
19205 @end smallexample
19206
19207
19208 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
19209 @findex -exec-step-instruction
19210
19211 @subsubheading Synopsis
19212
19213 @smallexample
19214 -exec-step-instruction
19215 @end smallexample
19216
19217 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
19218 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
19219 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
19220 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
19221 well.
19222
19223 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19224
19225 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
19226
19227 @subsubheading Example
19228
19229 @smallexample
19230 (gdb)
19231 -exec-step-instruction
19232 ^running
19233
19234 (gdb)
19235 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19236 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19237 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19238 (gdb)
19239 -exec-step-instruction
19240 ^running
19241
19242 (gdb)
19243 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19244 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19245 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19246 (gdb)
19247 @end smallexample
19248
19249
19250 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
19251 @findex -exec-until
19252
19253 @subsubheading Synopsis
19254
19255 @smallexample
19256 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
19257 @end smallexample
19258
19259 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
19260 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
19261 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
19262 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
19263
19264 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19265
19266 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
19267
19268 @subsubheading Example
19269
19270 @smallexample
19271 (gdb)
19272 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
19273 ^running
19274 (gdb)
19275 x = 55
19276 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19277 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
19278 (gdb)
19279 @end smallexample
19280
19281 @ignore
19282 @subheading -file-clear
19283 Is this going away????
19284 @end ignore
19285
19286 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19287 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
19288 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
19289
19290
19291 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
19292 @findex -stack-info-frame
19293
19294 @subsubheading Synopsis
19295
19296 @smallexample
19297 -stack-info-frame
19298 @end smallexample
19299
19300 Get info on the selected frame.
19301
19302 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19303
19304 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
19305 (without arguments).
19306
19307 @subsubheading Example
19308
19309 @smallexample
19310 (gdb)
19311 -stack-info-frame
19312 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19313 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19314 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
19315 (gdb)
19316 @end smallexample
19317
19318 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
19319 @findex -stack-info-depth
19320
19321 @subsubheading Synopsis
19322
19323 @smallexample
19324 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
19325 @end smallexample
19326
19327 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
19328 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
19329
19330 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19331
19332 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
19333
19334 @subsubheading Example
19335
19336 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
19337
19338 @smallexample
19339 (gdb)
19340 -stack-info-depth
19341 ^done,depth="12"
19342 (gdb)
19343 -stack-info-depth 4
19344 ^done,depth="4"
19345 (gdb)
19346 -stack-info-depth 12
19347 ^done,depth="12"
19348 (gdb)
19349 -stack-info-depth 11
19350 ^done,depth="11"
19351 (gdb)
19352 -stack-info-depth 13
19353 ^done,depth="12"
19354 (gdb)
19355 @end smallexample
19356
19357 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
19358 @findex -stack-list-arguments
19359
19360 @subsubheading Synopsis
19361
19362 @smallexample
19363 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
19364 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19365 @end smallexample
19366
19367 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
19368 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
19369 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
19370 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
19371 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
19372 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
19373 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
19374 which case only existing frames will be returned.
19375
19376 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
19377 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
19378 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
19379
19380 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19381
19382 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
19383 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
19384 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
19385
19386 @subsubheading Example
19387
19388 @smallexample
19389 (gdb)
19390 -stack-list-frames
19391 ^done,
19392 stack=[
19393 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19394 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19395 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
19396 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19397 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19398 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
19399 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
19400 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19401 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
19402 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
19403 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19404 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
19405 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
19406 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19407 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
19408 (gdb)
19409 -stack-list-arguments 0
19410 ^done,
19411 stack-args=[
19412 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19413 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
19414 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
19415 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
19416 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19417 (gdb)
19418 -stack-list-arguments 1
19419 ^done,
19420 stack-args=[
19421 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19422 frame=@{level="1",
19423 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19424 frame=@{level="2",args=[
19425 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19426 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19427 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
19428 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19429 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
19430 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
19431 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19432 (gdb)
19433 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
19434 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
19435 (gdb)
19436 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
19437 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
19438 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19439 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
19440 (gdb)
19441 @end smallexample
19442
19443 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
19444
19445
19446 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19447 @findex -stack-list-frames
19448
19449 @subsubheading Synopsis
19450
19451 @smallexample
19452 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19453 @end smallexample
19454
19455 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19456 following info:
19457
19458 @table @samp
19459 @item @var{level}
19460 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
19461 @item @var{addr}
19462 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19463 @item @var{func}
19464 Function name.
19465 @item @var{file}
19466 File name of the source file where the function lives.
19467 @item @var{line}
19468 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19469 @end table
19470
19471 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19472 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19473 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19474 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
19475 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
19476 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
19477 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
19478
19479 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19480
19481 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19482
19483 @subsubheading Example
19484
19485 Full stack backtrace:
19486
19487 @smallexample
19488 (gdb)
19489 -stack-list-frames
19490 ^done,stack=
19491 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19492 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19493 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19494 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19495 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19496 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19497 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19498 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19499 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19500 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19501 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19502 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19503 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19504 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19505 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19506 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19507 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19508 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19509 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19510 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19511 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19512 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19513 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19514 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19515 (gdb)
19516 @end smallexample
19517
19518 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19519
19520 @smallexample
19521 (gdb)
19522 -stack-list-frames 3 5
19523 ^done,stack=
19524 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19525 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19526 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19527 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19528 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19529 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19530 (gdb)
19531 @end smallexample
19532
19533 Show a single frame:
19534
19535 @smallexample
19536 (gdb)
19537 -stack-list-frames 3 3
19538 ^done,stack=
19539 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19540 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19541 (gdb)
19542 @end smallexample
19543
19544
19545 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19546 @findex -stack-list-locals
19547
19548 @subsubheading Synopsis
19549
19550 @smallexample
19551 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19552 @end smallexample
19553
19554 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19555 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19556 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19557 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19558 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19559 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19560 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19561 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
19562 more detail.
19563
19564 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19565
19566 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
19567
19568 @subsubheading Example
19569
19570 @smallexample
19571 (gdb)
19572 -stack-list-locals 0
19573 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
19574 (gdb)
19575 -stack-list-locals --all-values
19576 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
19577 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
19578 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
19579 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
19580 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
19581 (gdb)
19582 @end smallexample
19583
19584
19585 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
19586 @findex -stack-select-frame
19587
19588 @subsubheading Synopsis
19589
19590 @smallexample
19591 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
19592 @end smallexample
19593
19594 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
19595 the stack.
19596
19597 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19598
19599 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
19600 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
19601
19602 @subsubheading Example
19603
19604 @smallexample
19605 (gdb)
19606 -stack-select-frame 2
19607 ^done
19608 (gdb)
19609 @end smallexample
19610
19611 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19612 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
19613 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
19614
19615 @ignore
19616
19617 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19618
19619 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
19620 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
19621 used by @code{Insight}.
19622
19623 The two main reasons for that are:
19624
19625 @enumerate 1
19626 @item
19627 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
19628
19629 @item
19630 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
19631 now).
19632 @end enumerate
19633
19634 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
19635 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
19636 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
19637 hints about their use.
19638
19639 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
19640 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
19641 least, the following operations:
19642
19643 @itemize @bullet
19644 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
19645 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
19646 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
19647 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
19648 @end itemize
19649
19650 @end ignore
19651
19652 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
19653
19654 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19655
19656 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
19657 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
19658 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
19659 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
19660 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
19661 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
19662 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
19663 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
19664 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
19665 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
19666 object, or to change display format.
19667
19668 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
19669 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
19670 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
19671 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
19672 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
19673 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types.
19674
19675 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
19676 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
19677 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
19678 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
19679 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
19680
19681 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
19682 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
19683 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
19684 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
19685 be transferred to the frontend.
19686
19687 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
19688 access this functionality:
19689
19690 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
19691 @item @strong{Operation}
19692 @tab @strong{Description}
19693
19694 @item @code{-var-create}
19695 @tab create a variable object
19696 @item @code{-var-delete}
19697 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
19698 @item @code{-var-set-format}
19699 @tab set the display format of this variable
19700 @item @code{-var-show-format}
19701 @tab show the display format of this variable
19702 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
19703 @tab tells how many children this object has
19704 @item @code{-var-list-children}
19705 @tab return a list of the object's children
19706 @item @code{-var-info-type}
19707 @tab show the type of this variable object
19708 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
19709 @tab print what this variable object represents
19710 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
19711 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
19712 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
19713 @tab get the value of this variable
19714 @item @code{-var-assign}
19715 @tab set the value of this variable
19716 @item @code{-var-update}
19717 @tab update the variable and its children
19718 @end multitable
19719
19720 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
19721 how it can be used.
19722
19723 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
19724
19725 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
19726 @findex -var-create
19727
19728 @subsubheading Synopsis
19729
19730 @smallexample
19731 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
19732 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
19733 @end smallexample
19734
19735 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
19736 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
19737 register.
19738
19739 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
19740 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
19741 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
19742 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
19743 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
19744
19745 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
19746 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
19747 frame should be used.
19748
19749 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
19750 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
19751
19752 @itemize @bullet
19753 @item
19754 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
19755
19756 @item
19757 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
19758
19759 @item
19760 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
19761 @end itemize
19762
19763 @subsubheading Result
19764
19765 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
19766 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
19767 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
19768
19769 @smallexample
19770 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
19771 @end smallexample
19772
19773
19774 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
19775 @findex -var-delete
19776
19777 @subsubheading Synopsis
19778
19779 @smallexample
19780 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
19781 @end smallexample
19782
19783 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
19784 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
19785
19786 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
19787
19788
19789 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
19790 @findex -var-set-format
19791
19792 @subsubheading Synopsis
19793
19794 @smallexample
19795 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
19796 @end smallexample
19797
19798 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
19799 @var{format-spec}.
19800
19801 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
19802
19803 @smallexample
19804 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
19805 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
19806 @end smallexample
19807
19808 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
19809 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
19810 for pointers, etc.).
19811
19812 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
19813 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
19814
19815 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
19816 @findex -var-show-format
19817
19818 @subsubheading Synopsis
19819
19820 @smallexample
19821 -var-show-format @var{name}
19822 @end smallexample
19823
19824 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
19825
19826 @smallexample
19827 @var{format} @expansion{}
19828 @var{format-spec}
19829 @end smallexample
19830
19831
19832 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
19833 @findex -var-info-num-children
19834
19835 @subsubheading Synopsis
19836
19837 @smallexample
19838 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
19839 @end smallexample
19840
19841 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
19842
19843 @smallexample
19844 numchild=@var{n}
19845 @end smallexample
19846
19847
19848 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
19849 @findex -var-list-children
19850
19851 @subsubheading Synopsis
19852
19853 @smallexample
19854 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
19855 @end smallexample
19856 @anchor{-var-list-children}
19857
19858 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
19859 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
19860 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
19861 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
19862 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
19863 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
19864 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
19865 and unions.
19866
19867 @subsubheading Example
19868
19869 @smallexample
19870 (gdb)
19871 -var-list-children n
19872 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19873 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19874 (gdb)
19875 -var-list-children --all-values n
19876 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19877 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19878 @end smallexample
19879
19880
19881 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
19882 @findex -var-info-type
19883
19884 @subsubheading Synopsis
19885
19886 @smallexample
19887 -var-info-type @var{name}
19888 @end smallexample
19889
19890 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
19891 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
19892 @value{GDBN} CLI:
19893
19894 @smallexample
19895 type=@var{typename}
19896 @end smallexample
19897
19898
19899 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
19900 @findex -var-info-expression
19901
19902 @subsubheading Synopsis
19903
19904 @smallexample
19905 -var-info-expression @var{name}
19906 @end smallexample
19907
19908 Returns what is represented by the variable object @var{name}:
19909
19910 @smallexample
19911 lang=@var{lang-spec},exp=@var{expression}
19912 @end smallexample
19913
19914 @noindent
19915 where @var{lang-spec} is @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
19916
19917 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
19918 @findex -var-show-attributes
19919
19920 @subsubheading Synopsis
19921
19922 @smallexample
19923 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
19924 @end smallexample
19925
19926 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
19927
19928 @smallexample
19929 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
19930 @end smallexample
19931
19932 @noindent
19933 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
19934
19935 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
19936 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
19937
19938 @subsubheading Synopsis
19939
19940 @smallexample
19941 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
19942 @end smallexample
19943
19944 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
19945 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the
19946 string can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
19947
19948 @smallexample
19949 value=@var{value}
19950 @end smallexample
19951
19952 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
19953 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
19954
19955 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
19956 @findex -var-assign
19957
19958 @subsubheading Synopsis
19959
19960 @smallexample
19961 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
19962 @end smallexample
19963
19964 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
19965 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
19966 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
19967 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
19968
19969 @subsubheading Example
19970
19971 @smallexample
19972 (gdb)
19973 -var-assign var1 3
19974 ^done,value="3"
19975 (gdb)
19976 -var-update *
19977 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
19978 (gdb)
19979 @end smallexample
19980
19981 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
19982 @findex -var-update
19983
19984 @subsubheading Synopsis
19985
19986 @smallexample
19987 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
19988 @end smallexample
19989
19990 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
19991 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
19992 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
19993 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
19994 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
19995 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
19996 object names, all existing variable objects are updated. The option
19997 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
19998 names are printed. The possible values of this options are the same
19999 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
20000 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
20001 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
20002
20003
20004 @subsubheading Example
20005
20006 @smallexample
20007 (gdb)
20008 -var-assign var1 3
20009 ^done,value="3"
20010 (gdb)
20011 -var-update --all-values var1
20012 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
20013 type_changed="false"@}]
20014 (gdb)
20015 @end smallexample
20016
20017 @anchor{-var-update}
20018 The field in_scope may take three values:
20019
20020 @table @code
20021 @item "true"
20022 The variable object's current value is valid.
20023
20024 @item "false"
20025 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
20026 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
20027 scope.
20028
20029 @item "invalid"
20030 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
20031 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
20032 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
20033 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
20034 objects.
20035 @end table
20036
20037 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
20038 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
20039
20040 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20041 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
20042 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
20043
20044 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
20045 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
20046 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
20047 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
20048
20049 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
20050 @c @subheading -data-assign
20051 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
20052 @c @subsubheading GDB command
20053 @c set variable
20054 @c @subsubheading Example
20055 @c N.A.
20056
20057 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
20058 @findex -data-disassemble
20059
20060 @subsubheading Synopsis
20061
20062 @smallexample
20063 -data-disassemble
20064 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
20065 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
20066 -- @var{mode}
20067 @end smallexample
20068
20069 @noindent
20070 Where:
20071
20072 @table @samp
20073 @item @var{start-addr}
20074 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
20075 @item @var{end-addr}
20076 is the end address
20077 @item @var{filename}
20078 is the name of the file to disassemble
20079 @item @var{linenum}
20080 is the line number to disassemble around
20081 @item @var{lines}
20082 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
20083 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
20084 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
20085 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
20086 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
20087 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
20088 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
20089 are displayed.
20090 @item @var{mode}
20091 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
20092 disassembly).
20093 @end table
20094
20095 @subsubheading Result
20096
20097 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
20098
20099 @itemize @bullet
20100 @item Address
20101 @item Func-name
20102 @item Offset
20103 @item Instruction
20104 @end itemize
20105
20106 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
20107 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
20108
20109 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20110
20111 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
20112
20113 @subsubheading Example
20114
20115 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
20116
20117 @smallexample
20118 (gdb)
20119 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
20120 ^done,
20121 asm_insns=[
20122 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20123 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20124 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20125 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20126 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
20127 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
20128 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
20129 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20130 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
20131 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
20132 (gdb)
20133 @end smallexample
20134
20135 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
20136 @code{main}.
20137
20138 @smallexample
20139 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
20140 ^done,asm_insns=[
20141 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20142 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20143 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20144 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20145 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20146 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20147 [@dots{}]
20148 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
20149 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
20150 (gdb)
20151 @end smallexample
20152
20153 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
20154
20155 @smallexample
20156 (gdb)
20157 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
20158 ^done,asm_insns=[
20159 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20160 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20161 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20162 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20163 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20164 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
20165 (gdb)
20166 @end smallexample
20167
20168 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
20169
20170 @smallexample
20171 (gdb)
20172 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
20173 ^done,asm_insns=[
20174 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
20175 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20176 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20177 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20178 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
20179 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
20180 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20181 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20182 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20183 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20184 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20185 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
20186 (gdb)
20187 @end smallexample
20188
20189
20190 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
20191 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
20192
20193 @subsubheading Synopsis
20194
20195 @smallexample
20196 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
20197 @end smallexample
20198
20199 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
20200 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
20201 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
20202
20203 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20204
20205 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
20206 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
20207 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
20208
20209 @subsubheading Example
20210
20211 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
20212 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
20213 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
20214 output.
20215
20216 @smallexample
20217 211-data-evaluate-expression A
20218 211^done,value="1"
20219 (gdb)
20220 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
20221 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
20222 (gdb)
20223 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
20224 411^done,value="4"
20225 (gdb)
20226 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
20227 511^done,value="4"
20228 (gdb)
20229 @end smallexample
20230
20231
20232 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
20233 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
20234
20235 @subsubheading Synopsis
20236
20237 @smallexample
20238 -data-list-changed-registers
20239 @end smallexample
20240
20241 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
20242
20243 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20244
20245 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
20246 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
20247
20248 @subsubheading Example
20249
20250 On a PPC MBX board:
20251
20252 @smallexample
20253 (gdb)
20254 -exec-continue
20255 ^running
20256
20257 (gdb)
20258 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
20259 args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="5"@}
20260 (gdb)
20261 -data-list-changed-registers
20262 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
20263 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
20264 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
20265 (gdb)
20266 @end smallexample
20267
20268
20269 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
20270 @findex -data-list-register-names
20271
20272 @subsubheading Synopsis
20273
20274 @smallexample
20275 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
20276 @end smallexample
20277
20278 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
20279 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
20280 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
20281 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
20282 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
20283 include empty register names.
20284
20285 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20286
20287 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
20288 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
20289 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
20290
20291 @subsubheading Example
20292
20293 For the PPC MBX board:
20294 @smallexample
20295 (gdb)
20296 -data-list-register-names
20297 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
20298 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
20299 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
20300 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
20301 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
20302 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
20303 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
20304 (gdb)
20305 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
20306 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
20307 (gdb)
20308 @end smallexample
20309
20310 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
20311 @findex -data-list-register-values
20312
20313 @subsubheading Synopsis
20314
20315 @smallexample
20316 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
20317 @end smallexample
20318
20319 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
20320 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
20321 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
20322 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
20323
20324 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
20325
20326 @table @code
20327 @item x
20328 Hexadecimal
20329 @item o
20330 Octal
20331 @item t
20332 Binary
20333 @item d
20334 Decimal
20335 @item r
20336 Raw
20337 @item N
20338 Natural
20339 @end table
20340
20341 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20342
20343 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
20344 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
20345
20346 @subsubheading Example
20347
20348 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
20349 don't appear in the actual output):
20350
20351 @smallexample
20352 (gdb)
20353 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
20354 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20355 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
20356 (gdb)
20357 -data-list-register-values x
20358 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
20359 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20360 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
20361 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
20362 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
20363 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
20364 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
20365 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
20366 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
20367 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20368 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
20369 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
20370 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
20371 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
20372 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
20373 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
20374 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
20375 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
20376 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
20377 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
20378 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
20379 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
20380 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
20381 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
20382 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
20383 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
20384 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
20385 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
20386 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
20387 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
20388 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
20389 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
20390 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20391 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
20392 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
20393 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
20394 (gdb)
20395 @end smallexample
20396
20397
20398 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
20399 @findex -data-read-memory
20400
20401 @subsubheading Synopsis
20402
20403 @smallexample
20404 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
20405 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
20406 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
20407 @end smallexample
20408
20409 @noindent
20410 where:
20411
20412 @table @samp
20413 @item @var{address}
20414 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
20415 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
20416 quoted using the C convention.
20417
20418 @item @var{word-format}
20419 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
20420 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
20421 ,Output formats}).
20422
20423 @item @var{word-size}
20424 The size of each memory word in bytes.
20425
20426 @item @var{nr-rows}
20427 The number of rows in the output table.
20428
20429 @item @var{nr-cols}
20430 The number of columns in the output table.
20431
20432 @item @var{aschar}
20433 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
20434 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
20435 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
20436 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
20437
20438 @item @var{byte-offset}
20439 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
20440 @end table
20441
20442 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
20443 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
20444 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
20445 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
20446 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
20447 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
20448 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
20449 @samp{addr}.
20450
20451 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
20452 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
20453 @samp{prev-page}.
20454
20455 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20456
20457 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
20458 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
20459
20460 @subsubheading Example
20461
20462 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
20463 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
20464 word. Display each word in hex.
20465
20466 @smallexample
20467 (gdb)
20468 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
20469 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
20470 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
20471 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
20472 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
20473 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
20474 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
20475 (gdb)
20476 @end smallexample
20477
20478 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
20479 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
20480
20481 @smallexample
20482 (gdb)
20483 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
20484 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
20485 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
20486 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
20487 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
20488 (gdb)
20489 @end smallexample
20490
20491 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
20492 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
20493 used as the non-printable character.
20494
20495 @smallexample
20496 (gdb)
20497 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
20498 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
20499 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
20500 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
20501 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20502 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20503 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20504 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20505 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
20506 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
20507 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
20508 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
20509 (gdb)
20510 @end smallexample
20511
20512 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20513 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
20514 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
20515
20516 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
20517
20518 @c @subheading -trace-actions
20519
20520 @c @subheading -trace-delete
20521
20522 @c @subheading -trace-disable
20523
20524 @c @subheading -trace-dump
20525
20526 @c @subheading -trace-enable
20527
20528 @c @subheading -trace-exists
20529
20530 @c @subheading -trace-find
20531
20532 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
20533
20534 @c @subheading -trace-info
20535
20536 @c @subheading -trace-insert
20537
20538 @c @subheading -trace-list
20539
20540 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
20541
20542 @c @subheading -trace-save
20543
20544 @c @subheading -trace-start
20545
20546 @c @subheading -trace-stop
20547
20548
20549 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20550 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
20551 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
20552
20553
20554 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
20555 @findex -symbol-info-address
20556
20557 @subsubheading Synopsis
20558
20559 @smallexample
20560 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
20561 @end smallexample
20562
20563 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
20564
20565 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20566
20567 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
20568
20569 @subsubheading Example
20570 N.A.
20571
20572
20573 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
20574 @findex -symbol-info-file
20575
20576 @subsubheading Synopsis
20577
20578 @smallexample
20579 -symbol-info-file
20580 @end smallexample
20581
20582 Show the file for the symbol.
20583
20584 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20585
20586 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
20587 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
20588
20589 @subsubheading Example
20590 N.A.
20591
20592
20593 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
20594 @findex -symbol-info-function
20595
20596 @subsubheading Synopsis
20597
20598 @smallexample
20599 -symbol-info-function
20600 @end smallexample
20601
20602 Show which function the symbol lives in.
20603
20604 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20605
20606 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
20607
20608 @subsubheading Example
20609 N.A.
20610
20611
20612 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
20613 @findex -symbol-info-line
20614
20615 @subsubheading Synopsis
20616
20617 @smallexample
20618 -symbol-info-line
20619 @end smallexample
20620
20621 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
20622
20623 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20624
20625 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
20626 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
20627
20628 @subsubheading Example
20629 N.A.
20630
20631
20632 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
20633 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
20634
20635 @subsubheading Synopsis
20636
20637 @smallexample
20638 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
20639 @end smallexample
20640
20641 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
20642
20643 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20644
20645 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
20646
20647 @subsubheading Example
20648 N.A.
20649
20650
20651 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
20652 @findex -symbol-list-functions
20653
20654 @subsubheading Synopsis
20655
20656 @smallexample
20657 -symbol-list-functions
20658 @end smallexample
20659
20660 List the functions in the executable.
20661
20662 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20663
20664 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
20665 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20666
20667 @subsubheading Example
20668 N.A.
20669
20670
20671 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
20672 @findex -symbol-list-lines
20673
20674 @subsubheading Synopsis
20675
20676 @smallexample
20677 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
20678 @end smallexample
20679
20680 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
20681 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
20682 ascending PC order.
20683
20684 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20685
20686 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
20687
20688 @subsubheading Example
20689 @smallexample
20690 (gdb)
20691 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
20692 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
20693 (gdb)
20694 @end smallexample
20695
20696
20697 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
20698 @findex -symbol-list-types
20699
20700 @subsubheading Synopsis
20701
20702 @smallexample
20703 -symbol-list-types
20704 @end smallexample
20705
20706 List all the type names.
20707
20708 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20709
20710 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
20711 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20712
20713 @subsubheading Example
20714 N.A.
20715
20716
20717 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
20718 @findex -symbol-list-variables
20719
20720 @subsubheading Synopsis
20721
20722 @smallexample
20723 -symbol-list-variables
20724 @end smallexample
20725
20726 List all the global and static variable names.
20727
20728 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20729
20730 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20731
20732 @subsubheading Example
20733 N.A.
20734
20735
20736 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
20737 @findex -symbol-locate
20738
20739 @subsubheading Synopsis
20740
20741 @smallexample
20742 -symbol-locate
20743 @end smallexample
20744
20745 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20746
20747 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
20748
20749 @subsubheading Example
20750 N.A.
20751
20752
20753 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
20754 @findex -symbol-type
20755
20756 @subsubheading Synopsis
20757
20758 @smallexample
20759 -symbol-type @var{variable}
20760 @end smallexample
20761
20762 Show type of @var{variable}.
20763
20764 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20765
20766 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
20767 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
20768
20769 @subsubheading Example
20770 N.A.
20771
20772
20773 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20774 @node GDB/MI File Commands
20775 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
20776
20777 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
20778 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
20779
20780 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
20781 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
20782
20783 @subsubheading Synopsis
20784
20785 @smallexample
20786 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
20787 @end smallexample
20788
20789 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
20790 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
20791 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
20792 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
20793 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
20794 notification.
20795
20796 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20797
20798 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
20799
20800 @subsubheading Example
20801
20802 @smallexample
20803 (gdb)
20804 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20805 ^done
20806 (gdb)
20807 @end smallexample
20808
20809
20810 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
20811 @findex -file-exec-file
20812
20813 @subsubheading Synopsis
20814
20815 @smallexample
20816 -file-exec-file @var{file}
20817 @end smallexample
20818
20819 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
20820 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
20821 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
20822 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
20823 notification.
20824
20825 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20826
20827 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
20828
20829 @subsubheading Example
20830
20831 @smallexample
20832 (gdb)
20833 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20834 ^done
20835 (gdb)
20836 @end smallexample
20837
20838
20839 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
20840 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
20841
20842 @subsubheading Synopsis
20843
20844 @smallexample
20845 -file-list-exec-sections
20846 @end smallexample
20847
20848 List the sections of the current executable file.
20849
20850 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20851
20852 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
20853 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
20854 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
20855
20856 @subsubheading Example
20857 N.A.
20858
20859
20860 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
20861 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
20862
20863 @subsubheading Synopsis
20864
20865 @smallexample
20866 -file-list-exec-source-file
20867 @end smallexample
20868
20869 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
20870 to the current source file for the current executable.
20871
20872 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20873
20874 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
20875
20876 @subsubheading Example
20877
20878 @smallexample
20879 (gdb)
20880 123-file-list-exec-source-file
20881 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
20882 (gdb)
20883 @end smallexample
20884
20885
20886 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
20887 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
20888
20889 @subsubheading Synopsis
20890
20891 @smallexample
20892 -file-list-exec-source-files
20893 @end smallexample
20894
20895 List the source files for the current executable.
20896
20897 It will always output the filename, but only when GDB can find the absolute
20898 file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
20899
20900 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20901
20902 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
20903 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
20904
20905 @subsubheading Example
20906 @smallexample
20907 (gdb)
20908 -file-list-exec-source-files
20909 ^done,files=[
20910 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
20911 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
20912 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
20913 (gdb)
20914 @end smallexample
20915
20916 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
20917 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
20918
20919 @subsubheading Synopsis
20920
20921 @smallexample
20922 -file-list-shared-libraries
20923 @end smallexample
20924
20925 List the shared libraries in the program.
20926
20927 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20928
20929 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
20930
20931 @subsubheading Example
20932 N.A.
20933
20934
20935 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
20936 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
20937
20938 @subsubheading Synopsis
20939
20940 @smallexample
20941 -file-list-symbol-files
20942 @end smallexample
20943
20944 List symbol files.
20945
20946 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20947
20948 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
20949
20950 @subsubheading Example
20951 N.A.
20952
20953
20954 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
20955 @findex -file-symbol-file
20956
20957 @subsubheading Synopsis
20958
20959 @smallexample
20960 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
20961 @end smallexample
20962
20963 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
20964 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
20965 produced, except for a completion notification.
20966
20967 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20968
20969 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
20970
20971 @subsubheading Example
20972
20973 @smallexample
20974 (gdb)
20975 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20976 ^done
20977 (gdb)
20978 @end smallexample
20979
20980 @ignore
20981 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20982 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
20983 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
20984
20985 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
20986
20987 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
20988
20989 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
20990
20991 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
20992
20993 @c @subheading -overlay-map
20994
20995 @c @subheading -overlay-off
20996
20997 @c @subheading -overlay-on
20998
20999 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
21000
21001 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21002 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
21003 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
21004
21005 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
21006
21007 @c @subheading -signal-handle
21008
21009 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
21010
21011 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
21012 @end ignore
21013
21014
21015 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21016 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
21017 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
21018
21019
21020 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
21021 @findex -target-attach
21022
21023 @subsubheading Synopsis
21024
21025 @smallexample
21026 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
21027 @end smallexample
21028
21029 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
21030
21031 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
21032
21033 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
21034
21035 @subsubheading Example
21036 N.A.
21037
21038
21039 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
21040 @findex -target-compare-sections
21041
21042 @subsubheading Synopsis
21043
21044 @smallexample
21045 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
21046 @end smallexample
21047
21048 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
21049 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
21050
21051 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21052
21053 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
21054
21055 @subsubheading Example
21056 N.A.
21057
21058
21059 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
21060 @findex -target-detach
21061
21062 @subsubheading Synopsis
21063
21064 @smallexample
21065 -target-detach
21066 @end smallexample
21067
21068 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
21069 There's no output.
21070
21071 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
21072
21073 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
21074
21075 @subsubheading Example
21076
21077 @smallexample
21078 (gdb)
21079 -target-detach
21080 ^done
21081 (gdb)
21082 @end smallexample
21083
21084
21085 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
21086 @findex -target-disconnect
21087
21088 @subsubheading Synopsis
21089
21090 @smallexample
21091 -target-disconnect
21092 @end smallexample
21093
21094 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
21095 generally not resumed.
21096
21097 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
21098
21099 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
21100
21101 @subsubheading Example
21102
21103 @smallexample
21104 (gdb)
21105 -target-disconnect
21106 ^done
21107 (gdb)
21108 @end smallexample
21109
21110
21111 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
21112 @findex -target-download
21113
21114 @subsubheading Synopsis
21115
21116 @smallexample
21117 -target-download
21118 @end smallexample
21119
21120 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
21121 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
21122
21123 @table @samp
21124 @item section
21125 The name of the section.
21126 @item section-sent
21127 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
21128 @item section-size
21129 The size of the section.
21130 @item total-sent
21131 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
21132 @item total-size
21133 The size of the overall executable to download.
21134 @end table
21135
21136 @noindent
21137 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
21138 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
21139
21140 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
21141 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
21142
21143 @table @samp
21144 @item section
21145 The name of the section.
21146 @item section-size
21147 The size of the section.
21148 @item total-size
21149 The size of the overall executable to download.
21150 @end table
21151
21152 @noindent
21153 At the end, a summary is printed.
21154
21155 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21156
21157 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
21158
21159 @subsubheading Example
21160
21161 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
21162 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
21163
21164 @smallexample
21165 (gdb)
21166 -target-download
21167 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
21168 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
21169 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
21170 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
21171 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
21172 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
21173 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
21174 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
21175 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
21176 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
21177 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
21178 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
21179 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
21180 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
21181 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
21182 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
21183 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
21184 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
21185 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
21186 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
21187 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
21188 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
21189 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
21190 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
21191 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
21192 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
21193 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
21194 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21195 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21196 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
21197 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
21198 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
21199 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
21200 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
21201 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
21202 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
21203 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
21204 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
21205 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
21206 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
21207 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
21208 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
21209 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
21210 write-rate="429"
21211 (gdb)
21212 @end smallexample
21213
21214
21215 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
21216 @findex -target-exec-status
21217
21218 @subsubheading Synopsis
21219
21220 @smallexample
21221 -target-exec-status
21222 @end smallexample
21223
21224 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
21225 not, for instance).
21226
21227 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21228
21229 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
21230
21231 @subsubheading Example
21232 N.A.
21233
21234
21235 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
21236 @findex -target-list-available-targets
21237
21238 @subsubheading Synopsis
21239
21240 @smallexample
21241 -target-list-available-targets
21242 @end smallexample
21243
21244 List the possible targets to connect to.
21245
21246 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21247
21248 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
21249
21250 @subsubheading Example
21251 N.A.
21252
21253
21254 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
21255 @findex -target-list-current-targets
21256
21257 @subsubheading Synopsis
21258
21259 @smallexample
21260 -target-list-current-targets
21261 @end smallexample
21262
21263 Describe the current target.
21264
21265 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21266
21267 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
21268 other things).
21269
21270 @subsubheading Example
21271 N.A.
21272
21273
21274 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
21275 @findex -target-list-parameters
21276
21277 @subsubheading Synopsis
21278
21279 @smallexample
21280 -target-list-parameters
21281 @end smallexample
21282
21283 @c ????
21284
21285 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21286
21287 No equivalent.
21288
21289 @subsubheading Example
21290 N.A.
21291
21292
21293 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
21294 @findex -target-select
21295
21296 @subsubheading Synopsis
21297
21298 @smallexample
21299 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
21300 @end smallexample
21301
21302 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
21303
21304 @table @samp
21305 @item @var{type}
21306 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
21307 @item @var{parameters}
21308 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
21309 Commands for managing targets}, for more details.
21310 @end table
21311
21312 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
21313 which the target program is, in the following form:
21314
21315 @smallexample
21316 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
21317 args=[@var{arg list}]
21318 @end smallexample
21319
21320 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21321
21322 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
21323
21324 @subsubheading Example
21325
21326 @smallexample
21327 (gdb)
21328 -target-select async /dev/ttya
21329 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
21330 (gdb)
21331 @end smallexample
21332
21333 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21334 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
21335 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
21336
21337 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
21338
21339 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
21340 @findex -gdb-exit
21341
21342 @subsubheading Synopsis
21343
21344 @smallexample
21345 -gdb-exit
21346 @end smallexample
21347
21348 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
21349
21350 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21351
21352 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
21353
21354 @subsubheading Example
21355
21356 @smallexample
21357 (gdb)
21358 -gdb-exit
21359 ^exit
21360 @end smallexample
21361
21362
21363 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
21364 @findex -exec-abort
21365
21366 @subsubheading Synopsis
21367
21368 @smallexample
21369 -exec-abort
21370 @end smallexample
21371
21372 Kill the inferior running program.
21373
21374 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21375
21376 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
21377
21378 @subsubheading Example
21379 N.A.
21380
21381
21382 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
21383 @findex -gdb-set
21384
21385 @subsubheading Synopsis
21386
21387 @smallexample
21388 -gdb-set
21389 @end smallexample
21390
21391 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
21392 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
21393
21394 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21395
21396 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
21397
21398 @subsubheading Example
21399
21400 @smallexample
21401 (gdb)
21402 -gdb-set $foo=3
21403 ^done
21404 (gdb)
21405 @end smallexample
21406
21407
21408 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
21409 @findex -gdb-show
21410
21411 @subsubheading Synopsis
21412
21413 @smallexample
21414 -gdb-show
21415 @end smallexample
21416
21417 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
21418
21419 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
21420
21421 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
21422
21423 @subsubheading Example
21424
21425 @smallexample
21426 (gdb)
21427 -gdb-show annotate
21428 ^done,value="0"
21429 (gdb)
21430 @end smallexample
21431
21432 @c @subheading -gdb-source
21433
21434
21435 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
21436 @findex -gdb-version
21437
21438 @subsubheading Synopsis
21439
21440 @smallexample
21441 -gdb-version
21442 @end smallexample
21443
21444 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
21445
21446 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21447
21448 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
21449 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
21450
21451 @subsubheading Example
21452
21453 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
21454 @c box in TeX.
21455 @smallexample
21456 (gdb)
21457 -gdb-version
21458 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
21459 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21460 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
21461 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
21462 ~ certain conditions.
21463 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21464 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
21465 ~ details.
21466 ~This GDB was configured as
21467 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
21468 ^done
21469 (gdb)
21470 @end smallexample
21471
21472 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
21473 @findex -interpreter-exec
21474
21475 @subheading Synopsis
21476
21477 @smallexample
21478 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
21479 @end smallexample
21480 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
21481
21482 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
21483
21484 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21485
21486 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
21487
21488 @subheading Example
21489
21490 @smallexample
21491 (gdb)
21492 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
21493 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
21494 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
21495 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
21496 ^done
21497 (gdb)
21498 @end smallexample
21499
21500 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
21501 @findex -inferior-tty-set
21502
21503 @subheading Synopsis
21504
21505 @smallexample
21506 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21507 @end smallexample
21508
21509 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
21510
21511 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21512
21513 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
21514
21515 @subheading Example
21516
21517 @smallexample
21518 (gdb)
21519 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21520 ^done
21521 (gdb)
21522 @end smallexample
21523
21524 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
21525 @findex -inferior-tty-show
21526
21527 @subheading Synopsis
21528
21529 @smallexample
21530 -inferior-tty-show
21531 @end smallexample
21532
21533 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
21534
21535 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21536
21537 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
21538
21539 @subheading Example
21540
21541 @smallexample
21542 (gdb)
21543 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21544 ^done
21545 (gdb)
21546 -inferior-tty-show
21547 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
21548 (gdb)
21549 @end smallexample
21550
21551 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
21552 @findex -enable-timings
21553
21554 @subheading Synopsis
21555
21556 @smallexample
21557 -enable-timings [yes | no]
21558 @end smallexample
21559
21560 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
21561 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
21562 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
21563 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
21564
21565 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21566
21567 No equivalent.
21568
21569 @subheading Example
21570
21571 @smallexample
21572 (gdb)
21573 -enable-timings
21574 ^done
21575 (gdb)
21576 -break-insert main
21577 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21578 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
21579 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
21580 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
21581 (gdb)
21582 -enable-timings no
21583 ^done
21584 (gdb)
21585 -exec-run
21586 ^running
21587 (gdb)
21588 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
21589 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
21590 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
21591 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
21592 (gdb)
21593 @end smallexample
21594
21595 @node Annotations
21596 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
21597
21598 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
21599 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
21600 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
21601 relatively high level.
21602
21603 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
21604 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
21605
21606 @ignore
21607 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
21608 @end ignore
21609
21610 @menu
21611 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
21612 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
21613 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
21614 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
21615 * Annotations for Running::
21616 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
21617 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
21618 @end menu
21619
21620 @node Annotations Overview
21621 @section What is an Annotation?
21622 @cindex annotations
21623
21624 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
21625 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
21626 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
21627 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
21628 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
21629 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
21630 cannot contain newline characters.
21631
21632 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
21633 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
21634 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
21635 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
21636 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
21637 means those three characters as output.
21638
21639 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
21640 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
21641 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
21642 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
21643 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
21644 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
21645 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
21646 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
21647 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
21648
21649 @table @code
21650 @kindex set annotate
21651 @item set annotate @var{level}
21652 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
21653 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
21654
21655 @item show annotate
21656 @kindex show annotate
21657 Show the current annotation level.
21658 @end table
21659
21660 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
21661
21662 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
21663
21664 @smallexample
21665 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
21666 GNU gdb 6.0
21667 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21668 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
21669 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
21670 under certain conditions.
21671 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21672 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
21673 for details.
21674 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
21675
21676 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21677 (@value{GDBP})
21678 ^Z^Zprompt
21679 @kbd{quit}
21680
21681 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21682 $
21683 @end smallexample
21684
21685 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
21686 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
21687 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
21688 output from @value{GDBN}.
21689
21690 @node Prompting
21691 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
21692
21693 @cindex annotations for prompts
21694 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
21695 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
21696 over, etc.
21697
21698 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
21699 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
21700 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
21701 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
21702 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
21703 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
21704 features the following annotations:
21705
21706 @smallexample
21707 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21708 ^Z^Zprompt
21709 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21710 @end smallexample
21711
21712 The input types are
21713
21714 @table @code
21715 @findex pre-prompt annotation
21716 @findex prompt annotation
21717 @findex post-prompt annotation
21718 @item prompt
21719 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
21720
21721 @findex pre-commands annotation
21722 @findex commands annotation
21723 @findex post-commands annotation
21724 @item commands
21725 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
21726 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
21727
21728 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
21729 @findex overload-choice annotation
21730 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
21731 @item overload-choice
21732 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
21733
21734 @findex pre-query annotation
21735 @findex query annotation
21736 @findex post-query annotation
21737 @item query
21738 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
21739
21740 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
21741 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
21742 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
21743 @item prompt-for-continue
21744 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
21745 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
21746 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
21747 presence of annotations.
21748 @end table
21749
21750 @node Errors
21751 @section Errors
21752 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
21753
21754 @findex quit annotation
21755 @smallexample
21756 ^Z^Zquit
21757 @end smallexample
21758
21759 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
21760
21761 @findex error annotation
21762 @smallexample
21763 ^Z^Zerror
21764 @end smallexample
21765
21766 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
21767
21768 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
21769 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
21770 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
21771 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
21772 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
21773 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
21774 to the top level.
21775
21776 @findex error-begin annotation
21777 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
21778
21779 @smallexample
21780 ^Z^Zerror-begin
21781 @end smallexample
21782
21783 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
21784 message.
21785
21786 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
21787 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
21788 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
21789
21790 @node Invalidation
21791 @section Invalidation Notices
21792
21793 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
21794 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
21795 changed.
21796
21797 @table @code
21798 @findex frames-invalid annotation
21799 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
21800
21801 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
21802 have changed.
21803
21804 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
21805 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
21806
21807 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
21808 deleted a breakpoint.
21809 @end table
21810
21811 @node Annotations for Running
21812 @section Running the Program
21813 @cindex annotations for running programs
21814
21815 @findex starting annotation
21816 @findex stopping annotation
21817 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
21818 @code{step} or @code{continue},
21819
21820 @smallexample
21821 ^Z^Zstarting
21822 @end smallexample
21823
21824 is output. When the program stops,
21825
21826 @smallexample
21827 ^Z^Zstopped
21828 @end smallexample
21829
21830 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
21831 annotations describe how the program stopped.
21832
21833 @table @code
21834 @findex exited annotation
21835 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
21836 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
21837 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
21838
21839 @findex signalled annotation
21840 @findex signal-name annotation
21841 @findex signal-name-end annotation
21842 @findex signal-string annotation
21843 @findex signal-string-end annotation
21844 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
21845 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
21846 annotation continues:
21847
21848 @smallexample
21849 @var{intro-text}
21850 ^Z^Zsignal-name
21851 @var{name}
21852 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
21853 @var{middle-text}
21854 ^Z^Zsignal-string
21855 @var{string}
21856 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
21857 @var{end-text}
21858 @end smallexample
21859
21860 @noindent
21861 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
21862 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
21863 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
21864 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
21865 user's benefit and have no particular format.
21866
21867 @findex signal annotation
21868 @item ^Z^Zsignal
21869 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
21870 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
21871 terminated with it.
21872
21873 @findex breakpoint annotation
21874 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
21875 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
21876
21877 @findex watchpoint annotation
21878 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
21879 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
21880 @end table
21881
21882 @node Source Annotations
21883 @section Displaying Source
21884 @cindex annotations for source display
21885
21886 @findex source annotation
21887 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
21888
21889 @smallexample
21890 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
21891 @end smallexample
21892
21893 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
21894 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
21895 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
21896 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
21897 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
21898 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
21899 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
21900 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
21901 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
21902 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
21903 depend on the language).
21904
21905 @node GDB Bugs
21906 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
21907 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
21908 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
21909
21910 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
21911
21912 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
21913 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
21914 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
21915 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
21916
21917 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
21918 information that enables us to fix the bug.
21919
21920 @menu
21921 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
21922 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
21923 @end menu
21924
21925 @node Bug Criteria
21926 @section Have you found a bug?
21927 @cindex bug criteria
21928
21929 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
21930
21931 @itemize @bullet
21932 @cindex fatal signal
21933 @cindex debugger crash
21934 @cindex crash of debugger
21935 @item
21936 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
21937 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
21938
21939 @cindex error on valid input
21940 @item
21941 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
21942 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
21943 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
21944
21945 @cindex invalid input
21946 @item
21947 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
21948 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
21949 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
21950 for traditional practice''.
21951
21952 @item
21953 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
21954 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
21955 @end itemize
21956
21957 @node Bug Reporting
21958 @section How to report bugs
21959 @cindex bug reports
21960 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
21961
21962 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
21963 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
21964 contact that organization first.
21965
21966 You can find contact information for many support companies and
21967 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
21968 distribution.
21969 @c should add a web page ref...
21970
21971 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
21972 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
21973 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
21974 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
21975 be used.
21976
21977 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
21978 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
21979 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
21980 @samp{bug-gdb}.
21981
21982 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
21983 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
21984 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
21985 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
21986 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
21987 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
21988 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
21989 bug reports to the mailing list.
21990
21991 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
21992 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
21993 fact or leave it out, state it!
21994
21995 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
21996 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
21997 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
21998 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
21999 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
22000 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
22001 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
22002 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
22003 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
22004
22005 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
22006 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
22007 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
22008 self-contained.
22009
22010 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
22011 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
22012 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
22013 bugs properly.
22014
22015 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
22016
22017 @itemize @bullet
22018 @item
22019 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
22020 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
22021 version}.
22022
22023 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
22024 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
22025
22026 @item
22027 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
22028 version number.
22029
22030 @item
22031 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
22032 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
22033
22034 @item
22035 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
22036 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
22037 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{gcc --version} to get this
22038 information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
22039 compilers.
22040
22041 @item
22042 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
22043 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
22044 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
22045 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
22046
22047 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
22048 and then we might not encounter the bug.
22049
22050 @item
22051 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
22052 reproduce the bug.
22053
22054 @item
22055 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
22056 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
22057
22058 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
22059 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
22060 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
22061 a chance to make a mistake.
22062
22063 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
22064 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
22065 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
22066 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
22067 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
22068 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
22069 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
22070 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
22071
22072 @pindex script
22073 @cindex recording a session script
22074 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
22075 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
22076 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
22077 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
22078
22079 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
22080 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
22081
22082 @item
22083 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
22084 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
22085 it by context, not by line number.
22086
22087 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
22088 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
22089
22090 @end itemize
22091
22092 Here are some things that are not necessary:
22093
22094 @itemize @bullet
22095 @item
22096 A description of the envelope of the bug.
22097
22098 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
22099 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
22100 changes will not affect it.
22101
22102 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
22103 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
22104 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
22105 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
22106
22107 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
22108 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
22109 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
22110 less time, and so on.
22111
22112 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
22113 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
22114
22115 @item
22116 A patch for the bug.
22117
22118 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
22119 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
22120 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
22121 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
22122
22123 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
22124 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
22125 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
22126 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
22127
22128 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
22129 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
22130 help us to understand.
22131
22132 @item
22133 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
22134
22135 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
22136 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
22137 @end itemize
22138
22139 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
22140 @c and consists of the two following files:
22141 @c rluser.texinfo
22142 @c inc-hist.texinfo
22143 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
22144 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
22145 @include rluser.texi
22146 @include inc-hist.texinfo
22147
22148
22149 @node Formatting Documentation
22150 @appendix Formatting Documentation
22151
22152 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
22153 @cindex reference card
22154 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
22155 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
22156 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
22157 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
22158 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
22159 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
22160
22161 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
22162 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
22163
22164 @smallexample
22165 make refcard.dvi
22166 @end smallexample
22167
22168 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
22169 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
22170 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
22171 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
22172 your @sc{dvi} output program.
22173
22174 @cindex documentation
22175
22176 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
22177 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
22178 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
22179 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
22180 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
22181 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
22182
22183 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
22184 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
22185 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
22186 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
22187 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
22188 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
22189 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
22190 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
22191
22192 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
22193 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
22194 @code{makeinfo}.
22195
22196 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
22197 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
22198 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
22199
22200 @smallexample
22201 cd gdb
22202 make gdb.info
22203 @end smallexample
22204
22205 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
22206 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
22207 Texinfo definitions file.
22208
22209 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
22210 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
22211 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
22212 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
22213 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
22214 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
22215 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
22216
22217 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
22218 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
22219 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
22220 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
22221 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
22222 directory.
22223
22224 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
22225 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
22226 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
22227 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
22228
22229 @smallexample
22230 make gdb.dvi
22231 @end smallexample
22232
22233 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
22234
22235 @node Installing GDB
22236 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
22237 @cindex installation
22238
22239 @menu
22240 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
22241 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @code{configure} script
22242 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22243 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
22244 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
22245 @end menu
22246
22247 @node Requirements
22248 @section Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
22249 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
22250
22251 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
22252 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
22253
22254 @heading Tools/packages necessary for building @value{GDBN}
22255 @table @asis
22256 @item ISO C90 compiler
22257 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
22258 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
22259
22260 @end table
22261
22262 @heading Tools/packages optional for building @value{GDBN}
22263 @table @asis
22264 @item Expat
22265 @anchor{Expat}
22266 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
22267 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
22268 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
22269 The @code{configure} script will search for this library in several
22270 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
22271 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
22272
22273 Expat is used for remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory map format})
22274 and for target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions}).
22275
22276 @end table
22277
22278 @node Running Configure
22279 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @code{configure} script
22280 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
22281 @value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
22282 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
22283 build the @code{gdb} program.
22284 @iftex
22285 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
22286 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
22287 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
22288 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
22289 @end iftex
22290
22291 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
22292 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
22293 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
22294
22295 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
22296 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
22297
22298 @table @code
22299 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
22300 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
22301
22302 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
22303 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
22304
22305 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
22306 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
22307
22308 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
22309 @sc{gnu} include files
22310
22311 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
22312 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
22313
22314 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
22315 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
22316
22317 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
22318 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
22319
22320 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
22321 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
22322
22323 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
22324 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
22325 @end table
22326
22327 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
22328 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
22329 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
22330
22331 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
22332 if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
22333 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
22334 argument.
22335
22336 For example:
22337
22338 @smallexample
22339 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22340 ./configure @var{host}
22341 make
22342 @end smallexample
22343
22344 @noindent
22345 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
22346 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
22347 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
22348 correct value by examining your system.)
22349
22350 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
22351 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
22352 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
22353 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
22354
22355 @need 750
22356 @code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
22357 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
22358 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
22359
22360 @smallexample
22361 sh configure @var{host}
22362 @end smallexample
22363
22364 If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
22365 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
22366 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
22367 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
22368 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
22369
22370 You should run the @code{configure} script from the top directory in the
22371 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
22372 @code{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
22373 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
22374 if you run the first @code{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
22375 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
22376 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
22377 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
22378 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22379
22380 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
22381 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
22382 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
22383 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
22384 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
22385
22386 @node Separate Objdir
22387 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22388
22389 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
22390 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
22391 host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
22392 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
22393 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
22394 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
22395 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
22396 program specified there.
22397
22398 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
22399 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
22400 (You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
22401 itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
22402 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
22403 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
22404
22405 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
22406 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
22407
22408 @smallexample
22409 @group
22410 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22411 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
22412 cd ../gdb-sun4
22413 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
22414 make
22415 @end group
22416 @end smallexample
22417
22418 When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
22419 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
22420 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
22421 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
22422 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
22423 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
22424
22425 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
22426 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
22427 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
22428 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
22429 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22430
22431 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
22432 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
22433 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
22434 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
22435 You specify a cross-debugging target by
22436 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
22437
22438 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
22439 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
22440 called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
22441
22442 The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
22443 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
22444 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
22445 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
22446 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
22447
22448 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
22449 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
22450 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
22451 with each other.
22452
22453 @node Config Names
22454 @section Specifying names for hosts and targets
22455
22456 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
22457 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
22458 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
22459 of information in the following pattern:
22460
22461 @smallexample
22462 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
22463 @end smallexample
22464
22465 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
22466 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
22467 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
22468
22469 The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
22470 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
22471 aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
22472 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
22473 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
22474 abbreviations---for example:
22475
22476 @smallexample
22477 % sh config.sub i386-linux
22478 i386-pc-linux-gnu
22479 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
22480 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
22481 % sh config.sub hp9k700
22482 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
22483 % sh config.sub sun4
22484 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
22485 % sh config.sub sun3
22486 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
22487 % sh config.sub i986v
22488 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
22489 @end smallexample
22490
22491 @noindent
22492 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
22493 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
22494
22495 @node Configure Options
22496 @section @code{configure} options
22497
22498 Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
22499 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
22500 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
22501 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
22502
22503 @smallexample
22504 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
22505 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22506 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22507 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
22508 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
22509 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
22510 @var{host}
22511 @end smallexample
22512
22513 @noindent
22514 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
22515 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
22516 @samp{--}.
22517
22518 @table @code
22519 @item --help
22520 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
22521
22522 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
22523 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
22524 @file{@var{dir}}.
22525
22526 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
22527 Configure the source to install programs under directory
22528 @file{@var{dir}}.
22529
22530 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
22531 @need 2000
22532 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
22533 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
22534 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
22535 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
22536 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
22537 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
22538 directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
22539 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
22540 directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
22541 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
22542 @var{dirname}.
22543
22544 @item --norecursion
22545 Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
22546 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
22547
22548 @item --target=@var{target}
22549 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
22550 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
22551 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
22552
22553 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
22554
22555 @item @var{host} @dots{}
22556 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
22557
22558 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
22559 @end table
22560
22561 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
22562 needed for special purposes only.
22563
22564 @node Maintenance Commands
22565 @appendix Maintenance Commands
22566 @cindex maintenance commands
22567 @cindex internal commands
22568
22569 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
22570 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
22571 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
22572 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
22573 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
22574
22575 @table @code
22576 @kindex maint agent
22577 @item maint agent @var{expression}
22578 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
22579 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
22580 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
22581
22582 @kindex maint info breakpoints
22583 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
22584 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
22585 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
22586 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
22587 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
22588 is shown:
22589
22590 @table @code
22591 @item breakpoint
22592 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
22593
22594 @item watchpoint
22595 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
22596
22597 @item longjmp
22598 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
22599 @code{longjmp} calls.
22600
22601 @item longjmp resume
22602 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
22603
22604 @item until
22605 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
22606
22607 @item finish
22608 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
22609
22610 @item shlib events
22611 Shared library events.
22612
22613 @end table
22614
22615 @kindex maint check-symtabs
22616 @item maint check-symtabs
22617 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
22618
22619 @kindex maint cplus first_component
22620 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
22621 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
22622
22623 @kindex maint cplus namespace
22624 @item maint cplus namespace
22625 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
22626
22627 @kindex maint demangle
22628 @item maint demangle @var{name}
22629 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
22630
22631 @kindex maint deprecate
22632 @kindex maint undeprecate
22633 @cindex deprecated commands
22634 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
22635 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
22636 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
22637 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
22638 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
22639 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
22640 the replacement as part of the warning.
22641
22642 @kindex maint dump-me
22643 @item maint dump-me
22644 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
22645 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
22646 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
22647 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
22648
22649 @kindex maint internal-error
22650 @kindex maint internal-warning
22651 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22652 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22653 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
22654 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
22655 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
22656 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
22657 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
22658 @value{GDBN} session.
22659
22660 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
22661 used as the text of the error or warning message.
22662
22663 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
22664
22665 @smallexample
22666 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
22667 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
22668 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
22669 debugging may prove unreliable.
22670 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22671 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22672 (@value{GDBP})
22673 @end smallexample
22674
22675 @kindex maint packet
22676 @item maint packet @var{text}
22677 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
22678 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
22679 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
22680 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
22681 checksum.
22682
22683 @kindex maint print architecture
22684 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22685 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
22686 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
22687
22688 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
22689 @item maint print dummy-frames
22690 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
22691
22692 @smallexample
22693 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
22694 @dots{}
22695 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
22696 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
22697 58 return (a + b);
22698 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
22699 @dots{}
22700 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
22701 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
22702 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
22703 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
22704 (@value{GDBP})
22705 @end smallexample
22706
22707 Takes an optional file parameter.
22708
22709 @kindex maint print registers
22710 @kindex maint print raw-registers
22711 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
22712 @kindex maint print register-groups
22713 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22714 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22715 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22716 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22717 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
22718
22719 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
22720 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
22721 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
22722 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
22723 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
22724 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
22725
22726 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
22727 write the information.
22728
22729 @kindex maint print reggroups
22730 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22731 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
22732 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
22733 information.
22734
22735 The register groups info looks like this:
22736
22737 @smallexample
22738 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
22739 Group Type
22740 general user
22741 float user
22742 all user
22743 vector user
22744 system user
22745 save internal
22746 restore internal
22747 @end smallexample
22748
22749 @kindex flushregs
22750 @item flushregs
22751 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
22752
22753 @kindex maint print objfiles
22754 @cindex info for known object files
22755 @item maint print objfiles
22756 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
22757 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
22758 and symtabs.
22759
22760 @kindex maint print statistics
22761 @cindex bcache statistics
22762 @item maint print statistics
22763 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
22764 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
22765 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
22766 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
22767 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
22768 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
22769 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
22770 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
22771 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
22772 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
22773 lengths.
22774
22775 @kindex maint print target-stack
22776 @cindex target stack description
22777 @item maint print target-stack
22778 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
22779 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
22780 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
22781 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
22782 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
22783 address.
22784
22785 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
22786 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
22787
22788 @kindex maint print type
22789 @cindex type chain of a data type
22790 @item maint print type @var{expr}
22791 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
22792 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
22793 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
22794 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
22795 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
22796
22797 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22798 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22799 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22800 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22801 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
22802
22803 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
22804 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
22805 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
22806 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
22807 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
22808 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
22809 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
22810 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
22811 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
22812
22813 @kindex maint set profile
22814 @kindex maint show profile
22815 @cindex profiling GDB
22816 @item maint set profile
22817 @itemx maint show profile
22818 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
22819
22820 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
22821 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
22822 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
22823 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
22824 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
22825 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
22826 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
22827
22828 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
22829 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
22830
22831 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
22832 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
22833 @item maint show-debug-regs
22834 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
22835 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
22836 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when GDB inserts or
22837 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
22838 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
22839
22840 @kindex maint space
22841 @cindex memory used by commands
22842 @item maint space
22843 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
22844 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
22845 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
22846 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
22847 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22848
22849 @kindex maint time
22850 @cindex time of command execution
22851 @item maint time
22852 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
22853 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
22854 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
22855 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
22856 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22857
22858 @kindex maint translate-address
22859 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
22860 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
22861 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
22862 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
22863 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
22864 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
22865 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
22866
22867 @end table
22868
22869 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
22870 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
22871
22872 @table @code
22873 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
22874 @kindex set watchdog
22875 @cindex watchdog timer
22876 @cindex timeout for commands
22877 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
22878 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
22879 reports and error and the command is aborted.
22880
22881 @item show watchdog
22882 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
22883 @end table
22884
22885 @node Remote Protocol
22886 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
22887
22888 @menu
22889 * Overview::
22890 * Packets::
22891 * Stop Reply Packets::
22892 * General Query Packets::
22893 * Register Packet Format::
22894 * Tracepoint Packets::
22895 * Interrupts::
22896 * Examples::
22897 * File-I/O remote protocol extension::
22898 * Memory map format::
22899 @end menu
22900
22901 @node Overview
22902 @section Overview
22903
22904 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
22905 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
22906 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
22907 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
22908
22909 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
22910 transmitted and received data respectfully.
22911
22912 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
22913 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
22914 @cindex remote serial protocol
22915 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
22916 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
22917 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
22918 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
22919
22920 @smallexample
22921 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22922 @end smallexample
22923 @noindent
22924
22925 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
22926 @noindent
22927 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
22928 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
22929 eight bit unsigned checksum).
22930
22931 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
22932 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
22933
22934 @smallexample
22935 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22936 @end smallexample
22937
22938 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
22939 @noindent
22940 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
22941 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
22942 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
22943
22944 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
22945 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
22946 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
22947 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
22948 retransmission):
22949
22950 @smallexample
22951 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22952 <- @code{+}
22953 @end smallexample
22954 @noindent
22955
22956 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
22957 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
22958 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
22959 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
22960
22961 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
22962 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
22963 exceptions).
22964
22965 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
22966 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
22967 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
22968 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
22969
22970 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
22971 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
22972 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
22973
22974 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
22975 @anchor{Binary Data}
22976 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
22977 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
22978 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
22979 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
22980 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
22981 binary data.
22982
22983 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
22984 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
22985 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
22986 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
22987 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
22988 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
22989 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
22990 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
22991 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
22992 (described next).
22993
22994 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
22995 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
22996 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
22997 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
22998 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
22999 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
23000 value greater than 126 should not be used.
23001
23002 So:
23003 @smallexample
23004 "@code{0* }"
23005 @end smallexample
23006 @noindent
23007 means the same as "0000".
23008
23009 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
23010 error number. That number is not well defined.
23011
23012 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
23013 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
23014 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
23015 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
23016 on that response.
23017
23018 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
23019 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
23020 optional.
23021
23022 @node Packets
23023 @section Packets
23024
23025 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
23026 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
23027 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for details about the File
23028 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
23029
23030 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
23031 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
23032 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
23033 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
23034 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
23035 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
23036 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
23037 @var{baz}. GDB does not transmit a space character between the
23038 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
23039 @var{baz}.
23040
23041 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
23042 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
23043
23044 Here are the packet descriptions.
23045
23046 @table @samp
23047
23048 @item !
23049 @cindex @samp{!} packet
23050 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
23051 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
23052 debugged.
23053
23054 Reply:
23055 @table @samp
23056 @item OK
23057 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
23058 @end table
23059
23060 @item ?
23061 @cindex @samp{?} packet
23062 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
23063 step and continue.
23064
23065 Reply:
23066 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23067
23068 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
23069 @cindex @samp{A} packet
23070 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
23071 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
23072 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
23073
23074 Reply:
23075 @table @samp
23076 @item OK
23077 The arguments were set.
23078 @item E @var{NN}
23079 An error occurred.
23080 @end table
23081
23082 @item b @var{baud}
23083 @cindex @samp{b} packet
23084 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
23085 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
23086
23087 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
23088 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
23089 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
23090
23091 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
23092 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
23093 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
23094 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
23095 of view, nothing actually happened.}
23096
23097 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
23098 @cindex @samp{B} packet
23099 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
23100 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
23101
23102 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
23103 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
23104
23105 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23106 @cindex @samp{c} packet
23107 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
23108 resume at current address.
23109
23110 Reply:
23111 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23112
23113 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23114 @cindex @samp{C} packet
23115 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
23116 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
23117
23118 Reply:
23119 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23120
23121 @item d
23122 @cindex @samp{d} packet
23123 Toggle debug flag.
23124
23125 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
23126 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
23127
23128 @item D
23129 @cindex @samp{D} packet
23130 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
23131 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
23132
23133 Reply:
23134 @table @samp
23135 @item OK
23136 for success
23137 @item E @var{NN}
23138 for an error
23139 @end table
23140
23141 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
23142 @cindex @samp{F} packet
23143 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
23144 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
23145 remote protocol extension}, for the specification.
23146
23147 @item g
23148 @anchor{read registers packet}
23149 @cindex @samp{g} packet
23150 Read general registers.
23151
23152 Reply:
23153 @table @samp
23154 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23155 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
23156 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
23157 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
23158 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros
23159 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The
23160 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
23161 @item E @var{NN}
23162 for an error.
23163 @end table
23164
23165 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
23166 @cindex @samp{G} packet
23167 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
23168 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
23169
23170 Reply:
23171 @table @samp
23172 @item OK
23173 for success
23174 @item E @var{NN}
23175 for an error
23176 @end table
23177
23178 @item H @var{c} @var{t}
23179 @cindex @samp{H} packet
23180 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
23181 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
23182 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
23183 operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
23184 the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
23185
23186 Reply:
23187 @table @samp
23188 @item OK
23189 for success
23190 @item E @var{NN}
23191 for an error
23192 @end table
23193
23194 @c FIXME: JTC:
23195 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
23196 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
23197 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
23198 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
23199 @c described. For example:
23200 @c
23201 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23202 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
23203 @c otherwise returns current registers.
23204 @c
23205 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23206 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
23207 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
23208
23209 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
23210 @anchor{cycle step packet}
23211 @cindex @samp{i} packet
23212 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
23213 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
23214 step starting at that address.
23215
23216 @item I
23217 @cindex @samp{I} packet
23218 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
23219 step packet}.
23220
23221 @item k
23222 @cindex @samp{k} packet
23223 Kill request.
23224
23225 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
23226 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
23227 thread?)}.
23228
23229 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
23230 @cindex @samp{m} packet
23231 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23232 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
23233
23234 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
23235 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
23236 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
23237 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
23238 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
23239 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
23240 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
23241 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
23242
23243 Reply:
23244 @table @samp
23245 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23246 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
23247 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
23248 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
23249 @item E @var{NN}
23250 @var{NN} is errno
23251 @end table
23252
23253 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23254 @cindex @samp{M} packet
23255 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23256 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
23257 hexadecimal number.
23258
23259 Reply:
23260 @table @samp
23261 @item OK
23262 for success
23263 @item E @var{NN}
23264 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
23265 written).
23266 @end table
23267
23268 @item p @var{n}
23269 @cindex @samp{p} packet
23270 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
23271 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
23272 register value is encoded.
23273
23274 Reply:
23275 @table @samp
23276 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23277 the register's value
23278 @item E @var{NN}
23279 for an error
23280 @item
23281 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
23282 @end table
23283
23284 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
23285 @anchor{write register packet}
23286 @cindex @samp{P} packet
23287 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
23288 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
23289 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
23290
23291 Reply:
23292 @table @samp
23293 @item OK
23294 for success
23295 @item E @var{NN}
23296 for an error
23297 @end table
23298
23299 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23300 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23301 @cindex @samp{q} packet
23302 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
23303 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
23304 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
23305
23306 @item r
23307 @cindex @samp{r} packet
23308 Reset the entire system.
23309
23310 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
23311
23312 @item R @var{XX}
23313 @cindex @samp{R} packet
23314 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
23315 This packet is only available in extended mode.
23316
23317 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
23318
23319 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23320 @cindex @samp{s} packet
23321 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
23322 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
23323
23324 Reply:
23325 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23326
23327 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23328 @anchor{step with signal packet}
23329 @cindex @samp{S} packet
23330 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
23331 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
23332
23333 Reply:
23334 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23335
23336 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
23337 @cindex @samp{t} packet
23338 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
23339 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
23340 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
23341
23342 @item T @var{XX}
23343 @cindex @samp{T} packet
23344 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
23345
23346 Reply:
23347 @table @samp
23348 @item OK
23349 thread is still alive
23350 @item E @var{NN}
23351 thread is dead
23352 @end table
23353
23354 @item v
23355 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
23356 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
23357
23358 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
23359 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
23360 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
23361 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
23362 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
23363 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
23364 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
23365 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
23366
23367 @table @samp
23368 @item c
23369 Continue.
23370 @item C @var{sig}
23371 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23372 @item s
23373 Step.
23374 @item S @var{sig}
23375 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23376 @end table
23377
23378 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
23379 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
23380
23381 Reply:
23382 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23383
23384 @item vCont?
23385 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
23386 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
23387
23388 Reply:
23389 @table @samp
23390 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
23391 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
23392 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
23393 @item
23394 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
23395 @end table
23396
23397 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
23398 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
23399 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
23400 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
23401 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
23402 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory map
23403 format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
23404 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
23405 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23406 packet is received.
23407
23408 Reply:
23409 @table @samp
23410 @item OK
23411 for success
23412 @item E @var{NN}
23413 for an error
23414 @end table
23415
23416 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23417 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
23418 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
23419 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
23420 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
23421 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
23422 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
23423 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
23424 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
23425 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
23426 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
23427 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
23428
23429
23430 Reply:
23431 @table @samp
23432 @item OK
23433 for success
23434 @item E.memtype
23435 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
23436 @item E @var{NN}
23437 for an error
23438 @end table
23439
23440 @item vFlashDone
23441 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
23442 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
23443 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
23444 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
23445 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
23446 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23447 request is completed.
23448
23449 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23450 @anchor{X packet}
23451 @cindex @samp{X} packet
23452 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
23453 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
23454 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
23455
23456 Reply:
23457 @table @samp
23458 @item OK
23459 for success
23460 @item E @var{NN}
23461 for an error
23462 @end table
23463
23464 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23465 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23466 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
23467 @cindex @samp{z} packet
23468 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
23469 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
23470 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
23471 @var{length} bytes.
23472
23473 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
23474 separately.
23475
23476 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
23477 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
23478 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
23479 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
23480 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
23481 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
23482
23483 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23484 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23485 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
23486 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
23487 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
23488 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23489
23490 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
23491 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
23492 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
23493 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
23494 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
23495
23496 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
23497 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
23498 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
23499 target, is not defined.}
23500
23501 Reply:
23502 @table @samp
23503 @item OK
23504 success
23505 @item
23506 not supported
23507 @item E @var{NN}
23508 for an error
23509 @end table
23510
23511 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23512 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23513 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
23514 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
23515 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
23516 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23517
23518 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
23519 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
23520
23521 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
23522 movement.}
23523
23524 Reply:
23525 @table @samp
23526 @item OK
23527 success
23528 @item
23529 not supported
23530 @item E @var{NN}
23531 for an error
23532 @end table
23533
23534 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23535 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23536 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
23537 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
23538 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
23539
23540 Reply:
23541 @table @samp
23542 @item OK
23543 success
23544 @item
23545 not supported
23546 @item E @var{NN}
23547 for an error
23548 @end table
23549
23550 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23551 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23552 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
23553 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
23554 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
23555
23556 Reply:
23557 @table @samp
23558 @item OK
23559 success
23560 @item
23561 not supported
23562 @item E @var{NN}
23563 for an error
23564 @end table
23565
23566 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23567 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23568 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
23569 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
23570 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
23571
23572 Reply:
23573 @table @samp
23574 @item OK
23575 success
23576 @item
23577 not supported
23578 @item E @var{NN}
23579 for an error
23580 @end table
23581
23582 @end table
23583
23584 @node Stop Reply Packets
23585 @section Stop Reply Packets
23586 @cindex stop reply packets
23587
23588 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
23589 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
23590 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
23591 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
23592 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
23593 @value{GDBN} source code.
23594
23595 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
23596 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
23597 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
23598 components.
23599
23600 @table @samp
23601
23602 @item S @var{AA}
23603 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23604 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
23605 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
23606
23607 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
23608 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
23609 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23610 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
23611 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
23612 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
23613 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
23614 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
23615 @enumerate
23616 @item
23617 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
23618 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
23619 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
23620 two-digit hex number.
23621 @item
23622 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
23623 hex.
23624 @item
23625 If @var{n} is @samp{watch}, @samp{rwatch}, or @samp{awatch}, then the
23626 packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
23627 hex.
23628 @item
23629 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
23630 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
23631 future.
23632 @end enumerate
23633
23634 @item W @var{AA}
23635 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
23636 applicable to certain targets.
23637
23638 @item X @var{AA}
23639 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
23640
23641 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
23642 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
23643 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
23644 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
23645 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
23646
23647 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
23648 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
23649 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
23650 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
23651 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for a list of implemented
23652 system calls.
23653
23654 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
23655 this very system call.
23656
23657 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
23658 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
23659 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
23660 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
23661 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O remote
23662 protocol extension}, for more details.
23663
23664 @end table
23665
23666 @node General Query Packets
23667 @section General Query Packets
23668 @cindex remote query requests
23669
23670 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
23671 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
23672 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
23673 sending information to and from the stub.
23674
23675 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
23676 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
23677 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
23678 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
23679 conventions:
23680
23681 @itemize @bullet
23682 @item
23683 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
23684 @item
23685 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
23686 letter.
23687 @item
23688 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
23689 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
23690 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
23691 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
23692 @end itemize
23693
23694 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
23695 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
23696 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
23697 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
23698 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
23699 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
23700 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
23701 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
23702 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
23703 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
23704 packet.}.
23705
23706 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
23707 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
23708 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
23709 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
23710 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
23711
23712 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
23713
23714 @table @samp
23715
23716 @item qC
23717 @cindex current thread, remote request
23718 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
23719 Return the current thread id.
23720
23721 Reply:
23722 @table @samp
23723 @item QC @var{pid}
23724 Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexadecimal process id.
23725 @item @r{(anything else)}
23726 Any other reply implies the old pid.
23727 @end table
23728
23729 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
23730 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
23731 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
23732 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
23733 Reply:
23734 @table @samp
23735 @item E @var{NN}
23736 An error (such as memory fault)
23737 @item C @var{crc32}
23738 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
23739 @end table
23740
23741 @item qfThreadInfo
23742 @itemx qsThreadInfo
23743 @cindex list active threads, remote request
23744 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
23745 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
23746 Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
23747 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
23748 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
23749 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
23750 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
23751 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
23752
23753 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
23754
23755 Reply:
23756 @table @samp
23757 @item m @var{id}
23758 A single thread id
23759 @item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
23760 a comma-separated list of thread ids
23761 @item l
23762 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
23763 @end table
23764
23765 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
23766 more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
23767 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
23768 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
23769 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
23770
23771 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
23772 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
23773 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
23774 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
23775 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
23776
23777 @var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
23778 thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
23779
23780 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
23781 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
23782 information associated with the variable.)
23783
23784 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI specific encoding of the
23785 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
23786 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
23787 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
23788 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
23789 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
23790
23791 Reply:
23792 @table @samp
23793 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
23794 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
23795 local storage requested.
23796
23797 @item E @var{nn}
23798 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
23799
23800 @item
23801 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
23802 @end table
23803
23804 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
23805 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
23806 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
23807 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
23808 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
23809 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
23810 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
23811
23812 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
23813
23814 Reply:
23815 @table @samp
23816 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
23817 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
23818 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
23819 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
23820 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
23821 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
23822 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
23823 @end table
23824
23825 @item qOffsets
23826 @cindex section offsets, remote request
23827 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
23828 Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
23829 image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
23830 response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
23831 offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
23832
23833 Reply:
23834 @table @samp
23835 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy};Bss=@var{zzz}
23836 @end table
23837
23838 @item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
23839 @cindex thread information, remote request
23840 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
23841 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
23842 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
23843
23844 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
23845 (see below).
23846
23847 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
23848
23849 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
23850 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
23851 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
23852 @anchor{QPassSignals}
23853 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
23854 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
23855 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
23856 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
23857 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
23858 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
23859 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
23860 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
23861 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
23862
23863 Reply:
23864 @table @samp
23865 @item OK
23866 The request succeeded.
23867
23868 @item E @var{nn}
23869 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
23870
23871 @item
23872 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
23873 the stub.
23874 @end table
23875
23876 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
23877 command (@pxref{Remote configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
23878 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23879 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23880
23881 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
23882 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
23883 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
23884 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
23885 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
23886 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
23887 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
23888 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
23889 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
23890
23891 Reply:
23892 @table @samp
23893 @item OK
23894 A command response with no output.
23895 @item @var{OUTPUT}
23896 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
23897 @item E @var{NN}
23898 Indicate a badly formed request.
23899 @item
23900 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
23901 @end table
23902
23903 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
23904 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
23905 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
23906 packets.)
23907
23908 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
23909 @cindex supported packets, remote query
23910 @cindex features of the remote protocol
23911 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
23912 @anchor{qSupported}
23913 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
23914 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
23915 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
23916 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
23917 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
23918 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
23919 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
23920 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
23921 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
23922 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
23923 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
23924 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
23925 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
23926 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
23927
23928 Reply:
23929 @table @samp
23930 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
23931 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
23932 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
23933 possible forms).
23934 @item
23935 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
23936 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
23937 @end table
23938
23939 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
23940 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
23941 are:
23942
23943 @table @samp
23944 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
23945 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
23946 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
23947 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
23948 @item @var{name}+
23949 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
23950 need an associated value.
23951 @item @var{name}-
23952 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
23953 @item @var{name}?
23954 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
23955 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
23956 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
23957 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
23958 @end table
23959
23960 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
23961 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
23962 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
23963 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
23964 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
23965
23966 No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
23967 are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
23968 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
23969 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
23970 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
23971 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
23972 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
23973 improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
23974 responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
23975 the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
23976 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
23977 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
23978 all the features it supports.
23979
23980 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
23981 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
23982
23983 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
23984 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
23985 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
23986 form response.
23987
23988 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
23989 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
23990 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
23991 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
23992
23993 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
23994 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
23995 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
23996 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
23997 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
23998
23999 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
24000
24001 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.2 0.2 0.2
24002 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
24003 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
24004 @item Feature Name
24005 @tab Value Required
24006 @tab Default
24007 @tab Probe Allowed
24008
24009 @item @samp{PacketSize}
24010 @tab Yes
24011 @tab @samp{-}
24012 @tab No
24013
24014 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
24015 @tab No
24016 @tab @samp{-}
24017 @tab Yes
24018
24019 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
24020 @tab No
24021 @tab @samp{-}
24022 @tab Yes
24023
24024 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
24025 @tab No
24026 @tab @samp{-}
24027 @tab Yes
24028
24029 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
24030 @tab No
24031 @tab @samp{-}
24032 @tab Yes
24033
24034 @end multitable
24035
24036 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
24037
24038 @table @samp
24039 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
24040 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
24041 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
24042 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
24043 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
24044 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
24045 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
24046 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
24047 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
24048 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
24049
24050 @item qXfer:auxv:read
24051 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
24052 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
24053
24054 @item qXfer:features:read
24055 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
24056 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
24057
24058 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
24059 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
24060 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
24061
24062 @item QPassSignals
24063 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
24064 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
24065
24066 @end table
24067
24068 @item qSymbol::
24069 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
24070 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
24071 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
24072 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
24073
24074 Reply:
24075 @table @samp
24076 @item OK
24077 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
24078 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
24079 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
24080 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
24081 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
24082 below.
24083 @end table
24084
24085 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
24086 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
24087
24088 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
24089 target has previously requested.
24090
24091 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
24092 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
24093 will be empty.
24094
24095 Reply:
24096 @table @samp
24097 @item OK
24098 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
24099 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
24100 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
24101 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
24102 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
24103 @end table
24104
24105 @item QTDP
24106 @itemx QTFrame
24107 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24108
24109 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
24110 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
24111 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
24112 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
24113 the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
24114 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
24115 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
24116 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
24117 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
24118 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
24119
24120 Reply:
24121 @table @samp
24122 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
24123 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
24124 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
24125 the thread's attributes.
24126 @end table
24127
24128 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
24129 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
24130 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
24131 packets.)
24132
24133 @item QTStart
24134 @itemx QTStop
24135 @itemx QTinit
24136 @itemx QTro
24137 @itemx qTStatus
24138 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24139
24140 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24141 @cindex read special object, remote request
24142 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
24143 @anchor{qXfer read}
24144 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
24145 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
24146 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
24147 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to the object; it can supply
24148 additional details about what data to access.
24149
24150 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
24151 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
24152 formats, listed below.
24153
24154 @table @samp
24155 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
24156 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
24157 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
24158 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
24159
24160 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24161 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24162
24163 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24164 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
24165 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
24166 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
24167 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
24168
24169 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24170 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24171
24172 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
24173 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
24174 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory map format}. The
24175 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
24176 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
24177
24178 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24179 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24180 @end table
24181
24182 Reply:
24183 @table @samp
24184 @item m @var{data}
24185 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
24186 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
24187 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
24188 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
24189 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
24190 request.
24191
24192 @item l @var{data}
24193 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
24194 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
24195 than the @var{length} in the request.
24196
24197 @item l
24198 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
24199 There is no more data to be read.
24200
24201 @item E00
24202 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24203
24204 @item E @var{nn}
24205 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
24206 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24207
24208 @item
24209 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
24210 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
24211 @end table
24212
24213 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
24214 @cindex write data into object, remote request
24215 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
24216 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
24217 into the data. @samp{@var{data}@dots{}} is the binary-encoded data
24218 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
24219 is specific to the object; it can supply additional details about what data
24220 to access.
24221
24222 No requests of this form are presently in use. This specification
24223 serves as a placeholder to document the common format that new
24224 specific request specifications ought to use.
24225
24226 Reply:
24227 @table @samp
24228 @item @var{nn}
24229 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
24230 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
24231
24232 @item E00
24233 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24234
24235 @item E @var{nn}
24236 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
24237 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24238
24239 @item
24240 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
24241 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
24242 @end table
24243
24244 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
24245 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
24246 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
24247 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
24248 must respond with an empty packet.
24249
24250 @end table
24251
24252 @node Register Packet Format
24253 @section Register Packet Format
24254
24255 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
24256 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
24257 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
24258 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
24259 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
24260 most-significant - least-significant.
24261
24262 @table @r
24263
24264 @item MIPS32
24265
24266 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
24267 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
24268 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
24269
24270 @item MIPS64
24271
24272 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
24273 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
24274 as @code{MIPS32}.
24275
24276 @end table
24277
24278 @node Tracepoint Packets
24279 @section Tracepoint Packets
24280 @cindex tracepoint packets
24281 @cindex packets, tracepoint
24282
24283 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
24284 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
24285
24286 @table @samp
24287
24288 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
24289 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
24290 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
24291 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
24292 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
24293 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
24294 tracepoint's actions.
24295
24296 Replies:
24297 @table @samp
24298 @item OK
24299 The packet was understood and carried out.
24300 @item
24301 The packet was not recognized.
24302 @end table
24303
24304 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
24305 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
24306 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
24307 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
24308 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
24309 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
24310 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
24311
24312 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
24313 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
24314 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
24315 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
24316 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
24317 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
24318 tracepoint actions.
24319
24320 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
24321 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
24322 following forms:
24323
24324 @table @samp
24325
24326 @item R @var{mask}
24327 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
24328 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
24329 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
24330 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
24331 not fit in a 32-bit word.
24332
24333 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
24334 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
24335 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
24336 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
24337 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
24338 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
24339 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
24340
24341 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
24342 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
24343 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
24344 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
24345 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
24346 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
24347 packet).
24348
24349 @end table
24350
24351 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
24352 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
24353 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
24354 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
24355 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
24356 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
24357 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
24358 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
24359
24360 Replies:
24361 @table @samp
24362 @item OK
24363 The packet was understood and carried out.
24364 @item
24365 The packet was not recognized.
24366 @end table
24367
24368 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
24369 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
24370 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
24371 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
24372
24373 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
24374 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
24375 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
24376 one of the following forms:
24377
24378 @table @samp
24379 @item F @var{f}
24380 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
24381 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
24382 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
24383
24384 @item T @var{t}
24385 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
24386 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
24387
24388 @end table
24389
24390 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
24391 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24392 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
24393 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
24394
24395 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
24396 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24397 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
24398 is a hexadecimal number.
24399
24400 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
24401 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24402 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
24403 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
24404 numbers.
24405
24406 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
24407 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
24408 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
24409
24410 @item QTStart
24411 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
24412 hits in the trace frame buffer.
24413
24414 @item QTStop
24415 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
24416
24417 @item QTinit
24418 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
24419
24420 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
24421 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
24422 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
24423 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
24424
24425 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
24426 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
24427 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
24428 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
24429
24430 @item qTStatus
24431 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
24432
24433 Replies:
24434 @table @samp
24435 @item T0
24436 There is no trace experiment running.
24437 @item T1
24438 There is a trace experiment running.
24439 @end table
24440
24441 @end table
24442
24443
24444 @node Interrupts
24445 @section Interrupts
24446 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
24447
24448 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
24449 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
24450 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
24451 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
24452
24453 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
24454 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
24455 not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
24456 interfaces.
24457
24458 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
24459 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
24460 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
24461 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
24462 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
24463 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
24464 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
24465 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
24466
24467 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
24468 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
24469 implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
24470 running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
24471 Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
24472 of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
24473 program is stopped will be discarded.
24474
24475 @node Examples
24476 @section Examples
24477
24478 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
24479 does not get any direct output:
24480
24481 @smallexample
24482 -> @code{R00}
24483 <- @code{+}
24484 @emph{target restarts}
24485 -> @code{?}
24486 <- @code{+}
24487 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24488 -> @code{+}
24489 @end smallexample
24490
24491 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
24492
24493 @smallexample
24494 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
24495 <- @code{+}
24496 -> @code{s}
24497 <- @code{+}
24498 @emph{time passes}
24499 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24500 -> @code{+}
24501 -> @code{g}
24502 <- @code{+}
24503 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
24504 -> @code{+}
24505 @end smallexample
24506
24507 @node File-I/O remote protocol extension
24508 @section File-I/O remote protocol extension
24509 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
24510
24511 @menu
24512 * File-I/O Overview::
24513 * Protocol basics::
24514 * The F request packet::
24515 * The F reply packet::
24516 * The Ctrl-C message::
24517 * Console I/O::
24518 * List of supported calls::
24519 * Protocol specific representation of datatypes::
24520 * Constants::
24521 * File-I/O Examples::
24522 @end menu
24523
24524 @node File-I/O Overview
24525 @subsection File-I/O Overview
24526 @cindex file-i/o overview
24527
24528 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
24529 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
24530 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
24531 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
24532 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
24533 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
24534
24535 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
24536 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
24537 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
24538 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
24539 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
24540
24541 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
24542 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
24543 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
24544 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
24545 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
24546 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
24547 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
24548
24549 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
24550 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
24551 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
24552 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
24553 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
24554
24555 @smallexample
24556 (@value{GDBP}) continue
24557 <- target requests 'system call X'
24558 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
24559 -> GDB returns result
24560 ... target continues, GDB returns to wait for the target
24561 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
24562 @end smallexample
24563
24564 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
24565 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
24566 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
24567 system are not supported by this protocol.
24568
24569 @node Protocol basics
24570 @subsection Protocol basics
24571 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
24572
24573 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
24574 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
24575 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
24576 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
24577 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
24578 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
24579 to call the appropriate host system call:
24580
24581 @itemize @bullet
24582 @item
24583 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
24584
24585 @item
24586 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
24587 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
24588 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
24589 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol specific representation.
24590
24591 @end itemize
24592
24593 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
24594
24595 @itemize @bullet
24596 @item
24597 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
24598 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
24599 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
24600 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
24601 packet.
24602
24603 @item
24604 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
24605 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
24606
24607 @item
24608 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
24609
24610 @item
24611 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
24612
24613 @item
24614 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
24615 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
24616 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
24617 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
24618 packet.
24619
24620 @end itemize
24621
24622 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
24623 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
24624
24625 @itemize @bullet
24626 @item
24627 Return value.
24628
24629 @item
24630 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
24631
24632 @item
24633 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
24634
24635 @end itemize
24636
24637 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
24638 the latest continue or step action.
24639
24640 @node The F request packet
24641 @subsection The @code{F} request packet
24642 @cindex file-i/o request packet
24643 @cindex @code{F} request packet
24644
24645 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
24646
24647 @table @samp
24648 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
24649
24650 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
24651 This is just the name of the function.
24652
24653 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
24654 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
24655 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
24656 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
24657 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
24658 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
24659 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
24660
24661 @end table
24662
24663
24664
24665 @node The F reply packet
24666 @subsection The @code{F} reply packet
24667 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
24668 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
24669
24670 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
24671
24672 @table @samp
24673
24674 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call specific attachment}
24675
24676 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
24677
24678 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol specific representation.
24679 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
24680
24681 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
24682 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
24683 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
24684
24685 @smallexample
24686 F0,0,C
24687 @end smallexample
24688
24689 @noindent
24690 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
24691
24692 @smallexample
24693 F-1,4,C
24694 @end smallexample
24695
24696 @noindent
24697 assuming 4 is the protocol specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
24698
24699 @end table
24700
24701
24702 @node The Ctrl-C message
24703 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} message
24704 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
24705
24706 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
24707 reply packet (@pxref{The F reply packet}),
24708 the target should behave as if it had
24709 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
24710 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
24711 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
24712 packet.
24713
24714 It's important for the target to know in which
24715 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
24716
24717 @itemize @bullet
24718 @item
24719 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
24720
24721 @item
24722 The system call on the host has been finished.
24723
24724 @end itemize
24725
24726 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
24727 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
24728 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
24729 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
24730 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
24731 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
24732
24733 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
24734 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
24735 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
24736 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
24737 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
24738 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
24739 or the full action has been completed.
24740
24741 @node Console I/O
24742 @subsection Console I/O
24743 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
24744
24745 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
24746 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
24747 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
24748 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
24749 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
24750 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
24751 conditions is met:
24752
24753 @itemize @bullet
24754 @item
24755 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
24756 @code{read}
24757 system call is treated as finished.
24758
24759 @item
24760 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
24761 newline.
24762
24763 @item
24764 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
24765 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
24766
24767 @end itemize
24768
24769 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
24770 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
24771 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
24772 is stopped at the user's request.
24773
24774
24775 @node List of supported calls
24776 @subsection List of supported calls
24777 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
24778
24779 @menu
24780 * open::
24781 * close::
24782 * read::
24783 * write::
24784 * lseek::
24785 * rename::
24786 * unlink::
24787 * stat/fstat::
24788 * gettimeofday::
24789 * isatty::
24790 * system::
24791 @end menu
24792
24793 @node open
24794 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
24795 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
24796
24797 @table @asis
24798 @item Synopsis:
24799 @smallexample
24800 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
24801 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
24802 @end smallexample
24803
24804 @item Request:
24805 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
24806
24807 @noindent
24808 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24809
24810 @table @code
24811 @item O_CREAT
24812 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
24813 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
24814 are concerned.
24815
24816 @item O_EXCL
24817 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
24818 an error and open() fails.
24819
24820 @item O_TRUNC
24821 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
24822 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
24823 truncated to zero length.
24824
24825 @item O_APPEND
24826 The file is opened in append mode.
24827
24828 @item O_RDONLY
24829 The file is opened for reading only.
24830
24831 @item O_WRONLY
24832 The file is opened for writing only.
24833
24834 @item O_RDWR
24835 The file is opened for reading and writing.
24836 @end table
24837
24838 @noindent
24839 Other bits are silently ignored.
24840
24841
24842 @noindent
24843 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24844
24845 @table @code
24846 @item S_IRUSR
24847 User has read permission.
24848
24849 @item S_IWUSR
24850 User has write permission.
24851
24852 @item S_IRGRP
24853 Group has read permission.
24854
24855 @item S_IWGRP
24856 Group has write permission.
24857
24858 @item S_IROTH
24859 Others have read permission.
24860
24861 @item S_IWOTH
24862 Others have write permission.
24863 @end table
24864
24865 @noindent
24866 Other bits are silently ignored.
24867
24868
24869 @item Return value:
24870 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
24871 occurred.
24872
24873 @item Errors:
24874
24875 @table @code
24876 @item EEXIST
24877 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
24878
24879 @item EISDIR
24880 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
24881
24882 @item EACCES
24883 The requested access is not allowed.
24884
24885 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24886 @var{pathname} was too long.
24887
24888 @item ENOENT
24889 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
24890
24891 @item ENODEV
24892 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
24893
24894 @item EROFS
24895 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
24896 write access was requested.
24897
24898 @item EFAULT
24899 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
24900
24901 @item ENOSPC
24902 No space on device to create the file.
24903
24904 @item EMFILE
24905 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
24906
24907 @item ENFILE
24908 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
24909 has been reached.
24910
24911 @item EINTR
24912 The call was interrupted by the user.
24913 @end table
24914
24915 @end table
24916
24917 @node close
24918 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
24919 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
24920
24921 @table @asis
24922 @item Synopsis:
24923 @smallexample
24924 int close(int fd);
24925 @end smallexample
24926
24927 @item Request:
24928 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
24929
24930 @item Return value:
24931 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
24932
24933 @item Errors:
24934
24935 @table @code
24936 @item EBADF
24937 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
24938
24939 @item EINTR
24940 The call was interrupted by the user.
24941 @end table
24942
24943 @end table
24944
24945 @node read
24946 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
24947 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
24948
24949 @table @asis
24950 @item Synopsis:
24951 @smallexample
24952 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
24953 @end smallexample
24954
24955 @item Request:
24956 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
24957
24958 @item Return value:
24959 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
24960 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
24961 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
24962
24963 @item Errors:
24964
24965 @table @code
24966 @item EBADF
24967 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
24968 reading.
24969
24970 @item EFAULT
24971 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24972
24973 @item EINTR
24974 The call was interrupted by the user.
24975 @end table
24976
24977 @end table
24978
24979 @node write
24980 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
24981 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
24982
24983 @table @asis
24984 @item Synopsis:
24985 @smallexample
24986 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
24987 @end smallexample
24988
24989 @item Request:
24990 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
24991
24992 @item Return value:
24993 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
24994 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
24995 is returned.
24996
24997 @item Errors:
24998
24999 @table @code
25000 @item EBADF
25001 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
25002 writing.
25003
25004 @item EFAULT
25005 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25006
25007 @item EFBIG
25008 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
25009 host specific maximum file size allowed.
25010
25011 @item ENOSPC
25012 No space on device to write the data.
25013
25014 @item EINTR
25015 The call was interrupted by the user.
25016 @end table
25017
25018 @end table
25019
25020 @node lseek
25021 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
25022 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
25023
25024 @table @asis
25025 @item Synopsis:
25026 @smallexample
25027 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
25028 @end smallexample
25029
25030 @item Request:
25031 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
25032
25033 @var{flag} is one of:
25034
25035 @table @code
25036 @item SEEK_SET
25037 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
25038
25039 @item SEEK_CUR
25040 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
25041 bytes.
25042
25043 @item SEEK_END
25044 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
25045 bytes.
25046 @end table
25047
25048 @item Return value:
25049 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
25050 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
25051 value of -1 is returned.
25052
25053 @item Errors:
25054
25055 @table @code
25056 @item EBADF
25057 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
25058
25059 @item ESPIPE
25060 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
25061
25062 @item EINVAL
25063 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
25064
25065 @item EINTR
25066 The call was interrupted by the user.
25067 @end table
25068
25069 @end table
25070
25071 @node rename
25072 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
25073 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
25074
25075 @table @asis
25076 @item Synopsis:
25077 @smallexample
25078 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
25079 @end smallexample
25080
25081 @item Request:
25082 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
25083
25084 @item Return value:
25085 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25086
25087 @item Errors:
25088
25089 @table @code
25090 @item EISDIR
25091 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
25092 directory.
25093
25094 @item EEXIST
25095 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
25096
25097 @item EBUSY
25098 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
25099 process.
25100
25101 @item EINVAL
25102 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
25103 of itself.
25104
25105 @item ENOTDIR
25106 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
25107 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
25108 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
25109
25110 @item EFAULT
25111 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
25112
25113 @item EACCES
25114 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25115
25116 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25117
25118 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
25119
25120 @item ENOENT
25121 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
25122
25123 @item EROFS
25124 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
25125
25126 @item ENOSPC
25127 The device containing the file has no room for the new
25128 directory entry.
25129
25130 @item EINTR
25131 The call was interrupted by the user.
25132 @end table
25133
25134 @end table
25135
25136 @node unlink
25137 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
25138 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
25139
25140 @table @asis
25141 @item Synopsis:
25142 @smallexample
25143 int unlink(const char *pathname);
25144 @end smallexample
25145
25146 @item Request:
25147 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
25148
25149 @item Return value:
25150 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25151
25152 @item Errors:
25153
25154 @table @code
25155 @item EACCES
25156 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25157
25158 @item EPERM
25159 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
25160
25161 @item EBUSY
25162 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
25163 being used by another process.
25164
25165 @item EFAULT
25166 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25167
25168 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25169 @var{pathname} was too long.
25170
25171 @item ENOENT
25172 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
25173
25174 @item ENOTDIR
25175 A component of the path is not a directory.
25176
25177 @item EROFS
25178 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
25179
25180 @item EINTR
25181 The call was interrupted by the user.
25182 @end table
25183
25184 @end table
25185
25186 @node stat/fstat
25187 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
25188 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
25189 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
25190
25191 @table @asis
25192 @item Synopsis:
25193 @smallexample
25194 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
25195 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
25196 @end smallexample
25197
25198 @item Request:
25199 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
25200 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
25201
25202 @item Return value:
25203 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25204
25205 @item Errors:
25206
25207 @table @code
25208 @item EBADF
25209 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
25210
25211 @item ENOENT
25212 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
25213 path is an empty string.
25214
25215 @item ENOTDIR
25216 A component of the path is not a directory.
25217
25218 @item EFAULT
25219 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25220
25221 @item EACCES
25222 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25223
25224 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25225 @var{pathname} was too long.
25226
25227 @item EINTR
25228 The call was interrupted by the user.
25229 @end table
25230
25231 @end table
25232
25233 @node gettimeofday
25234 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
25235 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
25236
25237 @table @asis
25238 @item Synopsis:
25239 @smallexample
25240 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
25241 @end smallexample
25242
25243 @item Request:
25244 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
25245
25246 @item Return value:
25247 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
25248
25249 @item Errors:
25250
25251 @table @code
25252 @item EINVAL
25253 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
25254
25255 @item EFAULT
25256 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25257 @end table
25258
25259 @end table
25260
25261 @node isatty
25262 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
25263 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
25264
25265 @table @asis
25266 @item Synopsis:
25267 @smallexample
25268 int isatty(int fd);
25269 @end smallexample
25270
25271 @item Request:
25272 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
25273
25274 @item Return value:
25275 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
25276
25277 @item Errors:
25278
25279 @table @code
25280 @item EINTR
25281 The call was interrupted by the user.
25282 @end table
25283
25284 @end table
25285
25286 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
25287 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
25288 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
25289 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
25290 needed.
25291
25292
25293 @node system
25294 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
25295 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
25296
25297 @table @asis
25298 @item Synopsis:
25299 @smallexample
25300 int system(const char *command);
25301 @end smallexample
25302
25303 @item Request:
25304 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
25305
25306 @item Return value:
25307 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
25308 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
25309 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
25310 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
25311 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
25312 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
25313 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
25314
25315 @item Errors:
25316
25317 @table @code
25318 @item EINTR
25319 The call was interrupted by the user.
25320 @end table
25321
25322 @end table
25323
25324 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
25325 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
25326 the host is simplified before it's returned
25327 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
25328 is discarded, and the return value consists
25329 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
25330
25331 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
25332 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
25333 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
25334
25335 @table @code
25336 @item set remote system-call-allowed
25337 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
25338 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
25339 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
25340
25341 @item show remote system-call-allowed
25342 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
25343 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
25344 protocol.
25345 @end table
25346
25347 @node Protocol specific representation of datatypes
25348 @subsection Protocol specific representation of datatypes
25349 @cindex protocol specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25350
25351 @menu
25352 * Integral datatypes::
25353 * Pointer values::
25354 * Memory transfer::
25355 * struct stat::
25356 * struct timeval::
25357 @end menu
25358
25359 @node Integral datatypes
25360 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral datatypes
25361 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25362
25363 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
25364 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
25365 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
25366
25367 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
25368 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
25369
25370 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
25371
25372 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
25373 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
25374
25375 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
25376
25377 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
25378 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
25379 byte order.
25380
25381 @node Pointer values
25382 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer values
25383 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
25384
25385 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
25386 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
25387 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
25388 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
25389
25390 @smallexample
25391 @code{1aaf/12}
25392 @end smallexample
25393
25394 @noindent
25395 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
25396 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
25397 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
25398 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
25399
25400 @smallexample
25401 @code{123456/d}
25402 @end smallexample
25403
25404 @node Memory transfer
25405 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory transfer
25406 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
25407
25408 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
25409 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol specific format
25410 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
25411 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
25412 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
25413 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
25414 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
25415
25416
25417 @node struct stat
25418 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
25419 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
25420
25421 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
25422 is defined as follows:
25423
25424 @smallexample
25425 struct stat @{
25426 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
25427 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
25428 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
25429 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
25430 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
25431 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
25432 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
25433 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
25434 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
25435 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
25436 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
25437 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
25438 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
25439 @};
25440 @end smallexample
25441
25442 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25443 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
25444 structure is of size 64 bytes.
25445
25446 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
25447 range of values.
25448
25449 @table @code
25450
25451 @item st_dev
25452 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
25453
25454 @item st_ino
25455 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25456
25457 @item st_mode
25458 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
25459 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
25460
25461 @item st_uid
25462 @itemx st_gid
25463 @itemx st_rdev
25464 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25465
25466 @item st_atime
25467 @itemx st_mtime
25468 @itemx st_ctime
25469 These values have a host and file system dependent
25470 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
25471 support exact timing values.
25472 @end table
25473
25474 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
25475 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
25476 continuing.
25477
25478 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
25479 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
25480 get truncated on the target.
25481
25482 @node struct timeval
25483 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
25484 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
25485
25486 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
25487 is defined as follows:
25488
25489 @smallexample
25490 struct timeval @{
25491 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
25492 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
25493 @};
25494 @end smallexample
25495
25496 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25497 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
25498 structure is of size 8 bytes.
25499
25500 @node Constants
25501 @subsection Constants
25502 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
25503
25504 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
25505 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
25506 values before and after the call as needed.
25507
25508 @menu
25509 * Open flags::
25510 * mode_t values::
25511 * Errno values::
25512 * Lseek flags::
25513 * Limits::
25514 @end menu
25515
25516 @node Open flags
25517 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open flags
25518 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
25519
25520 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
25521
25522 @smallexample
25523 O_RDONLY 0x0
25524 O_WRONLY 0x1
25525 O_RDWR 0x2
25526 O_APPEND 0x8
25527 O_CREAT 0x200
25528 O_TRUNC 0x400
25529 O_EXCL 0x800
25530 @end smallexample
25531
25532 @node mode_t values
25533 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t values
25534 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
25535
25536 All values are given in octal representation.
25537
25538 @smallexample
25539 S_IFREG 0100000
25540 S_IFDIR 040000
25541 S_IRUSR 0400
25542 S_IWUSR 0200
25543 S_IXUSR 0100
25544 S_IRGRP 040
25545 S_IWGRP 020
25546 S_IXGRP 010
25547 S_IROTH 04
25548 S_IWOTH 02
25549 S_IXOTH 01
25550 @end smallexample
25551
25552 @node Errno values
25553 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno values
25554 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
25555
25556 All values are given in decimal representation.
25557
25558 @smallexample
25559 EPERM 1
25560 ENOENT 2
25561 EINTR 4
25562 EBADF 9
25563 EACCES 13
25564 EFAULT 14
25565 EBUSY 16
25566 EEXIST 17
25567 ENODEV 19
25568 ENOTDIR 20
25569 EISDIR 21
25570 EINVAL 22
25571 ENFILE 23
25572 EMFILE 24
25573 EFBIG 27
25574 ENOSPC 28
25575 ESPIPE 29
25576 EROFS 30
25577 ENAMETOOLONG 91
25578 EUNKNOWN 9999
25579 @end smallexample
25580
25581 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
25582 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
25583
25584 @node Lseek flags
25585 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek flags
25586 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
25587
25588 @smallexample
25589 SEEK_SET 0
25590 SEEK_CUR 1
25591 SEEK_END 2
25592 @end smallexample
25593
25594 @node Limits
25595 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
25596 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
25597
25598 All values are given in decimal representation.
25599
25600 @smallexample
25601 INT_MIN -2147483648
25602 INT_MAX 2147483647
25603 UINT_MAX 4294967295
25604 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
25605 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
25606 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
25607 @end smallexample
25608
25609 @node File-I/O Examples
25610 @subsection File-I/O Examples
25611 @cindex file-i/o examples
25612
25613 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25614 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
25615
25616 @smallexample
25617 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
25618 @emph{request memory read from target}
25619 -> @code{m1234,6}
25620 <- XXXXXX
25621 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
25622 -> @code{F6}
25623 @end smallexample
25624
25625 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25626 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
25627
25628 @smallexample
25629 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25630 @emph{request memory write to target}
25631 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25632 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
25633 -> @code{F6}
25634 @end smallexample
25635
25636 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
25637 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
25638
25639 @smallexample
25640 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25641 -> @code{F-1,9}
25642 @end smallexample
25643
25644 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
25645 host is called:
25646
25647 @smallexample
25648 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25649 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
25650 <- @code{T02}
25651 @end smallexample
25652
25653 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
25654 host is called:
25655
25656 @smallexample
25657 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25658 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25659 <- @code{T02}
25660 @end smallexample
25661
25662 @node Memory map format
25663 @section Memory map format
25664 @cindex memory map format
25665
25666 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
25667 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
25668 memory map.
25669
25670 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
25671 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
25672 lists memory regions. The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
25673
25674 @smallexample
25675 <?xml version="1.0"?>
25676 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
25677 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
25678 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
25679 <memory-map>
25680 region...
25681 </memory-map>
25682 @end smallexample
25683
25684 Each region can be either:
25685
25686 @itemize
25687
25688 @item
25689 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
25690 bytes from there:
25691
25692 @smallexample
25693 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
25694 @end smallexample
25695
25696
25697 @item
25698 A region of read-only memory:
25699
25700 @smallexample
25701 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
25702 @end smallexample
25703
25704
25705 @item
25706 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
25707 bytes in length:
25708
25709 @smallexample
25710 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
25711 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
25712 </memory>
25713 @end smallexample
25714
25715 @end itemize
25716
25717 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
25718 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
25719 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
25720
25721 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
25722
25723 @smallexample
25724 <!-- ................................................... -->
25725 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
25726 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
25727 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
25728 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
25729 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
25730 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
25731 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
25732 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
25733 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
25734 and its type, or device. -->
25735 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
25736 start CDATA #REQUIRED
25737 length CDATA #REQUIRED
25738 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
25739 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
25740 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
25741 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
25742 @end smallexample
25743
25744 @include agentexpr.texi
25745
25746 @node Target Descriptions
25747 @appendix Target Descriptions
25748 @cindex target descriptions
25749
25750 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
25751 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
25752 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
25753
25754 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
25755 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
25756 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
25757 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
25758 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
25759 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
25760 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
25761
25762 @itemize @bullet
25763 @item
25764 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
25765 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
25766 @item
25767 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
25768 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
25769 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
25770 @item
25771 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
25772 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
25773 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
25774 @end itemize
25775
25776 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
25777 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
25778 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
25779 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
25780 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
25781
25782 @value{GDBN} must be compiled with Expat support to support XML target
25783 descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
25784
25785 @menu
25786 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
25787 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
25788 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
25789 descriptions.
25790 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
25791 @end menu
25792
25793 @node Retrieving Descriptions
25794 @section Retrieving Descriptions
25795
25796 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
25797 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
25798 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
25799 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
25800 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
25801 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
25802 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
25803 Format}.
25804
25805 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
25806 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
25807 specify a file are:
25808
25809 @table @code
25810 @cindex set tdesc filename
25811 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
25812 Read the target description from @var{path}.
25813
25814 @cindex unset tdesc filename
25815 @item unset tdesc filename
25816 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
25817 will use the description supplied by the current target.
25818
25819 @cindex show tdesc filename
25820 @item show tdesc filename
25821 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
25822 @end table
25823
25824
25825 @node Target Description Format
25826 @section Target Description Format
25827 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
25828
25829 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
25830 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
25831 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
25832 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
25833 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
25834 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
25835 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
25836
25837 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
25838 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
25839 sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
25840 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
25841
25842 Here is a simple target description:
25843
25844 @smallexample
25845 <target>
25846 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
25847 </target>
25848 @end smallexample
25849
25850 @noindent
25851 This minimal description only says that the target uses
25852 the x86-64 architecture.
25853
25854 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
25855 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
25856 are explained further below.
25857
25858 @smallexample
25859 <?xml version="1.0"?>
25860 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
25861 <target>
25862 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
25863 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
25864 </target>
25865 @end smallexample
25866
25867 @noindent
25868 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
25869 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
25870 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
25871 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
25872 useful for XML validation tools.
25873
25874 @subsection Inclusion
25875 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
25876 @cindex XInclude
25877 @ifnotinfo
25878 @cindex <xi:include>
25879 @end ifnotinfo
25880
25881 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
25882 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
25883 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
25884 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
25885 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
25886
25887 @smallexample
25888 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
25889 @end smallexample
25890
25891 @noindent
25892 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
25893 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
25894 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
25895 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
25896 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
25897 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
25898 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
25899 original description.
25900
25901 @subsection Architecture
25902 @cindex <architecture>
25903
25904 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
25905
25906 @smallexample
25907 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
25908 @end smallexample
25909
25910 @var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
25911 accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
25912 Debugging Target}).
25913
25914 @subsection Features
25915 @cindex <feature>
25916
25917 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
25918 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
25919 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
25920 has this form:
25921
25922 @smallexample
25923 <feature name="@var{name}">
25924 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
25925 @var{reg}@dots{}
25926 </feature>
25927 @end smallexample
25928
25929 @noindent
25930 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
25931 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
25932 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
25933 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
25934
25935 @subsection Types
25936
25937 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
25938 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
25939 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
25940 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
25941 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
25942
25943 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
25944 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
25945 Types must be defined before they are used.
25946
25947 @cindex <vector>
25948 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
25949 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
25950 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
25951 @var{count}:
25952
25953 @smallexample
25954 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
25955 @end smallexample
25956
25957 @cindex <union>
25958 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
25959 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
25960 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
25961 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
25962
25963 @smallexample
25964 <union id="@var{id}">
25965 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
25966 @dots{}
25967 </union>
25968 @end smallexample
25969
25970 @subsection Registers
25971 @cindex <reg>
25972
25973 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
25974
25975 @smallexample
25976 <reg name="@var{name}"
25977 bitsize="@var{size}"
25978 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
25979 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
25980 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
25981 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
25982 @end smallexample
25983
25984 @noindent
25985 The components are as follows:
25986
25987 @table @var
25988
25989 @item name
25990 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
25991
25992 @item bitsize
25993 The register's size, in bits.
25994
25995 @item regnum
25996 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
25997 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
25998 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
25999 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
26000 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
26001 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
26002 in order of increasing register number.
26003
26004 @item save-restore
26005 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
26006 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
26007 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
26008 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
26009 ABI.
26010
26011 @item type
26012 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
26013 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
26014 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
26015 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
26016 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
26017 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
26018
26019 @item group
26020 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
26021 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
26022 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
26023 in @code{info registers}.
26024
26025 @end table
26026
26027 @node Predefined Target Types
26028 @section Predefined Target Types
26029 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
26030
26031 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
26032 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
26033 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
26034 types. The currently supported types are:
26035
26036 @table @code
26037
26038 @item int8
26039 @itemx int16
26040 @itemx int32
26041 @itemx int64
26042 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
26043
26044 @item uint8
26045 @itemx uint16
26046 @itemx uint32
26047 @itemx uint64
26048 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
26049
26050 @item code_ptr
26051 @itemx data_ptr
26052 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
26053 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
26054 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
26055 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
26056 may be marked as data pointers.
26057
26058 @item arm_fpa_ext
26059 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
26060
26061 @end table
26062
26063 @node Standard Target Features
26064 @section Standard Target Features
26065 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
26066
26067 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
26068 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
26069 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
26070 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
26071 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
26072 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
26073 can recognize them.
26074
26075 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
26076 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
26077 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
26078 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
26079 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
26080 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
26081 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
26082 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
26083
26084 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
26085 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
26086 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
26087
26088 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
26089 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
26090 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
26091 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
26092
26093 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
26094 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
26095 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
26096
26097 @subsection ARM Features
26098 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
26099
26100 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
26101 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
26102 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
26103
26104 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
26105 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
26106
26107 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
26108 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
26109 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
26110 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
26111
26112 @include gpl.texi
26113
26114 @raisesections
26115 @include fdl.texi
26116 @lowersections
26117
26118 @node Index
26119 @unnumbered Index
26120
26121 @printindex cp
26122
26123 @tex
26124 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
26125 % meantime:
26126 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
26127 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
26128 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
26129 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
26130 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
26131 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
26132 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
26133 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
26134 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
26135 \page\colophon
26136 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
26137 @end tex
26138
26139 @bye
This page took 0.615799 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.